Current through Register Vol. 49, No. 9, September, 2024
SECTION 1
:
AUTHORITY.
The following Rules for Critical Access Hospitals in Arkansas
are duly adopted and promulgated by the Arkansas State Board of Health pursuant
to the authority expressly conferred by the laws of the State of Arkansas in
Act 414 of 1961, as amended by Act 258 of 1971, Act 190 of 1975, Act 536 of
1977, Act 273 of 1983, Act 980 of 1985, and Act 516 of 1987, along with Acts
143 of 1987, 348 of 1987, and 399 of 1987 covered under these
regulations.
SECTION 2
: PURPOSE.
These rules have been prepared for the purpose of establishing
a criterion for minimum standards for licensure, operation and maintenance of
hospitals and related institutions in Arkansas that is consistent with current
trends in patient care practices. By necessity they are of a regulatory nature
but are considered to be practical minimum design and operational standards for
these facilities. These standards are not static and are subject to periodic
revisions in the future as new knowledge and changes in patient care trends
become apparent. However, it is expected that facilities will exceed these
minimum requirements and that they shall not be dependent upon future revisions
in these standards as a necessary prerequisite for improved services. Hospitals
and related institutions have a strong moral responsibility for providing
optimum patient care and treatment for the populations they serve.
SECTION 3
:
DEFINITIONS.
For purposes of the rules, the following definitions
apply.
A. Administrator means the
person responsible for the management of any facility requiring licensure under
these rules.
B. Alcohol/Drug Abuse
Inpatient Treatment Center means a distinct unit within a hospital in which
services are provided for the diagnosis, treatment and rehabilitation of
alcohol and drug abuse.
C. Basic
hospital services means the services that all licensed hospitals must provide.
Basic services consist of:
1. Governing
Body;
2. Medical Staff;
3. General Administration;
4. Patient Care;
5. Health Information;
6. Pharmacy;
7. Food and Nutrition;
8. Infection Prevention and
Control;
9. Laboratory;
10. Radiology;
11. Respiratory Therapy;
12. Emergency; and
13. Physical facility maintenance.
D. Critical Access Hospital (CAH)
means a hospital located in a rural area that is:
1. Located more than a 35-mile drive (or, in
the case of mountainous terrain or in areas with only secondary roads
available, a 15-mile drive) from a hospital, or;
2. Provides 24-hour emergency care services
as determined necessary for ensuring access to emergency care in each area
served by a Critical Access Hospital;
3. Provides staffing according to Rules and
Regulations for Hospitals and Related Institutions in Arkansas;
4. Meets Centers of Medicare and Medicaid
Services (CMS) Conditions of Participation for Critical Access Hospitals;
or
5. Was operating as a licensed
Critical Access Hospital in Arkansas as of April 2007.
E. Department means the Arkansas Department
of Health.
F. Emergency Services
Facility means a facility originally operated as a licensed hospital that has
discontinued inpatient services but is licensed to continue to provide
emergency services.
G. General
Hospital means any facility used for the purpose of providing short-term
inpatient diagnostic care and treatment, including general medical care,
surgical care, obstetrical care, and specialized services or specialized
treatment.
H. Infirmary means any
facility used for the purpose of offering temporary medical care and/or
treatment exclusively for persons residing on a designated premise, e.g.,
schools, reformatories, prisons, etc. and where the persons are kept for 24
hours or more.
I. Institution
means, for the purpose of these rules, a facility which requires a license.
Institution does not include an establishment:
1. Operated by the federal government or by
any of its agencies; or
2. Licensed
or certified by the Office of Alcohol and Drug Abuse Prevention of the Division
of Behavioral Health of the Department of Human Services as an alcohol and drug
abuse inpatient treatment center.
J. Licensee means the person to whom a
license is issued for the purpose of operating the institution described in the
application for licensure, who shall be responsible for maintaining approved
standards for the institution of any state, county, or local government unit
and any division, board, or agency thereof.
K. Observation is a designated patient status
as opposed to a designated area. Patients in observation status are those
patients requiring periodic monitoring and assessment necessary to evaluate the
patient's condition or to determine the need for possible admissions to the
hospital in an inpatient status. Usually observation status shall be for 48
hours or less.
L. Off-campus
Emergency Department means an emergency services department located off site
from the main hospital campus but functions as a fully integrated department of
the parent hospital.
M. Outpatient
Psychiatric Center means a facility in which psychiatric services are offered
for a period of 8 to 16 hours a day, and where, in the opinion of the attending
psychiatrist, hospitalization as defined in the present licensure law is not
necessary. This definition shall not include Community Mental Health Clinics
and Centers, as they now exist.
N.
1. Outpatient Surgery Center (Ambulatory
Surgery Center) means a facility in which surgical services are offered that
require the use of general or intravenous anesthetics, and where, in the
opinion of the attending physician, hospitalization is not necessary.
2. "Outpatient surgery Center" does not
include:
a. a medical office owned and
operated by a physician or more than one (1) physician licensed by the Arkansas
State Medical Board, if the medical office does not bill facility fees to a
third party payor; or
b. a dental
office that has a Facility Permit for Moderate Sedation or a Facility Permit
for General/Deep Sedation issued by the Arkansas State Board of Dental
Examiners.
O.
Psychiatric Hospital means any facility, or a distinct part of a facility, used
for the purpose of providing inpatient diagnostic care and treatment for
persons having mental disorders.
P.
Recuperation Center means any facility or distinct part of a facility, which
includes inpatient beds with an organized Medical Staff, and with medical
services that include physician services and continuous nursing services to
provide treatment for patients who are not in an acute phase of illness but who
currently require primarily convalescent or restorative services (usually
post-acute hospital care of relatively short duration). A facility that
furnishes primarily domiciliary care is not within this definition.
Q. Rehabilitation Hospital or Facility means,
for the purpose of these rules, an inpatient care facility, or a distinct part
of a facility, which provides rehabilitation services for two or more disabled
persons not related to the proprietor, for more than 24 hours through an
integrated program of medical and other restorative services. A disabled person
shall be considered to be an individual who has a physical or mental condition
which, if not treated, will probably result in limiting the performance or
activity of the person to the extent of constituting a substantial physical,
mental, or vocational handicap.
R.
Shall means mandatory.
S. State
Health Officer means the Secretary of the State Board of Health.
T. Surgery and General Medical Care Hospital
means any facility limited to providing short-term inpatient surgical and
general medical diagnostic care and treatment.
SECTION 4
: LICENSURE AND CODES.
A. License required. No general hospital or
distinct part, critical access hospital or distinct part, recuperation center
or distinct part, infirmary, rehabilitation facility or distinct part,
outpatient surgery center, or alcohol/drug abuse inpatient treatment center,
psychiatric hospital or distinct part, outpatient psychiatric center or
emergency services facility may be established, conducted, or maintained in the
State without first obtaining a license.
B. Exceptions to license requirement. The
following facilities do not require a license from the Department:
1. A facility operated by the Federal
Government; and
2. A First Aid
Station.
C. Basic
services required. Every licensed hospital must provide basic
services.
D. Application for
License.
1. An applicant shall file
applications under oath with the Department upon forms provided by Health
Facility Services and shall pay annual license fee as indicated by Act 574 of
1997.
2. These fees shall be paid
into the State Treasury or refunded to the applicant if a license is denied.
The application shall be signed by the owner, if an individual or partnership,
or in the case of a corporation, by two of its officers, or in the case of a
governmental unit, by the head of the governmental department having
jurisdiction over it. The application shall set forth the full name and address
of the institution for which license is sought and such additional information
as the Department may require, including affirmative evidence of ability to
comply with such reasonable standards, rules, and regulations as may be
lawfully prescribed hereunder. The application for annual license renewal shall
be postmarked no later than January 2 of the year for which the license is
issued. The license applicant for an existing institution postmarked after the
date shall be subject to a penalty of one dollar per day for each day and every
day after January 2.
3. A license
issued hereunder shall be effective on a calendar year basis and shall expire
on December 31 of each calendar year. A license shall be issued only for the
premises and persons in the application, and shall not be transferable. If the
facility changes ownership the license shall expire. The license shall be
posted in a conspicuous place on the licensed premises. A license issued under
previous regulations shall be effective through the period for which it was
issued. The adequacy of cooperative agreements between hospitals in terms of
service provided by each hospital and the type of licenses issued to each
hospital shall be determined by the Arkansas Department of Health.
E. Facility Change of Ownership.
1. It shall be the responsibility of the
licensed entity to notify Health Facility Services in writing at least 30 days
prior to the effective date of change of ownership.
2. The following information shall be
submitted to Health Facility Services for review and approval:
a. License application;
b. Request for Medicare Certification (where
applicable);
c. Legal documents,
ownership agreements, the license previously issued to the facility, and other
information to support relicensure requirements; and
d. Licensure fee as indicated by Act 574 of
1997.
3. For the purpose
of these rules the licensed entity is the party ultimately responsible for
operating the facility. The same entity also bears the final responsibility in
decisions made in the capacity of a Governing Body, and for the consequences of
these decisions.
F.
Facility Name Change and/or Address.
1. The
facility shall notify Health Facility Services of any name and/or address
change;
2. The previously issued
license shall be returned to Health Facility Services; and
3. A fee, as indicated in Act 574 of 1997,
shall be submitted to Health Facility Services for issuance of a new
license.
G. Management
Contract.
1. It shall be the responsibility of
the licensed entity to notify Health Facility Services in writing at least 30
days prior to entering into a management contract or agreement with an
organization or firm. A copy of the contract or agreement shall also be
submitted to Health Facility Services for review to assure the arrangement does
not materially affect the license status.
2. An organization or firm who contracts with
the licensed entity to manage the health care facility, subject to Governing
Body approval of operational decisions, is generally considered an agent rather
than an owner. In such instances a licensure change is not required.
H. Separate License. An individual
license shall be required for an institution maintained on separate premises
even though it is operated under the same management, except in cases where the
hospital management of a general hospital operates a detached building which
can be utilized in a limited way for general medical care. Separate licenses
are not required for separate buildings on the same grounds.
I. Temporary Licenses. This license shall be
for less than one year and for a time specified on the temporary license by the
Department.
J. Revocation of
License. The Department is empowered to deny, suspend, or revoke a license on
any of the following grounds:
1. Violation of
any of the provisions of Act 414 of 1961, as amended by Act 258 of 1971, or Act
190 of 1975, Act 536 of 1977, or Act 273 of 1983, Act 980 of 1985, or Act 516
of 1987; Act 143 of 1987, Act 399 of 1987, or Act 348 of 1987, or the Rules and
Regulations lawfully promulgated hereunder; or
2. Permitting, aiding, or abetting the
commission of any unlawful act in connection with the operation of the
institution. (Section 22, Act 414 of 1961, as amended).
3. The right of appeal of any revocation
shall be as specified in the appeal procedure of the Arkansas Department of
Health.
NOTE: If services are to be temporarily suspended, a functional
program, with plans and specifications as applicable, shall be submitted to
Health Facility Services for approval prior to such suspension.
K. Inspection. Any
authorized representative of the Department shall have the right to enter the
premises of any institution at any time in order to make whatever inspection
necessary in accordance with the minimum standards and rules prescribed
herein.
L. CMS Waivers. When CMS
declares a public health emergency (PHE) with the implementation of waivers
which applies to Arkansas, ADH may consider implementing similar waivers. If
implemented, the waiver request and authorization may vary based on the type of
PHE and CMS requirements.
M.
Penalties.
1. Any person, partnership,
association, or corporation which establishes, conducts, manages, or operates
any institution within the meaning of Act 414 of 1961, as amended by Act 258 of
1971, Act 190 of 1975, Act 536 of 1977, Act 273 of 1983, Act 980 of 1985, And
Act 516 of 1987; and Act 143 of 1987, Act 348 of 1987, and Act 399 of 1987,
without first obtaining a license therefore as herein provided, or who violates
any portion of this act or regulations lawfully promulgated hereunder, shall be
guilty of a misdemeanor, and upon conviction thereof shall be liable to a fine
of not less than $25.00 nor more than $100.00 for the first offense and not
less than One Hundred Dollars 100.00), nor more than $500.00 for each
subsequent offense, and each day such institution operates after a first
conviction shall be considered a subsequent offense. (Ark. Code Ann. §
20-9-202.)
2. Any institution licensed by the authority
of these rules that has received damage due to fire, tornado, earthquake,
man-made or natural disaster shall notify the Department by telephone
immediately and follow with a preliminary report within 48 hours, and a
complete report when the incident has been thoroughly investigated. The
submitted report shall include, but not be limited to, damage to the building,
damage estimates, injuries to patients, staff and the public, etc. If the
Department is not notified, the institution shall be assessed a fine in the
amount of $50.00 for each day, or portion thereof, the incident is not reported
or $500.00 maximum.
N.
Codes. See Section 43, Physical Facilities, List of Referenced
Publications.
SECTION 5
: GOVERNING BODY.
An institution shall have an organized Governing Body which
shall be legally responsible for maintaining quality patient care and
establishing policies for the facility. The Governing Body shall be legally
responsible for the conduct of the institution.
A. Governing Body Bylaws. The Governing Body
shall adopt written bylaws which shall be available to all members of the
Governing Body. The bylaws shall ensure:
1.
Maintenance of proper standards of professional work in the hospital;
2. The Medical Staff functions in conformity
with reasonable standards of competency;
3. The method of selecting members and
officers with terms and responsibilities delineated;
4. The selection of an Administrator or Chief
Executive Officer with responsibilities for operation and maintenance of the
facility delineated. In the absence of the Administrator, an alternate with
authority to act shall be designated;
5. Methods for establishing Governing Body
committees with the duties of each committee delineated;
6. Coordination of activities and general
policies of the departments and special committees;
7. Liaison between the Governing Body and
Medical Staff with quarterly documentation;
8. Quarterly Governing Body meetings with
maintenance of minutes signed by an officer;
9. Provision for formal approval of the
organization, bylaws, rules and regulations of the Medical Staff and their
services;
10. Admission of patients
by a physician, patient choice of physician and/or dentist and emergency care
by a physician. All institutions governed by these standards shall arrange for
one or more persons duly licensed to practice medicine to be called in an
emergency. All individuals, who are not hospital employees, who make entries
into the medical record, shall be credentialed through the Medical
Staff;
11. A method of
credentialing or appointing members to the Medical Staff and other authorized
staff;
12. Methods by which Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement (QA/PI) is established; and
13. Establishment of a quorum to be met in
order to conduct business.
B. Governing Body Minutes. The Governing Body
minutes shall include at least the following information:
1. Review, approval and revision of the
Governing Body bylaws and the Medical Staff bylaws, Rules and
Regulations;
2. Election of
officers, as indicated in the bylaws;
3. Documentation that the liaison between the
Governing Body and Medical Staff is maintained;
4. Appointment and reappointment of the
Medical Staff and other authorized staff as indicated in the bylaws;
5. Review and approval of the hospital's
annual operating budget and capital expenditure plan;
6. Review and approval of reports received
from the Medical Staff and Administration; and
7. Review and approval of the Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement (QA/PI) plan of the facility, at least
annually, also documentation of the quarterly Quality Assurance/Performance
Improvement (QA/PI) summaries.
SECTION 6
: MEDICAL STAFF.
All persons admitted and discharged to any institution governed
by these standards shall be under the care of a person duly licensed to
practice medicine in Arkansas (hereafter called physician or surgeon). In
institutions where two or more physicians are allowed to practice there shall
be an organized Medical Staff. Members of the staff shall be qualified legally
and professionally for the positions to which they are appointed. Individuals
who are not hospital employees, who work in the hospital shall be credentialed
through the Medical Staff with approval from the Governing Body. (Refer to
Section 36, Specialized Services: Emergency Services.)
Note: See Ark. Code Ann. §
17-95-107 regarding requirements
for health care organizations that credential physicians/authorized staff to
use the Arkansas State Medical Board's Centralized Credentials Verification
Service (CCVS).
A. Credential Files of
the Medical Staff and Other Authorized Staff. An individual file shall be
maintained for each physician/other authorized staff practicing in the hospital
and shall include at least the following:
1.
Verification of age, year, and school of graduation and statement of
postgraduate or special training and experience;
2. Specific delineation of privileges
requested and granted;
3. A
detailed application signed by the applicant, the Chairman of the Credentials
Committee and an officer of the Governing Body;
4. Documentation of the applicant's agreement
to abide by the Medical Staff Bylaws and hospital requirements;
5. Verification of current Arkansas
license;
6. Verification of each
applicable physician's Drug Enforcement Agency (DEA) registration;
7. Verification of at least three
references;
8. Documentation of all
actions taken by the Medical Staff and Governing Board indicating the type of
privileges granted, approval of appointment/reappointment and other related
data;
9. Evaluation of members'
professional activities at the time of reappointment; and
10. Non-employee practitioners may be
screened through the Human Resources Department or another hospital designee.
The requested privileges and credentialing shall be approved by the Medical
Staff.
NOTE: Hospitals shall report to the appropriate professional
licensing board the names of individuals whose hospital privileges have been
terminated or revoked for cause.
B. Medical Staff Bylaws. The Medical Staff
Bylaws shall include at least the following information:
1. A provision stating the Medical Staff
shall be responsible to the Governing Body of the facility for the quality of
medical care provided for patients in the hospital and for the ethical and
professional practices of members;
2. A provision stating the requirements for
medical and other authorized staff membership, including allied health
professionals;
3. A provision
stating the division of the Medical Staff and clinical departments;
4. A provision stating the election of
officers, responsibilities and terms;
5. A provision establishing Medical Staff
committees, functions, frequency of meetings and composition
(quorum);
6. A provision
establishing frequency of general Medical Staff meetings, specifying attendance
requirements;
7. A provision
establishing written minutes be maintained of all Medical Staff meetings and
the minutes shall be signed by the physician chairman;
8. A provision for an appeals process which
delineates the procedures for a physician or other authorized staff to follow
in challenging staff, that if ratified by the Governing Body, adversely affects
his/her appointment or reappointment to the Medical Staff;
9. A provision establishing the designation
of a specific physician who shall direct each clinical/diagnostic
service;
10. A provision
delineating requirements for maintaining accurate and complete medical records.
(See Health Information Services, Section 14.);
11. A provision for selection and approval of
nationally recognized protocols for use in the Emergency Department;
12. A provision for approval of the bylaws
and amendments by the Medical Staff and the Governing Body; and
13. Documentation of appointments,
reappointments and approval of requested privileges to the medical and other
authorized staff as specified in the bylaws, but at least every two
years.
C. Medical Staff
Minutes. Medical Staff minutes shall include at least the following:
1. Documentation of review of committee
reports including quarterly Quality Assurance/Performance Improvement
(QA/PI);
2. Review, approval and
revision of the Medical Staff Bylaws and Rules and Regulations;
3. Election of officers as specified by the
Bylaws; and
4. Documentation of
physicians designated as chairmen of the committees to direct the services
defined in the Medical Staff bylaws.
D. Quality Assurance/Performance Improvement
(QA/PI).
1. The organization shall develop,
implement and maintain an ongoing program to assess and improve the quality of
care and services provided. A multidisciplinary committee shall meet at least
quarterly to provide oversight and direction for the program; the hospital
shall maintain minutes of the meetings. A Quality Assurance/Performance
Improvement Plan shall be developed and maintained to describe the manner in
which QA/PI activities shall be conducted in the hospital. The QA/PI plan shall
be reviewed and approved by the Chief Executive Officer, Medical Staff and
Governing Body annually.
a. All hospital and
Medical Staff programs, services, departments and functions, including
contracted services related to patient care, shall participate in ongoing
quality assurance/performance improvement activities.
b. The hospital shall collect and assess data
on the functional activities identified as priorities in the QA/PI
plan.
c. Data collected shall be
benchmarked against past performance and/or national or local
standards.
d. Improvement
strategies shall be developed for programs, services, departments and functions
identified with opportunities for improvement.
e. The effectiveness of improvement
strategies and actions taken shall be monitored and evaluated, with
documentation of conclusions regarding effectiveness.
f. Identify and reduce medical errors and
adverse patient events.
g. Approved
organizational abbreviation list.
2. Scope of QA/PI Program. The QA/PI program
shall include, but not be limited to, ongoing assessment and improvement
activities regarding the following:
a. Access
to care, processes of care, outcomes of care and hospital-specific clinical
data, including applicable Peer Review Organization (PRO)/Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement Organization (QA/PIO) data;
b. Customer satisfaction (patients and
families, physicians and employees);
c. Staff performance as it relates to the
staff as a whole when reviewing aspects of care;
d. Complaint resolution;
e. Utilization and discharge planning data;
and
f. Organizational
performance.
3. Program
Responsibilities. The Governing Body shall assume overall responsibility and
accountability for the organization-wide QA/PI program. The Governing Body,
Chief Executive Officer and Medical Staff shall ensure QA/PI activities,
address identified priorities and be responsible for the development,
implementation, monitoring and documentation of improvement
activities.
4. Reporting. QA/PI
activities shall be reported to the Governing Body on at least a quarterly
basis and shall be documented in the Governing Body meeting minutes.
5. Policies and Procedures. Policies and
procedures pertaining to the QA/PI program which are not contained within the
QA/PI plan shall be maintained in a manual, reviewed and approved
annually.
6. Program Evaluation. An
evaluation of the QA/PI program shall be conducted by the hospital and reported
to the Governing Body annually. The evaluation shall be based upon objective
data and shall include programs, services, departments and functions targeted
by the hospital for improvement, as well as those conducting ongoing QA/PI
activities. Changes in the QA/PI program and QA/PI plan shall be made in
response to the evaluation.
E. Discharge Planning. There shall be a
discharge plan for each patient.
1. Discharge
plans shall incorporate available community and hospital resources, such as
social, psychological, nutritional, and educational services, to meet the
medically-related needs of the patients and to facilitate the provision of
follow-up care.
2. There shall be
policies and procedures developed for discharge planning which include:
a. initiation of discharge planning at the
time of the patient's admission;
b.
reassessment of patient's condition and needs prior to the patient's
discharge;
c. patient and family
education regarding the discharge plan which includes:
1) follow-up care and treatment;
2) available community and hospital
resources; and
d.
transfers and referral processes to appropriate facilities, agencies or
outpatient services as needed for follow-up or ancillary care, including
necessary medical information.
F. Organ and Tissue Donation. The Governing
Body of each Acute Care Hospital shall cause to be developed appropriate
policies, procedures, and protocols for identifying and referring potential
organ and tissue donors. The written policies and procedures shall include but
not be limited to the following subjects:
1.
Determination and declaration of brain death;
2. Organ procurement procedures:
a. Identifying potential donors;
b. Referring potential donors; and
c. Obtaining consent.
3. Role of attending physician;
4. Role of the procurement coordinator
(employee of procurement agencies);
5. Reimbursement for cost of
donation;
6. Liabilities associated
with donation;
7. Agreement with
organ procurement agency designated by Center for Medicare and Medicaid
Services (CMS);
8. A consent
procedure which encourages reasonable discretion and sensitivity to the family
circumstances in all decisions regarding organ and tissue donations;
9. Determination by the organ procurement
agency personnel of the suitability of the organs and/or tissues for
transplantation; and
10.
Requirements for documentation in the patient's medical record that the family
of a potential organ donor has been advised of their right to donate or decline
to donate.
SECTION
7
: GENERAL ADMINISTRATION.
A. Each institution shall have an
Administrator responsible for the management of the institution. In the absence
of the Administrator, an alternate with authority to act shall be designated.
The responsibilities of the Administrator shall include:
1. Keeping the Governing Body fully informed
of the conduct of the hospital by submitting periodic written reports or by
attending meetings of the Governing Body;
2. Conducting interdepartmental meetings at
regular intervals and maintaining minutes of the meetings;
3. Preparing an annual operating budget of
anticipated income and expected expenditures; and
4. Preparing a capital expenditure plan for
at least a three-year period.
B. Policies and procedures shall be provided
for the general administration of the institution and for each department,
section or service in the facility. All policies and procedures for departments
or services shall have evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first
page of each manual shall have the annual review date signature of the
department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the review.
C. An accurate daily patient census sheet as
of midnight shall be available to the Department at all times.
D. The facility shall have visitation
policies determined by the Medical Staff, Governing Body and Administration
which shall include:
1. Development by the
Governing Body with guidance from the Medical Staff and Infection Prevention
and Control Committee regarding persons under the age of 12 who visit critical
care areas of the hospital.
2.
Provisions that comply with Act 311 of 2021 known as "No Patient Left Alone
Act" which is codified at A.C.A. §
20-6-401 et seq. See Appendix
A.
E. Provisions shall be
made for safe storage of patients' valuables.
F. Animals such as cats, dogs, birds and fish
and aquatic animals shall not be permitted in health care facilities.
Exceptions shall be made for service animals, animals that participate in pet
therapy, fish and aquatic animals in approved aquariums. (See Section 25, Pet
Therapy Program.) All exceptions shall be approved by Health Facility Services.
1. Service animals shall be permitted only
under the following guidelines:
a. Only
animals specifically trained as service animals shall be allowed into the
facility.
b. Service animals shall
not be allowed into the facility if they are unhealthy, feverish, or suffer
from gastroenteritis, fleas or skin lesions.
c. Healthy, well-groomed animals shall be
allowed to enter the facility into areas that are generally accessible to the
public (i.e., lobbies, cafeteria, and nurses stations on unrestricted units).
The owner of the animal shall be directed to inquire about the possibility of a
visit before entering a patient's room. Authorization to visit shall be given
by a unit supervisor.
d. Service
animals shall be walked before entering the facility or shall be diapered in a
manner to prevent contamination of the facility environment with excreta.
Service animals shall not be fed within the facility.
e. Petting or playing with service animals by
hospital personnel or patients shall be prohibited.
f. Owners of service animals shall be
instructed to wash their hands before having patient contact.
g. Visiting with service animals shall be
restricted in the following circumstances:
1)
The patient is in isolation for respiratory, enteric or infectious diseases or
is in protective isolation;
2) The
patient, although not in protective isolation, is immunocompromised or has a
roommate that is;
3) The patient is
in an intensive care unit, burn unit or restricted access unit of the
hospital;
4) The patient or
roommate is allergic to animals or has a severe phobia; and
5) The patient or roommate is psychotic,
hallucinating or confused or has an altered perception of reality and is not
amenable to rational explanation.
h. Animals which become loud, aggressive or
agitated shall be removed from the facility immediately.
2. Fish and aquatic animals shall not be
permitted in health care facilities without prior written approval by Health
Facility Services. Aquariums shall be approved by the Medical Staff and
Infection Prevention and Control Committee. (Turtles will not be considered for
approval.)
a. Aquariums shall meet the
following requirements:
1) Aquariums shall be
self-contained, shock proof, break proof and quiet in operation.
2) Aquariums shall be constructed or
positioned in such a manner as to be leak-proof, spill proof and to preclude
patients or staff from having direct contact with the animals or water in the
aquarium.
3) Aquariums and
associated equipment shall be cleaned frequently by appropriately trained
personnel who do not have direct contact with patients or patient care
items.
4) Aquariums shall be placed
only in areas which are accessed by the general public. Aquariums shall not be
placed in critical care areas (i.e., nursing stations, surgery, patient rooms,
ICU, etc.)
5) Aquariums shall be
kept in a state of good repair at all times.
b. There shall be written procedures for
cleaning and caring for the aquarium.
c. There shall be written procedures for
dealing with clean up in the event there is a major accident concerning the
aquarium.
d. Fish or aquatic
animals shall be of varieties that do not bite, sting and are considered
non-toxic or non-poisonous.
G. Each facility shall develop and maintain a
risk-assessed all hazards written disaster plan.
The plan shall:
1. be
tailored to meet specific disaster risks present in the area, such as
earthquakes, tornados, floods, nuclear reactor failures, etc.;
2. include widespread disasters as well as
disasters occurring within the local community and hospital facility;
3. provide for complete evacuation of the
facility;
4. provide for care of
mass casualties and increased patient volume;
5. provide for transfer of patients,
including those with hospital equipment, to an alternate site;
6. contain two rehearsals a year, preferably
as part of a coordinated drill in which other community emergency agencies
participate; and
a. one drill shall simulate a
disaster of internal nature and the other external;
b. one drill shall be planned and one shall
be "no notice;" and
c. written
reports and evaluation of all drills shall be maintained;
7. contain specific provisions to supply
food, water, generator fuel and other essential items for 72 hours (applies to
inpatient facilities only);
8.
develop, maintain and exercise redundant communication systems; and
9. facilities with AWIN (Arkansas Wireless
Information Network) issued equipment shall include regular maintenance and
personnel training for its use.
H. There shall be a posted list of names,
telephone numbers and addresses available for emergency use. The list shall
include the key hospital personnel and staff, the local police department, the
fire department, ambulance service, Red Cross and other available emergency
units. The list shall be reviewed and updated at least every six
months.
I. There shall be rules and
regulations governing the routine methods of handling and storing flammable and
explosive agents, particularly in operating rooms, delivery rooms, laundries
and in areas where oxygen therapy is administered.
J. All refrigerated areas, including
freezers, shall be provided with thermometers and records maintained to
document the temperatures checked on a daily or weekly basis, as
required.
K. The facility shall
provide access to appropriate educational references to meet the professional
and technical needs of hospital personnel.
L. A safety committee shall develop written
procedures for the reporting and prevention of safety hazards. The committee
shall meet at least quarterly or more frequently if necessary to fulfill safety
objectives. Minutes of the meeting shall be maintained.
M. All Departments and/or Services shall
receive annual education on safety, fire safety, back safety, infection
prevention and control, universal/standard precautions, disaster preparedness
and confidential information.
N.
Any hospital or related institution that closes shall meet the requirements for
new construction in order to be eligible for re-licensure. Once a facility
closes, it is no longer licensed. The license shall be immediately returned to
Health Facility Services. To be eligible for licensure all the latest life
safety and health regulations shall be met. Refer to Section 4, Licensure and
Codes, item B., Application for License and item H., Revocation of
Licenses.
O. The facility
Administrator shall assure the development of policies and procedures in
accordance with Ark. Code Ann. §
20-9-307 that, upon request of the
patient, an itemized statement of all services shall be provided within 30 days
after discharge or 30 days after request, whichever is later. The policy shall
include a statement advising the patient in writing of his/her right to receive
the itemized statement of all services.
P. The facility shall establish a process for
prompt resolution of patient grievances to include the following:
1. The facility shall inform each patient
whom to contact to file a grievance.
2. The Governing Body shall approve and be
responsible for the effective operation of the grievance process unless
delegated in writing to another responsible individual.
3. The facility shall establish a clearly
explained procedure for the submission of a patient's written or verbal
grievance to the facility.
4. The
grievance process shall specify timeframes for review of the grievance and the
provisional response.
5. The
grievance process shall include a mechanism for timely referral of patient
concerns regarding quality of care to the Quality Assurance/Performance
Improvement Committee.
Q.
A physician shall pronounce the patient dead and document the date, time and
cause of death.
R. Patient care
providers not employed by the hospital, who are involved in direct patient
care, shall follow hospital policies and procedures.
S. Pursuant to A.C.A §
20-9-302 hospitals shall not
perform an abortion unless the abortion is to save the life of the pregnant
woman in a medical emergency.
SECTION
8
: PERSONNEL ADMINISTRATION.
A. Medical Attendance. The name, address, and
telephone number of the physician(s) attending each patient shall be recorded
for ready reference.
B. Qualified
Personnel. The hospital shall maintain a sufficient number of qualified
personnel to provide effective patient care and all other related services.
There shall be personnel policies and procedures available. Provisions shall be
made for orientation and continuing education.
C. Minimum Age. Personnel who care for
patients shall be a minimum of 16 years of age. For any exceptions, see Subpart
C of Part 570 of Title 29 of the Code of Federal Regulations, Child Labor
Regulations No. 3.
D. Employee
Health. It shall be the responsibility of Administration, with advice and
guidance from the Medical Staff and/or Infection Control Committee, to
establish and enforce policies concerning pre-employment physicals and employee
health. The policies shall include but are not limited to:
1. Requirements for an up-to-date health file
for each employee;
2. There shall
be measures for prevention of communicable disease outbreaks, especially
mycobacterium tuberculosis (TB). All plans for the prevention of transmission
of TB shall conform to the most current CDC Guidelines for Preventing the
Transmission of Mycobacterium Tuberculosis in Healthcare Facilities.
3. Work restrictions placed on hospital
personnel who are known to be affected with any disease in a communicable stage
or to be a carrier of such disease, to be afflicted with boils, jaundice,
infected wounds, diarrhea or acute respiratory infections. Such individuals
shall not work in any area in any capacity in which there is the likelihood of
transmitting disease to patients, hospital personnel or other individuals
within the hospital or a potential of contaminating food, food contact
surfaces, supplies or any surface with pathogenic organisms.
E. The licensure rules promulgated
by the Arkansas Department of Health for hospitals and other related
institutions shall be available to all personnel. All personnel shall be
instructed in the requirements of the rules pertaining to their respective
duties.
F. Job descriptions shall
be developed for each employee and shall include the responsibilities or actual
work to be performed. The job descriptions shall include physical, educational
and licensing or certification requirements for each job.
G. Personnel records shall be maintained for
each employee and shall include current and background information covering
qualifications for employment, records of all required health examinations,
evidence of current registration, certification, or licensure of personnel
subject to statutory regulation and an annual job specific performance
evaluation.
SECTION 9
: ADMINISTRATION REPORTS.
A. All
communicable diseases shall be immediately reported to the Arkansas Department
of Health. The institution shall furnish pertinent required information related
to the disease to the Arkansas Department of Health.
B. Occurrences which threaten the welfare,
safety or health of the public such as epidemic outbreaks, poisoning, etc.,
shall be reported either by phone or facsimile to the local or State Health
Officer. The institution shall furnish other pertinent required information
related to the occurrence to the Arkansas Department of Health.
C. Immediate capacity for disaster admissions
shall be reported daily to the Disaster Preparedness Section of the Arkansas
Department of Health.
D. The
facility shall electronically submit to the Arkansas Department of Health,
Division of Vital Statistics a report on each abortion complication diagnosed
or treated by the Facility not later than the 30th
day after the date on which the abortion complication was diagnosed or treated.
1. The report must include:
a. The name of the Physician submitting the
report and type of healthcare facility submitting the report
b. Not identify by any means the Physician
performing the abortion or the patient on whom the abortion was
performed
c. Include the most
specific, accurate, and complete reporting for the highest level of specificity
and include the following:
1) The date of the
abortion that caused or may have caused the abortion complication;
2) The type of abortion that caused or may
have caused the abortion complication;
3) The gestational age of the fetus at the
time the abortion was performed;
4)
The name and type of healthcare facility in which the abortion was
performed;
5) The date the abortion
complication was diagnosed or treated;
6) The name and type of any healthcare
facility other than the reporting healthcare facility in which the abortion
complication was diagnosed or treated;
7) A description of the abortion
complication;
8) The patient's year
of birth, race, marital status, state of residence, and county of
residence;
9) The date of the first
day of the patient's last menstrual period that occurred before the date of the
abortion that caused or may have caused the abortion complication, if
known;
10) The number of previous
live births of the patient; and
11)
The number of previous induced abortions of the patient
E. The Facility shall
report to Arkansas Department of Health, Division of Vital Statistics transfers
after midwife deliveries.
SECTION
10
: PATIENT IDENTIFICATION.
Each patient admitted to the hospital shall have an
identification bracelet applied during the admission process.
SECTION 11
: PATIENT CARE
SERVICE.
A. Organization. Nursing
Services shall be directed by a nurse executive who is a Registered Nurse
qualified by advanced education and management experience. The nurse
executive's education and experience shall be directly related to the
facility's stated mission and to the nursing care needs of the patient
population.
1. The nurse executive shall have
overall authority for the development of organization-wide nursing standards
and policies and procedures that describe how patient care needs are assessed,
evaluated and met.
2. Development
and implementation of the organization's plans for providing nursing care to
the patient shall be approved by the nurse executive.
3. Policies, procedures and standards shall
be defined, documented and accessible to the nursing staff in a written or
electronic format. Each element shall be approved by the nurse executive or
designee prior to implementation.
4. The nurse executive and nursing staff
shall collaborate with appropriate Governing Body, Medical Staff, management
and other clinical leaders in developing, implementing, revising and monitoring
patient care improvement activities.
5. The nurse executive or designee shall be
responsible for orienting and maintaining adequate numbers of qualified staff
for patient care.
6. Staff meetings
shall be conducted at least monthly for the purpose of reviewing the quality of
nursing care provided. Meeting minutes and attendance shall be
maintained.
7. If the organization
provides clinical facilities for nursing students, there shall be a written
agreement that defines:
a. The facility's
responsibilities; and
b.
Responsibilities of the educational institution, including supervision of
students and responsibilities of the instructor.
8. Clinically relevant in-service educational
programs shall be conducted at regularly scheduled intervals not less than 12
times per year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendees, and
subject matter.
9. There shall be a
continuous QI program that is specific to the patient care administered. The
program shall reflect nursing staff participation including reports to
appropriate hospital committees.
B. Qualifications.
1. A current, valid license to practice
nursing in Arkansas shall be held by all nurses hired in the facility as well
as private duty and contract/pool nurses. There shall be a procedure to assure
all licenses are current.
2.
Licensed nursing personnel shall practice under the Nurse Practice Act of the
State of Arkansas and current Arkansas State Board of Nursing Rules and
Regulations.
3. The qualifications
required for each category of nursing staff shall be in written policy. Job
descriptions shall be available for review.
4. There shall be documented evidence of
appropriate training for all nonlicensed staff who are assigned patient care
duties.
5. The nurse executive or
designee(s) participates with administration in decisions relative to the
selection and promotion of nursing personnel based on qualifications and
capabilities and recommends the termination of employment when
necessary.
6. All licensed nursing
personnel shall be competent in life support measures.
C. Staffing.
There shall be an adequate number of Registered Nurses on duty
at all times and available for bedside care of any patient when needed on a
24-hour basis. In addition, there shall be sufficient Registered Nurses to
staff all patient care units. A Registered Nurse shall assign the nursing care
of each patient to other nursing personnel in accordance with the patient's
needs and the preparation and competence of the nursing staff. There shall be
written criteria to substantiate the assignments.
D. Evaluation and Review of Patient Care
Services.
1. There shall be established
working relationships with other services of the hospital, both administrative
and professional. The factors explaining the standard are as follows:
a. Registered Nurses confer with the
physicians relative to patient care;
b. Interdepartmental policies affecting
patient care are made jointly with the nurse executive or designee(s);
and
c. Procedures are established
for scheduling laboratory and X-ray examinations, for ordering, securing, and
maintaining supplies and equipment needed for patient care and for ordering
diets, etc.
2. There
shall be on-going review and evaluation of nursing care provided for patients.
a. A Registered Nurse plans, supervises, and
evaluates the nursing care for each patient in all settings where nursing care
is provided.
b. Each patient shall
have a plan for provision of care. Each patient plan of care shall be current.
Plans indicate patient care required, how it is to be accomplished, and the
methods, approaches, goals, and modifications necessary to ensure best results
for the patient. The patient's plan of care shall be initiated upon
admission.
c. There shall be
documentation of the nursing care provided. The following information shall be
documented:
1) The initial patient
assessment;
2) Date and time of
treatments and/or dressing changes;
3) Medication Administration Record (MAR)
including the date, time, dosage and manner of administration and the initials
of the nurse administering the medication. When personnel other than nursing
administer medication and the MAR is not utilized, a record of that ancillary
department shall comply with this requirement and be included in the medical
record;
4) Date, time, dosage and
manner of administration of all PRN medications to include reason for
administration and results;
5)
Bedtime and between meal snacks or feedings and the percentage of diets
consumed;
6) Change in patient's
appearance and/or condition;
7)
Patient complaints; and
8) Mode of
discharge and to whom the patient was discharged. If a patient expires, the
time the physician was called, time arrived, the time the patient was
pronounced dead and the fact that relatives were present shall be recorded. (If
relatives were not present, a note shall be made regarding their notification
and disposition of the patient's belongings).
d. A Registered Nurse shall observe each
patient at least once per shift and the observations shall be documented in the
patient's medical record.
NOTE: Block charting and co signatures are not
acceptable.
E. Patient Care Facilities and Equipment.
1. There shall be no more beds maintained in
the building than the number of beds for which the hospital is licensed except
in the case of a public disaster or national emergency and then only as a
temporary measure.
2. No beds shall
be in the hallway or on the floor except in case of emergency.
3. Children under the age of 16 years shall
not be cared for in a room with an unrelated adult patient.
4. Provisions shall be made for safe storage
of patients' valuables.
5. All
facilities for cleaning and storage of patient care supplies and equipment
shall be used only for the purpose for which they are designed.
6. Thermometers shall not come in contact
with more than one patient without disinfection or proper covers.
7. All single-use equipment used by a patient
shall either be sent home with the patient at the time of discharge or
destroyed.
8. Only currently dated
equipment and supplies shall be available for patient care. All equipment shall
be kept clean and in good condition.
9. Observation is a designated patient status
as opposed to a designated area. Patients in observation status are those
patients requiring periodic monitoring and assessment necessary to evaluate the
patient's condition or to determine the need for possible admission to the
hospital in an inpatient status. Usually observation status shall be for 48
hours or less.
Patients in observation status may be accommodated within the
facility:
a. In private, semi-private
or multi-patient rooms. Furniture shall be arranged to provide adequate room
for patient care procedures and to prevent the transmission of
infection;
b. Cubicle curtains,
privacy screens, or an approved equivalent shall be provided for patient
privacy in all multi-patient rooms. The utilization of such curtains or screens
shall be such that each patient shall have complete privacy;
c. Each room or cubicle shall be provided
with oxygen, vacuum and a nurse call button;
d. Hand hygiene facilities shall be available
within the area;
e. Hospital grade
furniture shall be provided. Bed rails shall be provided on beds;
f. For each area in which a patient bed is
utilized, a reading light shall be provided for each bed. The location and
design shall be such that the light is not annoying to other
patients;
g. Patient toilets shall
be provided and accessible to all patients; and
h. Adequate space shall be provided for
medical supplies.
Patients that remain in observation status for a period of 24
hours or more shall have provided to them accommodations equivalent to the
accommodations they would have if they were admitted as an inpatient.
SECTION
12
: MEDICATIONS.
A.
All medical orders (medications and treatments) shall be in writing and signed
by the prescriber. Telephone/verbal orders should be used infrequently. When
used they shall be given only to licensed nurses and signed by the
prescriber.
B. No medication shall
be dispensed or administered without a written order signed by a licensed
prescriber. A pharmacist may receive telephone or verbal orders for medications
from a prescriber and record them on the medical record.
C. Medications shall be administered by
licensed nursing personnel in accordance with the current Arkansas Nurse
Practice Act. Other personnel may administer medications only in accordance
with their current Practice Act (e.g., Respiratory, Physical
Therapy).
D. Blood transfusions and
intravenous medications administered by licensed nursing personnel shall be in
accordance with State law. If not administered by a Registered Nurse, only
licensed nursing personnel who have documentation of training shall be
permitted to administer blood transfusions and intravenous
medications.
E. There shall be an
effective hospital procedure for reporting transfusion reactions and adverse
medication reactions.
F. All
medications shall be properly labeled and stored in a specifically designated
medication cabinet, cart or room. At nursing stations, medications shall only
be accessible to licensed nursing personnel and pharmacists. In specialty units
and treatment areas, medications shall only be accessible to licensed nursing
personnel, pharmacists, and designated licensed personnel consistent with that
unit (e.g., Respiratory, Physical Therapy).
G. Refrigeration shall be provided for the
proper storage of biologicals and other medications. Medications shall be
stored in a separate compartment or area from food. Employee foods and/or
medications shall be stored in a separate refrigeration area. An internal
thermometer shall be provided and checked daily (or at least weekly when the
unit is closed) with documentation to assure temperatures between 36°-
46° Fahrenheit (two to eight degrees Centigrade). Refrigerated controlled
substances shall meet the requirement for double-lock security.
H. Unused or damaged medications shall be
returned to the pharmacy. All medications with incorrect or soiled labels shall
be returned to the pharmacy for relabeling.
I. In addition to patients' medical records,
a record of the procurement and disposition of each controlled substance shall
be maintained at each nursing and specialty unit. Each entry on the disposition
record shall reflect the actual dosage administered to the patient, the
patient's name, the date, time, and signature of the licensed person
administering the medication. (Licensed personnel who may legally administer
controlled substances shall include only those personnel authorized by their
current Practice Act. Any error of entry on the disposition record shall follow
a policy for correction of errors and accurate accountability. If the licensed
person who procures the medication from the double-lock security is not the
licensed person who administers the medication, then both persons shall sign
the disposition record.
J. When
breakage or wastage of a controlled substance occurs, the amount given and the
amount wasted shall be recorded by the licensed person who wasted the
medication and verified by the signature of a licensed person who witnessed the
wastage. Documentation shall include or policy shall delineate how the
medication was wasted. In addition to the above referenced licensed personnel
(see I), licensed Pharmacists shall be allowed to witness wastage of controlled
substances. When a licensed person is not available to witness wastage, the
partial dose shall be sent to the Arkansas Department of Health, Pharmacy
Services and Drug Control for destruction.
K. here shall be an audit each shift change
of all controlled substances stocked on the unit. At nursing stations such
counts shall be recorded by the oncoming nurse and witnessed by the off-going
nurse. At other units, audits shall be performed by two licensed personnel. In
each case, both licensed personnel shall sign the record with notation made as
to date and time of the audit. If discrepancies are noted, the Director of
Nursing, the Department Director, as applicable, and the Director of Pharmacy
shall be notified. As with the witnessing of wastage, licensed Pharmacists
shall be allowed to witness controlled substance audits.
L. If specialty units are not staffed on
every shift, controlled substances shall be audited by two licensed personnel
on each shift that is covered by licensed personnel.
M. Controlled substances in areas that are
covered only by on-call personnel shall be audited each shift the area is used
and at least weekly; whichever time frame is less.
N. Solutions and medications for "external
use only" shall be kept separate from other medications.
O. When a patient is discharged, the unused
portion of the patient's medication may be sent home with the patient on direct
written order of the attending physician; and only after the medication has
been relabeled by the pharmacy. Documentation shall include the amount
dispensed to the patient and quantities shall be consistent with the immediate
needs of the patient.
P. Policies
and procedures shall be developed and implemented for the handling of
medications brought into the facility by the patient.
Q. All medication errors and adverse drug
reactions shall be reported to the attending physician. A copy of all
medications errors and adverse drug reactions shall be sent to the Director of
Nursing or designee, QA/PI Committee and when appropriate, to the Director of
Pharmacy.
R. Records generated by
Automatic Medication Distribution Devices shall comply with these rules.
Policies and Procedures for the usage of Automatic Medication Distribution
Devices shall be approved administratively by Health Facility Services prior to
their usage.
S. Drug Security.
1. The pharmacist, with support from the
Pharmacy and Therapeutics (P&T) Committee, is ultimately responsible for
drug security throughout the facility; applicable licensed personnel at nursing
and specialty units shall maintain the daily security of medications at their
respective units.
2. Access to
medications shall be limited to designated licensed personnel at all
times.
3. Medications dispensed to
nursing and specialty units shall be kept locked in accordance with all Federal
and State regulations.
4.
Emergency-type medications (crash cart, crash kit), as approved by the P&T
Committee, shall be secured with a breakaway seal under the following
conditions:
a. The quantities of medication
are limited;
b. A list of
medications stocked with quantities listed is posted on the emergency cart or
container;
c. The breakage of the
seal clearly indicates that entry has occurred (and said broken seal cannot be
repaired without obvious evidence);
d. Any remaining medications shall be secured
and accessible only to licensed personnel whenever the seal has been broken and
before a new seal is installed;
e.
Applicable personnel shall check the cart for the integrity of the seal each
shift. Documentation shall reflect that the seal is intact. The emergency cart
shall be stored in an area observable by licensed personnel;
f. The quantities of a controlled substance
stocked in a cart or container shall be limited to a maximum of two single
doses of Schedule III, IV, or V drugs. No Schedule II drugs shall be included
in this stock; and
g. Pharmacy
Services shall check the condition of the carts or containers as part of the
monthly inspections of nursing and specialty units.
5. Controlled substances maintained as floor
stock at nursing and specialty units shall be stored separately from other
medication under double-lock security.
6. For patient safety, Schedule III, IV, and
V controlled substances in unit dose packages and dispensed in quantities
limited to a maximum of a two-day supply, may be stored with that patient's
other medication.
7. All
medications shall be locked in the absence of immediate visual supervision by
licensed personnel.
8. When a
hospital operates an outpatient pharmacy that stocks medications in various
clinical areas, stock lists, records, and security measures shall be in
compliance with the requirements for nursing and specialty units.
9. Distribution of sample legend medications
shall not be permitted by hospitals. Samples are defined as any prescription
only medication which is not intended to be sold and is intended to promote the
sale of the medication.
10.
Medication security as provided by Automatic Medication Distribution Devices
shall comply with these rules. Policies and procedures for security provisions
shall be approved administratively by Health Facility Services prior to usage
of Automatic Medication Distribution Devices.
SECTION 13
: RESTRAINTS.
A. Restraint use should be implemented in the
least restrictive manner possible, applied in accordance with safe and
appropriate techniques and ended at the earliest possible time.
B. Each order for the application of
restraints shall be time limited and shall include the type of restraint to be
used. Restraints orders shall not be written as a standing order or on an as
needed basis (PRN).
C. Restraints
either physical or chemical shall be applied only after less restrictive
measures have failed. Restraints shall not be used as a matter of convenience
for the staff or as a tool for disciplining the patient. When the use of a
restraint is clinically indicated, it shall be used only in accordance with the
order of a physician or non- physician licensed medical professional who has
been appropriately credentialed by the medical staff with approval by the
governing body.
D. Documentation of
a comprehensive assessment and modification to the plan of care shall include
the less restrictive measures attempted, justification for the continued need
of restraint and that the patient and/or significant other has been informed of
the reason for restraint use.
E.
Documentation in the patient's record regarding any type of restraint shall
include the times the restraint was applied, released, and discontinued, as
well as evidence of continual assessment, monitoring and re-evaluation of the
patient's condition during the restraint incident.
F. When restraint use is ordered by other
than the attending physician, the attending physician shall be informed as soon
as possible.
G. Patients in leather
or locked restraints shall be under constant observation.
H. All staff that have direct patient contact
shall have ongoing education and training in the proper and safe use of
restraints.
SECTION 14
: HEALTH INFORMATION SERVICES.
A.
General Requirements.
1. A medical record
shall be maintained for each patient admitted for care in the
hospital.
2. The original or a copy
of the original (when the original is not available) of all reports shall be
filed in the medical record.
3. The
record shall be permanent and shall be either typewritten or legibly written in
blue or black ink.
4. All
typewritten reports shall include the date of dictation and the date of
transcription.
5. All dictated
records shall be transcribed within 48 hours.
6. Errors shall be corrected by drawing a
single line through the incorrect data, labeling it as "Error," initialing, and
dating the entry.
7. Additional
patient records room requirements are provided in Section 61, Physical
Facilities, and Health Information Unit.
8. Disease, operation, and physicians'
indices shall be maintained (manual, abstract, or computer). Records shall be
indexed within one month following discharge. Indices maintained on computer
shall be retrievable at any time for research or quality assurance/performance
improvement monitoring.
9. Records
of discharged patients shall be coded in accordance to accepted coding
practices. Records shall be coded within one month of the patient's dictated
discharge summary.
10. Relevant
educational programs shall be conducted at regularly scheduled intervals with
no less than 12 per year. There shall be written documentation with employee
signatures, program title/subject, presenter, date, and outlines or narrative
of presented program.
11. A Master
Patient Index shall be maintained by the Health Information Services. Index
information shall include at least the full name, address, birth date, and the
medical record number of the patient. The index may be maintained manually or
on computer and shall contain the dates of all patient visits to the facility.
If the Index is maintained on computer, there shall be a policy and procedure
on permanent maintenance.
12. Birth
certificates shall be completed according to the current rules and regulations
of Vital Records, Arkansas Department of Health.
13. A unit record system shall be maintained.
A unit record is defined as all inpatient and outpatient visits for each
patient being filed together in one unit.
14. A policy and procedure manual for the
Health Information Management Department shall be developed. The manual shall
have evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual
shall have the annual review date, signature of the department supervisor
and/or person(s) conducting the review.
15. A qualified individual shall be employed
to direct the hospital's Health Information Department. If a Registered Health
Information Administrator (RHIA) or a Registered Health Information Technician
(RHIT) is not employed as Director on a full-time basis by the hospital, a
consultant shall make periodic visits to evaluate functions of the Department
and train personnel.
16. All
patient records, whether stored within the Health Information Management
Department or other areas, either within the facility or away from the
facility, shall be protected from destruction by fire, water, vermin, dust,
etc.
17. Medical records shall be
considered confidential. Only authorized personnel shall have access to the
medical records. All medical records (including those filed outside the
department) shall be secured at all times. If authorized personnel are not
available, the department shall be locked. Records shall be available to
authorized personnel from the Arkansas Department of Health.
18. Release of medical information shall be
restricted by the facility's policies and procedures.
19. All medical records shall be retained in
either the original, microfilm or other acceptable methods for 10 years after
the last discharge. After 10 years a medical record may be destroyed provided
the facility permanently maintains the information contained in the Master
Patient Index.
Complete medical records of minors shall be retained for a
period of two years after the age of majority.
20. Procedures shall be developed for the
retention and accessibility of the patients' medical records if the hospital or
other facility closes. The medical records shall be stored for the required
retention period and shall be accessible for patient use.
21. All entries into the medical record shall
be legible. There shall be no erasures or obliterations of the original
information contained in a medical record.
22. Medical records shall be complete and
contain all required signed documentation (including physician reports) no
later than 30 days following the patient's discharge date.
23. Patient records shall be destroyed by
burning or shredding. Patient records shall not be disposed of in landfills or
other refuse collection sites.
24.
A QA/PI program shall be continuous and specific to the services.
25. In the event of a physician's death or
permanent incapacitation, incomplete medical records shall be reviewed in a
manner approved by the Medical Staff. Approval to file incomplete medical
records shall be obtained in a manner approved by the Medical Staff and a
statement explaining the circumstances be placed in each record.
B. Authentication of Medical
Record Entries.
1. Each entry into the medical
record shall be authenticated by the individual who is the source of the
information. Entries shall include all documents, observations, notes, and any
other information included in the record.
2. Signatures shall be at least, the first
initial, last name and title. Computerized signatures may be either by code,
number, initials, or the method developed by the facility.
3. The hospital's Medical Staff and Governing
Body shall adopt a policy regarding dictation that permits authentication by
electronic or computer generated signature. The policy shall identify those
categories of the staff within the hospital that are authorized to authenticate
patient records using electronic or computer generated signatures.
4. At a minimum, the policy shall include
adequate safeguards to ensure confidentiality.
a. Each user shall be assigned a unique
identifier which is generated through a confidential code.
b. The policy shall include penalties for
inappropriate use of the identifier.
c. The user shall certify, in writing, that
he or she is the only person authorized to use the signature code.
d. The hospital shall periodically monitor
the use of identifiers; the process by which the monitoring shall be conducted
shall be described in the policy.
5. The system shall make an opportunity
available to the user to verify that the document is accurate and the signature
has been properly recorded.
6. Each
report generated by a user shall be separately authenticated.
7. A user may terminate authorization for use
of electronic or computer generated signature upon written notice to the
Director of Health Information Services.
8. Rubber stamp signatures shall be
acceptable if a letter from the physician is on file explaining that the
physician shall be the only person using the stamp and the stamp shall remain
in his/her possession at all times. The signature stamp shall be the full legal
name of the physician with his/her professional title.
9. Transcribed reports dictated by other than
the attending physician shall be signed by the credentialed individual
dictating the report and the attending physician. Dictation of reports by other
than the attending physician is limited to history, physical, discharge
summary, operative reports and progress notes. Reports dictated by resident
physicians for training purposes require only the signature of the attending
physician.
C. Electronic
Health Information
1. Policies and procedures
governing electronic health information within the organization and with
external entities shall be adopted by the Governing Body.
2. The policies and procedures shall provide
for the use, exchange, security and privacy of electronic health information.
The policies and procedures shall provide for standardized and authorized
availability of electronic health information for patient care, administrative
purposes and research. The policies and procedures will be in compliance with
current guidelines and standards as established in federal and state
status.
D. Record
Content.
1. Identification data shall include
at least the following:
a. Patient's full name
- maiden name if applicable;
b.
Patient's address, telephone number, and occupation;
c. Date of birth;
d. Age;
e. Sex;
f. Marital status (M.S.D.W.);
g. Dates and times of admission and
discharge;
h. Full name of
physician;
i. Name and address of
nearest relative or person or agency responsible for patient and occupation of
responsible party;
j. Name,
address, and telephone number of person(s) to notify in case of emergency;
and,
k. Medical record
number.
2. A general
consent for medical treatment and care. This shall be signed by the patient or
guardian. Written or verbal consent shall not release the hospital or its
personnel from upholding the rights of its patients including but not limited
to the right to privacy, dignity, security, confidentiality, and freedom from
abuse or neglect.
3. A consent for
a do-not-resuscitate order or otherwise withholding or withdrawing treatment of
a minor.
a. The consent shall:
1. Include the written or verbal consent of
at least one parent or guardian of the minor;
2. Include the signature of two (2) witnesses
attesting the consent was given by at least one parent or guardian when the
consent was given verbally'
3. Be
documented in the minor's medical record, specifying the parent or guardian who
gave consent, the witnesses present, and the date and time the consent was
obtained.
b. The consent
does not apply if the minor is married, pregnant, emancipated, or incarcerated
in the Division of Corrections, or the Division of Community Corrections, or in
the custody of the Department of Human Service.
c. Does not apply if a reasonable diligent
effort of at least seventy-two (72) without success has been made to contact
and inform each know parent or guardian of intent to issue a do-not-resuscitate
order or otherwise withhold or withdraw treatment so as to allow the natural
death of a minor.
d. The parent or
guardian may revoke the consent verbally or in writing.
4. Clinical reports shall include the
following and shall comply with listed requirements:
a. A History and Physical Examination (HPE)
shall be in the patient's medical record within 48 hours of the patient's
admission to the facility.
The HPE must be authenticated by the attending or treating
physician and shall contain the following:
1) Family (medical) history and review of
systems - if noncontributory, the record shall reflect such;
2) Past medical history;
3) Chief complaint(s) - a brief statement of
nature and duration of the symptoms that caused the patient to seek medical
attention as stated in the patient's own words;
4) Present illness with dates or approximate
dates of onset;
5) Physical
examination;
6) Provisional or
admitting diagnosis(es); and
7)
History and physical examinations may be completed up to 30 days prior to
admission if the examination is updated at the time of admission. The updated
HPE must be authenticated by the attending or treating physician.
b. Progress notes shall be
recorded, dated and signed. The frequency of the physician's progress notes
shall be determined by the patient's condition. Dictated progress notes are
acceptable and shall be placed in the patient's medical record within 48
hours.
c. Orders including verbal
orders shall be authenticated with a legible and dated signature in a timely
manner as defined by Medical Staff By-Laws.
d. A discharge summary shall recapitulate the
significant findings and events of the patient's hospitalization and his/her
condition on discharge. The discharge summary must be authenticated by the
attending or treating physician within 30 days of the patient's discharge. The
final diagnosis shall be stated in the discharge summary.
e. Autopsy findings shall be documented in
complete protocol within 60 days and the provisional anatomical diagnosis shall
be recorded within 72 hours. A signed authorization for autopsy shall be
obtained from the next of kin and documented in the medical record before an
autopsy is performed.
f. Original,
signed diagnostic reports (laboratory, X-rays, CATs, SCANs, EKGs, fetal
monitoring, EEGs) shall be filed in the patient's medical record. Physicians'
orders shall accompany all treatment procedures. Fetal monitor and EEG tracings
may be filed separately from the medical record if accessible when
needed.
g. Reports of ancillary
services (Dietary, Physical Therapy, Respiratory Care, Social Services, etc.)
shall be included in the patient's medical record.
h. Reports of Medical Consultation, if
ordered by the attending physician, shall be included in the patient's medical
record within time frames established by the Medical Staff.
E. Records of
Complementary Departments. In addition to the general record content
requirements stated above, parts F., G. and H. are required, as
applicable.
F. Surgery Records.
1. A specific consent for surgery shall be
documented prior to the surgery/procedure to be performed, except in cases of
emergency, and shall include the date, time and signatures of the patient and
witness. Consent shall be obtained by the surgeon and documented in the
patient's medical record. (Abbreviations are not acceptable.)
2. A History and Physical Examination (HPE)
on admission containing medical history and physical findings shall be
documented in the patient's medical record prior to surgery. In cases of
emergency surgery, an abbreviated physical examination, and a brief description
of why the surgery is necessary shall be included in the HPE. (See Section 14,
Health Information Services, Record Content.) The HPE must be authenticated by
the attending or treating physician or surgeon.
3. An anesthesia report, including
preoperative evaluation and postoperative assessment, shall be documented by
the Anesthesiologist and/or Certified Registered Nurse Anesthetist (CRNA). The
pre-evaluation and post assessment shall be dated and timed.
a. Preoperative anesthesia evaluation shall
be completed prior to the patient's surgery.
b. Report of Anesthesia. A CRNA who has not
been granted authority by a facility, as a DEA registrant, to order the
administration of controlled substances shall give all orders as verbal orders
from the supervising physician, dentist, or other person lawfully entitled to
order an anesthetic.
c. Post
anesthesia assessment shall be documented in the medical record prior to the
patient's discharge, not to exceed 48 hours after the patient's surgery. If the
patient is in need of continued observation, the anesthetist shall be readily
available. Discharge criteria shall be established and approved by the Medical
Staff and Governing Body. If the patient meets the discharge criteria within a
three-hour period postoperatively, a post anesthesia assessment is not
required.
4. An
individualized operative report shall be written or dictated by the physician
or surgeon immediately following surgery and shall be signed within 72 hours.
The report shall describe (in detail) techniques, findings, pre and
postoperative diagnosis, and tissues removed.
5. A signed pathological report shall be
maintained in the medical record of all tissue surgically removed. A specific
list of tissues exempt from pathological examination shall be developed by the
Medical Staff.
G.
Obstetrical Records.
1. A pertinent prenatal
record shall be updated upon admission, or history and physical examination
signed by the physician shall be available upon the patient's admission and be
maintained in the patient's medical record.
2. A record of labor and delivery,
authenticated by the physician, shall be maintained for every Obstetrical
patient.
3. Documentation of the
patient's recovery from delivery shall be maintained.
4. Nurses' postpartum record, graphics and
nurses' notes shall be maintained.
H. Newborn Records.
1. A newborn history and physical examination
shall be completed by the physician within 24 hours of birth. The following
additional data shall be required:
a. History
of the newborn delivery (sex, date of birth, type of delivery, and anesthesia
given the mother during labor and delivery); and
b. Physical examination (weight, date, time
of birth, and condition of infant after birth).
2. There shall be a consent for circumcision
(if applicable).
3. A procedure
note for circumcision shall be documented by the physician.
4. A discharge note or summary describing the
condition of the newborn at discharge and follow-up instructions given to the
mother must be prepared and included in the medical record. The discharge note
or summary must be authenticated by the attending or treating
physician.
5. Hospitals shall
comply with State Law and Health Department requirements for newborn testing.
See Rules Pertaining to Testing of Newborn Infants and Ark.
Code Ann. §
20-15-301 et seq.
6. Birth certificates shall be completed on
all infants born in the hospital, or admitted as a result of birth in
accordance with the requirements of Vital Records, Arkansas Department of
Health.
SECTION
15
: MEDICAL RECORD REQUIREMENTS FOR OUTPATIENT SERVICES,
EMERGENCY ROOM AND OBSERVATION SERVICES.
A. Outpatient Records. An Outpatient record
shall be completed for each outpatient and shall include the following:
1. History and physical examination of the
patient (not applicable if for diagnostic services and/or outpatient therapy
services);
2. Orders and reports of
diagnostic services and outpatient therapy services;
3. Patient's diagnosis and summary of
treatment received recorded by the attending physician;
4. Documentation of any medications
administered;
5. Progress notes for
subsequent clinic visits recorded by applicable disciplines
(practitioners);
6. Outpatient
surgery record requirements (See also item F. of Section 14, Health Information
Services.); and
7. Discharge
instructions.
B.
Emergency Room Records. An Emergency Room Record shall be completed for each
patient who presents for treatment at the Emergency Room and shall include the
following:
1. Patient
identification;
2. Date and the
following times:
a. Admission;
b. Time physician was notified of patient's
presence in the Emergency Room;
c.
Time of physician's arrival if applicable; and
d. Discharge.
3. History (when the injury or onset of
symptoms occurred);
4. Vital
signs;
5. Nurses' assessment and
physical findings;
6.
Diagnosis;
7. Record of treatment
including documentation of verbal orders and of medication quantities
administered with the initials of person(s) administering the medications.
Also, type and amount of local anesthetic, if administered;
8. Diagnostic reports with specific orders
noted;
9. Instructions to patients
for follow-up care (e.g., do not drive after receiving sedatives, return to
physician's office for removal of sutures in one week);
10. Disposition of case;
11. Signature of patient or his/her
representative;
12. Signed and
dated discharge order; and
13. The
ambulance record shall be transferred with the patient.
NOTE: Emergency Room Records shall be completed within 24 hours
of the patient's visit.
C. Observation Records. A record of every
patient admitted to an observation status shall be maintained. The observation
record shall include, at a minimum:
1. Patient
identification data;
2. Physician's
diagnosis and therapeutic orders dated and timed;
3. History and physical;
4. Physician's progress notes, including
results of treatment;
5. Nursing
assessment by a Registered Nurse;
6. Nursing observations;
7. Results of all diagnostic
testing;
8. Medication
Administration Record;
9.
Allergies;
10. Patient
education;
11. Plan for follow-up
treatment; and
12. Referrals.
NOTE: Observation records shall be completed on patients who
stay less than 24 hours.
D. Psychiatric Records. The basic medical
record requirements for psychiatric patients shall be the same as for other
patient records, with the following additions:
1. The identification data shall include the
patient's legal status (on the face sheet);
2. A proper consent or authority for
admission shall be included;
3. A
psychiatric evaluation shall be completed by the attending physician within 60
hours of admission which includes the following:
a. The patient's chief complaints and/or
reaction to hospitalization, recorded in patient's own words, if
possible;
b. History of present
illness including onset and reason for current admission;
c. Past history of any psychiatric problems
and treatment, including a record of patient's activities (social, education,
vocational, interpersonal and family relationships);
d. Past psychiatric history of patient's
family;
e. Mental status which
includes at least attitude and general behavior, affect, stream of mental
activity, presence or absence of delusions and hallucinations, estimate of
intellectual functions, judgment and an assessment of orientation and
memory;
f. Strengths such as
knowledge, interests, skills, aptitudes, experience, education and employment
status written in descriptive terms to be used in developing the Master
Treatment Plan; and
g. Diagnostic
impressions and recommendations.
4. A history and physical examination shall
be documented by a physician and shall include a neurological examination
within 24 hours of admission.
5.
Social service records, including report of interviews with patient, family
members and others shall be included for each admission. Social assessment and
plan of care shall be completed within 48 hours of admission.
6. Reports of consultation, psychological
evaluations, reports of electroencephalograms, dental records and reports of
special studies shall be included in the records when applicable.
7. An Interdisciplinary Master Treatment Plan
shall be developed for each patient and included in the medical record, within
60 hours of admission. The treatment plan shall involve all staff who have
contact with the patient and shall include (as a minimum):
a. Problems and needs relevant to admission
and discharge as identified in the various assessments, expressed in behavioral
and descriptive terms;
b. Strengths
(assets) including skills and interests;
c. Problems, both physical and mental, that
require therapeutic management;
d.
Long and short term goals describing the desired action or behavior to be
achieved. Goals shall be relevant, observable and measurable;
e. Treatment modalities individualized in
relation to patient's needs;
f.
Evidence of patient's involvement in formulation of the plan;
g. Realistic discharge and aftercare
plans;
h. Nursing assessment and
progress notes integrated into the Master Treatment Plan. Reviews and revisions
of the Nursing Plan of Care shall be as required under the Section 11, Patient
Care Service;
i. Signatures of all
staff involved;
j. Date Master
Treatment Plan was implemented; and
k. Staff
responsibilities.
8. The
treatment received by the patient shall be documented in such a manner and with
such frequency as to assure that all active therapeutic efforts such as
individual and group psychotherapy, medication therapy, milieu therapy,
occupational therapy, industrial or work therapy, nursing care and other
therapeutic interventions are included.
9. Progress notes shall be recorded by the
physician, social worker and others involved in active treatment modalities at
least as often as the patient is seen. The notes shall contain recommendations
for revisions in the treatment plan.
10. Nursing notes shall be written as
required under the Section 11, Patient Care Service.
11. The discharge summary shall include a
recapitulation of the patient's hospitalization and recommendations from
appropriate services concerning follow- up of aftercare, as well as a brief
summary of the patient's condition on discharge.
12. The psychiatric diagnosis contained in
the final diagnosis and included in the discharge summary shall be written in
the terminology of the current American Psychiatric Association's Diagnostic
and Statistical Manual.
SECTION 16
: PHARMACY.
All hospitals shall have adequate provision for pharmaceutical
services regarding the procurement, storage, distribution and control of all
medications. There shall be compliance with all federal and state regulations,
including Laws and Regulations - Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy.
A. Definitions.
1. Hospital Pharmacy means the place or
places in which drugs, chemicals, medicines, prescriptions or poisons are
prepared for distribution and administration for the use and/or benefit of
patients in a hospital licensed by the Arkansas Department of Health. The
Hospital Pharmacy shall also mean the place or places in which drugs,
chemicals, medicines, prescriptions or poisons are compounded for the
dispensing to hospital employees, members of the immediate families of hospital
employees, patients being discharged, and other persons in emergency
situations. Hospital Pharmacy shall also mean the provision of pharmaceutical
services as defined in the Pharmacy Practice Act by a pharmacist to a patient
of the hospital.
2. Hospital
Employee means any individual employed by the hospital whose compensation for
services or labor actually performed for a hospital is reflected on the payroll
records of a hospital.
3. Qualified
Hospital Personnel means persons other than Licensed Pharmacists who perform
duties in conjunction with the overall hospital pharmaceutical services for
inpatients.
4. Licensed Pharmacist
means any person licensed to practice pharmacy by the Arkansas State Board of
Pharmacy who provides pharmaceutical services as defined in the Pharmacy
Practice Act to patients of the hospital.
5. Unit Dose Distribution System is a
pharmacy-coordinated method of dispensing and controlling medications in
hospitals in which medications are dispensed in single unit packages for a
specific patient on orders of a physician where not more than a 24-hour supply
of said medication is dispensed, delivered, or available to the
patient.
6. Modified Unit Dose
Distribution System is a system that meets the requirement of a "Unit Dose
Distribution System," provided that up to a 72-hour supply may be sent to the
floor once a week if the system has been reviewed and approved administratively
by the Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy.
B. Hospitals maintaining and using mechanical
storage and delivery machines for legend drugs shall have such machines stocked
only by Pharmacy Services. Drugs may be obtained from such machines only by
licensed personnel in accordance with their Practice Act acting under the
prescribed rules of safety procedures as promulgated by the individual hospital
using said machine.
Limited amounts of Schedule II-V controlled substances may be
stocked in the machines provided the following requirements are met:
1. Pharmacy Services possesses the only key
necessary to stock the machine; and
2. Policies and Procedures specify the
licensed personnel having access and responsibility for the medications.
The person removing a medication for administration shall
record at least the patient's name and the name, strength, and amount of
medication on a record that is maintained by the Pharmacy Department. The
record shall also be signed by the person removing the medication. The removal
of controlled substances shall comply with the record keeping requirements of
Section 12, Medications. Pharmacy Services shall audit stock levels as needed
to replace medications. Use of the machines shall not be to circumvent adequate
pharmaceutical services.
C. Compounding, Dispensing and Distributing.
1. Compounding. The act of selecting, mixing,
combining, measuring, counting, or otherwise preparing a drug or
medication.
2. Dispensing. A
function restricted to licensed pharmacists, which involves the issuance of:
a. One or more doses of a medication in
containers other than the original, with such new containers being properly
labeled by the dispenser as to content and/or directions for use as directed by
the prescriber;
b. Medication in
its original container with a pharmacy prepared label that carries to the
patient the directions of the prescriber as well as other vital information;
and/or
c. A package carrying a
label prepared for nursing station use. The contents of the container may be
for one patient (individual prescription) or for several patients (such as a
nursing station medication container).
3. Distributing. Distributing, in the context
of this regulation, refers to the movement of a medication from a central point
to a nursing station medication center. The medication shall be in the
originally labeled manufacturer's container or in a prepackaged container
labeled according to federal and state laws and regulations, by a pharmacist or
under his direct and immediate supervision.
D. Pharmacy and Therapeutics Committee. There
is a committee of the Medical Staff to confer with the pharmacist in the
formulation of policies, explained as follows:
1. A Pharmacy and Therapeutics (P&T)
Committee, composed of at least one (1) physician, the Administrator or
representative, the director of nursing service or representative, and the
pharmacist is established in the hospital. It represents the organizational
line of communication and the liaison between the Medical Staff and the
pharmacist;
2. The Committee
assists in the formulation of broad, professional policies regarding the
evaluation, appraisal, selection, procurement, storage, distribution, use, and
safety procedures in conformance with Food and Drug Administration and
manufacturers' bulletins on the safe administration of drugs and all other
matters relating to drugs in hospitals;
3. The Committee performs the following
specific functions:
a. Serves as an advisory
group to the hospital Medical Staff and pharmacist on matters pertaining to the
choice of drugs;
b. Develops and
approves the drug formulary and all drug lists annually and makes interim
revisions as needed;
c. Establishes
standards concerning the use and control of investigational drugs and research
in the use of recognized drugs;
d.
Evaluates clinical data concerning new drugs or preparations requested for use
in the hospital;
e. Makes
recommendations concerning drugs to be stocked on the nursing unit floors and
emergency drug stocks;
f. Prevents
unnecessary duplication in stocking drugs and drugs in combination having
identical amounts of the same therapeutic ingredients; and
g. Reviews and approves drug-related policies
and procedures; and
4.
The Committee develops and approves policies and procedures for all nursing
personnel assigned the responsibility of preparing and administering
intravenous (IV) admixtures. The pharmacist shall be involved in the review of
the drug order, calculations, and preparation whenever possible. The Committee
should consider the appropriate category of personnel (Registered Nurse or LPN)
and degree of training necessary to make judgments and calculations involved in
IV admixture programs;
5. The
Committee assures that medications dispensed to outpatients, Emergency Room
patients and discharged patients comply with all federal and state laws and
regulations;
6. The Committee meets
at least quarterly and reports to the Medical Staff by written
report.
E. Pharmacy
Operations. The hospital has a pharmacy directed by a licensed pharmacist.
The pharmacy is administered in accordance with accepted
professional principles.
1. Pharmacy
supervision. There is a pharmacy directed by a licensed pharmacist defined as
follows:
a. The Director of Pharmacy is
trained in the specialized functions of hospital pharmacy;
b. The Director of Pharmacy is responsible to
the administration of the hospital and Board of Pharmacy for developing,
supervising, and coordinating all the activities of the Pharmacy Department and
all pharmacists providing professional services in the hospital; and
c. All licensed pharmacists who provide
pharmaceutical services as defined by the Pharmacy Practice Act shall practice
under policies, procedures, and protocols approved by the Director of Pharmacy.
These policies, procedures, and protocols shall be subject to review and
approval by the Board of Pharmacy.
F. Physical Facilities. Facilities are
provided for the storage, safeguarding, preparation, and dispensing of drugs,
defined as follows:
1. Drugs are issued to
floor units in accordance with approved policies and procedures;
2. Drug cabinets on all units shall be
checked monthly by qualified pharmacy personnel. All floor stocks are properly
controlled;
3. A careful
determination of the functions of a department will regulate the space to be
allocated, the equipment necessary to carry out the functions, and the number
of personnel required to utilize the equipment and to render a given volume of
service, as these functions relate to the frequency or intensity of each
function or activity. Adequate equipment shall specifically relate to services
rendered and functions performed by the hospital pharmacy. Equipment lists will
relate to the following services and functions:
a. Medication preparation;
b. Library reference facilities;
c. Record and office procedures;
d. Sterile product manufacturing;
e. Bulk compounding
(manufacturing);
f. Product control
(assay, sterility testing, etc.); and
g. Product development and special
formulations for medical staff.
4. Equipment and supplies necessary to the
hospital pharmacy's safe, efficient, and economical operation shall include,
but not be limited to:
a. Graduates capable of
measuring from 0.1 ml up to at least 500 ml;
b. Mortars and pestles;
c. Hot and cold running water;
d. Spatulas (steel and
non-metallic);
e.
Funnels;
f. Stirring
rods;
g. Class A balance and
appropriate weights;
h. Typewriter
or other label printer;
i. Suitable
apparatus for production of small-volume sterile solutions;
j. Suitable containers and labels;
and
k. Adequate reference library
to include at least the following:
1) American
Hospital Formulary Service;
2)
Pharmacology text;
3) Each hospital
pharmacy shall have available for personal and patient use a current copy of:
The U.S.P. DI, three book set including "Drug Information for
the Healthcare Professional" (two volumes) and "Advice for the Patient" (one
volume)
or
The two volume set "Facts and Comparisons" (one volume) and
"Patient Drug Facts" (one volume);
4) Text on compatibility of parenteral
products;
5) Current professional
journals, such as:
a) Drug Intelligence and
Clinical Pharmacy;
b) Hospital
Pharmacy; and
c) Journal of
ASHP.
5. Special locked storage space is provided
to meet legal requirements for storage of controlled drugs, alcohol, and other
prescribed drugs; and
G.
Personnel. Personnel competent in their respective duties are provided in
keeping with the size and activity of the department explained as follows:
1. The Director of Pharmacy is assisted by an
adequate number of additional licensed pharmacists and other such personnel as
the activities of the pharmacy may require to ensure quality pharmaceutical
services; and
2. The pharmacy,
depending upon the size and scope of its operations, is staffed by the
following categories of personnel:
a. Chief
Pharmacist (Director of Pharmacy);
b. One or more assistant chief pharmacists
(Assistant Director of Pharmacy);
c. Staff pharmacists;
d. Pharmacy residents (where program has been
activated);
e. Trained
non-professional pharmacy helpers (qualified hospital personnel); and
f. Clerical help.
H. Emergency Pharmaceutical
Services. Through the Administrator of the hospital, the P&T Committee
shall establish policies and procedures that include, but are not limited to,
the following:
1. Upon admission to the
Emergency Room on an outpatient basis and when examined by the physician where
medications are prescribed to be administered, a record shall be kept on file
in the Emergency Room admission book or a copy of the Emergency Room medication
order must be kept by the pharmacist to be readily accessible, for control and
other purposes, as required by these rules;
2. If the physician wishes the patient to
have medication to be taken with them from the emergency room supplies, the
amounts to be taken shall be sufficient to last until medication may be
obtained from local pharmacies, in any case not to exceed a 48-hour supply. All
state and federal laws shall be observed concerning all records, labeling, and
outpatient dispensing requirements; and
3. Take home prescriptions for
anti-infectives issued to patients at the time of discharge from the Emergency
Room, dispensed by a pharmacist shall be quantities consistent with the medical
needs of the patient.
I.
Pharmacy Records and Labeling. Records are kept of the transactions of the
pharmacy and correlated with other hospital records where indicated. All
medication shall be properly labeled. Such record and labeling requirements are
as follows:
1. The pharmacy establishes and
maintains, in cooperation with the accounting department, a satisfactory system
of records and bookkeeping in accordance with the policies of the hospital for:
a. Maintaining adequate control over the
requisitioning and dispensing of all drugs and pharmaceutical supplies;
and
b. Charging patients for drugs
and pharmaceutical supplies.
2. A record of procurement and disbursement
of all controlled drugs is maintained in such a manner that the disposition of
any particular item may be readily traced;
3. The pharmacist shall receive and provide
service pursuant to the perusal of the physician's original order or a direct
copy thereof, except in emergency situations wherein the pharmacist may provide
service pursuant to a verbal order or to an oral or written transcription of
the physician's order provided that the pharmacist shall receive and review the
original or direct copy;
4. A
record shall be maintained by the pharmacy and stored separately from other
hospital records for each patient (inpatient or outpatient) containing the name
of the patient, the prescribing physician, the name and strength of the drugs
prescribed, the name and manufacturer (or trademark), the quantity and the
pharmacist's initials for all medications dispensed;
5. The label of each medication container
prepared for administration to inpatients, shall bear the name and strength of
the medication, the expiration date, and the lot or control number. The label
on the medication or the container into which the labeled medication is placed
shall bear the name of the patient and room number; and
6. The label of each outpatient's individual
prescription medication container bears the name of the patient, prescribing
physician, directions for use, and the name and strength of the medication
dispensed (unless directed otherwise by the physician) and the date of
dispensing.
J. Control of
Toxic or Dangerous Drugs. Policies are established to control the
administration of toxic or dangerous drugs with specific reference to the
duration of the order and the dosage, explained as follows:
1. The Medical Staff has established a
written policy that all toxic or dangerous medications not specifically
prescribed as to the time or number of doses, will be automatically stopped
after a reasonable time limit set by the staff;
2. The classifications ordinarily thought of
as toxic or dangerous drugs are controlled substances, anticoagulants,
antibiotics, oxytocics, and cortisone products; and
3. All deteriorated non-sterile, non-labeled,
or damaged medication shall be destroyed by the pharmacist, with the exception
of controlled substances. All controlled drugs (Schedule II, III, IV and V)
shall be listed and a copy sent, along with drugs to the Arkansas Department of
Health by registered mail or delivered in person for disposition.
K. Drugs to be dispensed.
Therapeutic ingredients of medications dispensed are included (or approved for
inclusion) in the United States Pharmacopoeia, N.F. and U.S. Homeopathic
Pharmacopoeia, or Accepted Dental Remedies (except for any drugs unfavorably
evaluated therein) and drugs approved by Ark. Code Ann. § 17-92- 503, or
are approved for use by the P&T Committee of the hospital staff, explained
as follows:
1. The pharmacist, with the advice
and guidance of the P&T Committee, is responsible for the specifications as
to quality, quantity, and source of supply of all drugs; and
2. There is available a formulary or list of
drugs accepted for use in the hospital which is developed and amended at
regular intervals by the P&T.
L. Policy and Procedure Manual.
1. A policy and procedure manual pertaining
to the operations of the hospital pharmacy, with updated revisions adopted by
the P&T Committee of each hospital shall be prepared and maintained at the
hospital.
2. The policy and
procedure manual shall include at a minimum, the following:
a. Provisions for procurement, storage,
distribution, and drug control for all aspects of pharmaceutical services in
the hospital;
b. Specialized areas
such as Surgery, Delivery, ICU and CCU units and Emergency Room stock and usage
of medication shall be specifically outlined;
c. A system of requisitioning supplies and
medications for nurses' stations stock shall be in written procedural form as
to limits of medications to be stocked in each nursing unit;
d. Detailed job descriptions and duties of
each employee by job title working in the Pharmacy Department shall be
developed and made a part of these policies and procedures; and
e. The Pharmacy Policy and Procedure Manual
shall be subject to review and approval by the Board of Pharmacy on request
from the Board.
M. Employee Prescription Medication.
1. There will be a prescription on file for
all prescription drugs dispensed to hospital employees and their immediate
families. These records will be kept separate from all inpatient
records.
2. The only person(s)
entitled to have employee prescriptions filled will be the employee listed on
the hospital payroll and members of their immediate family.
N. Patient Discharge Medication.
Any take-home prescription dispensed to patients at time of discharge from the
hospital shall be for drugs and quantities consistent with the immediate needs
of the patient.
O. Licensed
Pharmacist Personnel Requirements.
1. The
minimum requirements for licensed pharmacists in hospitals are:
a. A general hospital, surgery and general
medical care, maternal and general medical care hospital, chronic disease
hospital, psychiatric hospital, and rehabilitative facility licensed for
greater than 50 beds, as determined by the institution license issued by the
Arkansas Department of Health, shall require the services of one pharmacist on
the basis of 40 hours per week with such additional pharmacists as are
necessary, in the opinion of the Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy, to perform
required pharmacy duties as are necessary in keeping with the size and scope of
the services of the hospital pharmacy's safe and efficient operation. Hospitals
providing specialized or unique patient care services may request approval from
the Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy to be exempt from the requirement of a
pharmacist on duty 40 hours per week. The request for exemption shall provide
adequate written documentation to justify the services of a pharmacist such
hours as are necessary to perform required pharmacy services, followed by an
appearance before the Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy for final approval of
the request;
b. The above
classified hospitals, licensed for 50 beds or less, as determined by the
institution license issued by the Arkansas Department of Health, shall require
the services of a pharmacist such hours as, in the opinion of the Arkansas
State Board of Pharmacy and the Arkansas State Board of Health, are necessary
to perform required pharmacy duties in keeping with the size and scope of the
services of the hospital pharmacy safe, and efficient operation. The pharmacist
shall be on site at least five days per week to perform and review pharmacy
dispensing, drug utilization and drug distribution activities. A pharmacist
shall be available to provide emergency services to the staff when the pharmacy
is closed;
c. Recuperation Centers,
Outpatient Surgery Centers and Infirmaries:
1)
If the infirmary, recuperation center, or outpatient surgery center has a
pharmacy department, a licensed pharmacist shall be employed to administer the
pharmacy in accordance with all state and federal laws regarding drugs and drug
control;
2) If the infirmary,
recuperation center, or outpatient surgery center does not have a pharmacy
department, it has provisions for promptly and conveniently obtaining
prescribed drugs and biologicals from a community or institutional
pharmacy;
3) If the infirmary,
recuperation center, or outpatient surgery center does not have a pharmacy
department but does maintain a supply of drugs, a licensed pharmacist shall be
responsible for the control of all bulk drugs and maintain records of their
receipt and disposition. The pharmacist shall dispense drugs from the drug
supply, properly labeled, and make them available to appropriate nursing
personnel;
4) All medication for
patients shall be on individual prescription basis.
2. A pharmacist in charge, who is
employed at any facility permitted by the Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy
where a 40-hour work week is required, may also be the pharmacist in charge at
a hospital licensed for 50 beds or less by the Arkansas Department of
Health.
P. Responsibility
of a Pharmacist in Hospital Pharmacy.
1. The
pharmacist is responsible for the control of all medications distributed in the
hospital where he practices and for the proper provision of all pharmaceutical
services.
2. The following aspects
of medication distribution and pharmaceutical service are functions involving
professional evaluations or judgments and may not be performed by supportive
personnel:
a. Selection of the brand and
supplies of medication;
b.
Interpretation and certification of the medication ordered. This involves a
number of professional responsibilities such as the determination of:
1) Accuracy and appropriateness of dose and
dosage schedule;
2) Such items as
possible drug interactions, medication sensitivities of the patient, and
chemical and therapeutic incompatibilities; and
3) Accuracy of entry of medication order to
patient's medication profile.
c. Final certification of the prepared
medication.
Q.
Pharmacy Technicians.
1. Pharmacy technician
refers to those individuals identified by the Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy.
Exclusive of pharmacy interns, who are regular paid employees of the hospital
and assist the pharmacist in pharmaceutical services.
2. Supervision means that the responsible
pharmacist shall be physically present to observe, direct, and supervise the
pharmacy technician at all times when the pharmacy technician performs acts
specified in this regulation. The supervising pharmacist is totally and
absolutely responsible for the actions of the pharmacy technician.
3. The pharmacist and pharmacy technician(s)
shall comply with all applicable sections of Laws and Regulations of the
Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy with regards to tasks, responsibilities,
duties, ratios, and supervision in the hospital setting.
4. There shall be documentation by each
technician of all duties and tasks performed in the preparation and processing
of medication. The pharmacist shall be responsible for the final check and
verification of all technician duties and tasks. The performance, check, and
verification shall be recorded on a record maintained by the department which
shall include the signature, initial(s), or other identifying mark of each
person.
R. Operation of
Pharmacy Department When Pharmacist is Not Present.
1. A limited supply of backup medications may
be utilized for patient needs only at times when the pharmacist is not present.
This stock shall be accessible only to approved licensed personnel. A record
shall be maintained which identifies the medication obtained and the personnel
obtaining it. The pharmacist shall then review this record when he returns to
the facility to assure compliance with the physician's orders. Medications
shall be replaced to stock as needed.
2. At no time will the hospital pharmacy be
open and in operation unless a licensed pharmacist is physically present
except:
a. Entrance may be obtained for
emergency medication as set forth in the Pharmacy Policy and Procedure Manual
when the pharmacy is closed outside its normal operation hours. The Medical
Staff shall approve a method by which individual nursing personnel may be
authorized by name and qualification to remove only one dose if the drug is not
of the unit dose packaging type; or, if the medication is unit dosed, enough
medication to last until the pharmacist returns can be removed. A record
listing all medications obtained should be maintained, and the pharmacist shall
check for compliance with the physician's orders when he returns to the
facility. Controlled substances shall not be accessible unless daily counts are
performed and documented; and
b.
When the pharmacist is summoned away from the pharmacy and there are other
qualified personnel left in the pharmacy, the personnel left in the pharmacy
shall perform only those functions authorized within this
regulation.
3. A
pharmacist shall be available to provide medication
consultation.
S.
Medication Utilization. The pharmacist, with the advice and guidance of the
P&T Committee, shall participate in:
1.
Discussions of reports of medication errors, with trends noted, conclusions
made, and recommendations suggested. If there are no errors to report, this
shall be stated;
2. Discussions of
adverse drug reactions with trends noted, conclusions made, and recommendations
suggested. Proper reports of appropriate reactions shall be reported to the
full Medical Staff and/or the FDA reporting system. If there are no adverse
reactions to report, this shall be stated;
3. Reviews of results of monitoring conducted
according to approved criteria for antibiotics prescribed for prophylactic and
therapeutic reasons;
4. Reviews of
other drug utilization in the facility, as appropriate; and
5. Formulation of an official record of each
meeting maintained as minutes. The written report shall be forwarded to the
P&T Committee, QA/PI Committee, and/or the Medical Staff for review and
consideration, with at least a quarterly frequency.
T. Electronic Data Processing in Hospital
Pharmacies. All hospitals utilizing electronic data processing systems shall
comply with Laws and Regulations of the Arkansas State Board of
Pharmacy.
U. Maintenance and
Retention of Drug Records. All drug records, including but not limited to,
purchase invoices, official dispensing records, prescription and inventory
records shall be kept in such a manner that all data is readily retrievable,
and shall be retained as a matter of record by the pharmacist for at least two
years.
V. The American Society of
Health-System Pharmacists Guidelines. The American Society of Health-System
Pharmacists' most recent statement on hospital drug control systems and
Guidelines for Institutional Use of Controlled Substances shall be required
reading by hospital pharmacists.
SECTION 17
: FOOD AND NUTRITION
SERVICES.
A. Administration.
1. The Food and Nutrition Services shall be
under the daily, including weekends, onsite supervision of a qualified
individual. The individual shall be at a minimum a certified dietary manager
and:
a. Be responsible for the daily
management of clinical and administrative dietetic aspects of the service by
formulating, reviewing and revising policies and procedures for all Food and
Nutrition Services practices;
b.
Ensure that all personnel in the service are oriented in their respective
duties;
c. Implement a maintenance
program to ensure food service facilities, equipment and utensils are
maintained in a safe, clean, sanitary manner and are replaced at specific
intervals or as needed;
d.
Participate on hospital-wide departmental committees as required;
e. Ensure that trained staff are maintained
for daily administrative and clinical nutrition practices. A minimum of a
two-week current work schedule shall be posted and reflect all positions,
including the department director; and
f. Develop, implement and maintain a system
for record keeping relating to all department functions dependent on the
department's scope of services, e.g., patient assessments, counseling, diet
instructions, temperatures, educational programs, etc.
g. A hospital within a hospital may contract
with the host hospital for food and nutrition services. Contracted services
shall:
1) be under a current agreement;
and
2) meet all requirements of
this section.
2. Policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision.
The first page of each manual shall have the annual review
date, signature of the department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the
review.
3. Policies and
procedures shall include:
a. Job descriptions
and performance evaluations;
b.
Orientation;
c. Preventive
maintenance;
d. Infection
prevention and control measures;
e.
Safety practices; and
f. Cleaning
of equipment and applicable areas.
4. Clinically relevant educational programs
shall be conducted at regularly scheduled intervals with not less than 12 per
year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
5. Nutrition Services shall
have an ongoing QA/PI Program that addresses both clinical and administrative
issues. A mechanism for reporting results of audits shall be provided, to
include: indicators monitored, thresholds/standards established, results,
corrective plan/corrective action taken and follow-up.
6. Time and duty schedules for all hourly
employees shall be maintained.
7.
Diet Manual shall be authorized by the Medical Staff, reviewed and revised, as
needed, to reflect current recognized dietary practices. A cover page shall be
affixed with the date of review and appropriate signatures and a copy of the
manual shall be located on each patient unit. Use of electronic diet manuals is
acceptable.
8. Menus shall:
a. Be planned/approved by the registered
dietitian and meet the nutrition needs of the patients in accordance with the
current recommended dietary guidelines of the Food and Nutrition Board,
National Research Council and the currently approved facility diet manual in
accordance with the written diet order.
b. Be dated at least one week in advance. The
current week's menus shall be posted and available in the kitchen. The meals
prepared and served shall correspond with the posted menu, or written diet
orders.
c. Not be restrictive in
nature (e.g., seasoning, fat, sodium, sugar content) unless required by a
modified/therapeutic diet order.
d.
Be of equivalent nutrition value when substitutions/changes are made.
Menus/production schedules, showing all changes, shall be retained for at least
30 days.
9. Diets shall
be in writing and signed by a physician or a mid-level practitioner if
privileged by the Medical Staff and Governing Body. Dietitians may issue orders
for patient diets if authorized by the medical staff. Notification according to
facility policy shall be made to the Nutrition Services Department on a timely
basis, kept current and include current date, the patient's name, room number
and diet order.
B. Food
Services.
1. At least three meal equivalents
shall be served daily at regular intervals, approximately five hours apart. No
more than 15 hours shall elapse between the serving of the evening meal and the
morning meal. The meals shall be served at approximately the same hour each
day.
2. Food shall be prepared in
accordance with approved menus and standardized recipes and in a manner to
conserve nutritive value, flavor and appearance.
3. Food shall meet patient needs and shall be
attractive, palatable and served at proper temperatures.
4. An identification system shall be
implemented for patient trays to ensure that each patient receives the
appropriate diet as ordered.
5.
Nourishing bedtime snacks, appropriate to the patient's needs, shall be made
available
6. Only foods prepared
and stored under the direction of Nutrition Services, in accordance with the
Rules Pertaining to Retail Food Service Establishments shall be served to
patients.
7. All individuals who
assist patients in the preparation, heating, reheating, consumption of food,
sanitation of food ware and kitchen equipment, etc., while in the facility or
on the facility grounds, shall be under the direction of Nutrition Services and
in compliance with the Rules Pertaining to Retail Food Service Establishments.
Documentation of educational programs on food preparation, safety and
sanitation shall be performed for all applicable personnel (e.g., Occupational
Therapy, Nursing) by Nutrition Services at least annually.
8. Food shall not be consumed in the
kitchen.
9. Food shall be
transported in a manner that maintains safe food temperatures and prevents
contamination. Food carts shall not block corridors/exits, emergency equipment
or patient doorways.
10. All
storage containers/foodstuffs shall be stored a minimum of 6 inches above the
floor on non-porous, easily cleaned racks, dollies or shelving, in a manner
that protects the food (or food contact surfaces) from splash and other
contamination and permits easy cleaning of the storage area.
11. Plastic milk crates shall not be
permitted for storing of food or equipment, except for the intended use for
milk storage.
12. Temperature
documentation of all food refrigerators/freezers in the kitchen and cafeteria
shall be performed a minimum of three times per day at opening, midoperation
and closing of the department.
13.
Temperature documentation of all nourishment refrigerators/freezers in patient
care areas shall be performed at least daily
14. Proper temperatures of vending machines
containing potentially hazardous foods shall be ensured daily by the facility.
Vending machines shall be equipped with a thermometer, easily visible to food
service personnel for the purposes of monitoring the temperature of the
internal environment. These machines shall have the capacity to render
themselves inoperable if temperatures in excess of 40 degrees Fahrenheit are
maintained for more than two hours. Documentation of such downtime shall be
maintained to include remedial action taken.
15. If, for any reason, the refrigeration
equipment does not maintain the appropriate temperature, action shall be taken
and a record of remedial action and downtime shall be recorded and maintained
by the facility.
16. Temperature
documentation of the dish machine shall be recorded with each meal and these
records shall be maintained by the facility. If the temperatures (and, if
applicable, dwell times) are not maintained properly, action shall be taken and
a record of remedial action, back-up procedures used and downtime shall be
maintained by the facility.
17. If
the facility uses a chemical method for sanitizing food preparation and serving
ware, a record of the water temperature, the chemical used and appropriate
parts per million (ppm) shall be maintained by the facility at each
use.
18. The temperature of the hot
and cold potentially hazardous foods shall be recorded at least at the
beginning and end of meal service that continues for more than 15 minutes. If
meal service lasts for 15 minutes or less, food temperature documentation is
required only at the beginning of food service.
19. Documentation of the testing/calibration
of food/refrigeration/freezer thermometers shall be performed according to
manufacturer's recommendations.
20.
Food thermometers shall be sanitized after each use and stored in a manner that
prevents contamination.
21. Only
dietary and authorized personnel shall be allowed in the kitchen.
22. Sanitation shall be in accordance with
the Rules Pertaining to Retail Food Service Establishments.
C. Food Safety/Sanitation.
1. Whole eggs and raw meat shall be stored
separately and in a way that prevents contamination of other food items in
refrigerated units.
2. Reheated
food shall attain a temperature above 165° Fahrenheit prior to placement in
steam tables, warmers, or other hot food storage units. Steam tables, warmers
or other food storage units shall not be used for the rapid heating of
potentially hazardous food.
3.
Disposable gloves shall be worn to eliminate direct handling of food. Gloves
shall be properly discarded after being used, torn or contaminated.
4. Ground beef or ground beef products shall
be cooked to an internal temperature of 160° Fahrenheit or
higher.
5. Potentially hazardous
food shall be tempered or thawed only:
a. In
designated tempering units at a temperature not to exceed 45°
Fahrenheit;
b. In general
refrigeration units at a temperature not to exceed 40°
Fahrenheit;
c. As part of the
conventional cooking process; or
d.
In a microwave, provided the food is immediately transferred to conventional
cooking process.
6.
Potentially hazardous food that is left over shall be labeled as such with the
date and time it was removed from service.
7. Potentially hazardous food shall be
chilled to a temperature below 40° Fahrenheit and retained for no longer
than 48 hours.
8. Food contact
surfaces, i.e., cutting boards, of all equipment and utensils, shall be
sanitized by immersion for at least one-half minute in clean, hot water at a
temperature of at least 180° Fahrenheit or by any other method approved by
Health Facility Services. Counter tops and other huge industrial equipment
shall be washed down with concentrated solutions.
9. Clean linens, mopheads and cloths shall be
stored in a manner to prevent contamination prior to use.
10. Soiled linens, etc., shall be stored
covered, separately from clean linen, food storage, preparation and serving
areas. Containers for holding such items shall be made of non- absorbent
materials. Soiled linens shall be removed from the department daily.
11. Food inventory shall be handled on a
first-in, first-out basis. A system for labeling and dating canned, dry and
potentially hazardous foods shall be implemented.
12. Potentially hazardous frozen foods
removed from freezer storage to be thawed shall be labeled with the date of
pull from the freezer for thawing.
13. Supplies and perishable foods for a
24-hour period and nonperishable foods for a three-day period shall be on the
premises to meet the requirements of the planned menus.
NOTE: These rules are referenced to the Arkansas Board of
Health Rules Pertaining to Retail Food Service
Establishments
D.
Clinical Services.
1. Clinical
Dietitian/Nutritionist.
Shall be a registered dietitian, or registry eligible, and
evaluate and oversee the delivery of effective nutrition care based on current,
recognized nutrition practices. If not full- time, make regularly scheduled
visits to accomplish the following:
a.
Review, revise and approve a current diet manual for facility use;
b. Review, revise, approve and implement
nutrition care policy and procedures, standards of nutrition care, nutrition
care protocols and the Nutrition Services QA/PI Program;
c. Coordinate nutrition care through
communication with other patient care services;
d. Provide for the initiation of nutrition
screening of all patients upon admission and periodic screening of patients
during their hospital stay;
e.
Provide for the nutrition assessment of patients at nutrition risk, as defined
by the Medical Staff, and collaborate with the physician on the findings of the
evaluation;
f. Ensure competency of
all nutrition services personnel who perform assessments, counseling, develop
care plans and participate in discharge planning;
g. Provide to the facility evidence of
continuing education hours;
h.
Perform orientation, preceptorship and ongoing training/educational programs
for staff;
i. Review and revise
nutrition counseling/diet education practices that are individualized to
patient needs;
j. Monitor the
enforcement of all policies and procedures and practices relating to food
safety and sanitation;
k. Develop,
implement and maintain a system for recording data related to patient
care;
l. Collaborate with Nursing
and Pharmacy to provide food/drug interaction counseling; and
m. If the dietitian is a consultant, submit
reports to the facility Administrator reflecting services performed at each
regularly scheduled visit.
2. Nutrition Screening and Documentation.
a. Nutrition Screening shall be completed
within 24 hours of admission on all patients to determine nutrition risk and
notify the physician and dietitian of any patients that are at nutrition
risk.
b. Psychiatric, Alcohol and
Drug and Rehabilitation patients shall be rescreened seven days from the
initial screen and at least every 14 days thereafter.
3. Nutrition Care Process.
a. A nutrition assessment of patients at
nutrition risk, as reflected in the medical record, shall include as
appropriate:
1) Anthropometric measurements
including height, weight, BMI, and goal weight;
2) Abnormal pertinent laboratory
values;
3) The patient's caloric
and protein needs;
4) nutrient
intake compared to estimated needs;
5) Determination of abnormal intake or recent
weight loss/gain prior to admission;
6) An objective evaluation of the patient's
compliance with a physician ordered diet prior to admission;
7) Pertinent food/drug
interactions;
8) An evaluation of
the patient's special feeding/nutrient/fluid needs;
9) Patient's food preferences, dislikes,
allergies or intolerances; and
10)
Nutrition summary including identification of nutrition problems
b. The patient care plan on all
patients found to be at nutrition risk shall include the following nutrition
components, as appropriate:
1) individualized
nutrition counseling;
2) discharge
planning;
3) comprehensive
nutrition assessments to include further clinical, laboratory, social or
nutrition data to assist with the ongoing evaluation;
4) follow-up care to evaluate the
effectiveness of the nutrition regimen; and
5) Any requests for alterations or
modifications to the ordered diet's nutrient content, consistency,
administration route/method or meal pattern as served in the hospital in order
to meet the nutrition needs and/or special feeding needs of the
patient.
4.
Nutrition Counseling. Documentation of nutrition counseling shall include:
a. Description of the individualized
nutrition counseling;
b. Objective
evaluation of the patient's and/or caregiver's understanding and ability to
carry out the diet order; and
c.
Plans for continued counseling and/or recommendations for post discharge
counseling and evaluation of patient diet compliance.
5. Nutrition Monitoring and Evaluation.
a. Shall be performed when the patient is at
nutrition risk and documented in the medical record. The frequency of follow-up
nutritional care shall be determined by the patient's condition.
b. Shall be documented in the patient's
medical record on all patients at nutrition risk.
c. Shall be documented to include an
evaluation of the effectiveness of the prescribed nutrition regimen, changing
nutrition status/needs, nutrition counseling and/or recommendations to improve
patient nutrition care.
SECTION 18
: INFECTION PREVENTION AND
CONTROL.
A. General.
1. The facility shall develop and use a
coordinated process that effectively reduces the risk of endemic and epidemic
healthcare associated infections (HAI) in patients, health care workers and
visitors.
2. There shall be a
comprehensive list of communicable diseases for which patients shall be
isolated and for which there are visitation restrictions. The list, and other
policies and procedures for isolation, shall conform to the latest edition of
the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Atlanta, Georgia (CDC)
Guidelines.
3. It shall be the duty
of the Administrator or his/her designee to report all infectious or
communicable diseases in the facility to the Arkansas Department of Health,
Epidemiology, as required by the Rules and Regulations Pertaining to
Communicable Disease in Arkansas (Ark. Code Ann. §§
20-7-109, 110) and CMS mandatory
reporting requirements for Medicare certified facilities.
4. The Administrator shall designate a
qualified individual who shall:
a. Coordinate
the activities of the Infection Prevention and Control Committee;
b. Direct surveillance activities;
c. Ensure policies established by the
Committee are carried out; and
d.
Gather and report data regarding the hospital's HAI.
5. There shall be policies and procedures
establishing and defining the Infection Prevention and Control program to
include:
a. Definitions of HAI and
communicable diseases based on the current CDC or National Healthcare Safety
Network (NHSN) surveillance definitions;
b. Perform an annual facility-based risk
assessment to determine the infections that are most likely to occur in the
facility. Infections to be addressed include (but are not limited to) the
following:
1) Ventilator associated event
(VAE);
2) Clostridium difficle
infection (CDI);
3) Central line
associated blood stream infection (CLABS); and
4) Catheter associated urinary tract
infection (CAUTI).
7) Use of
intravascular catheters.
NOTE: The facility's system for surveillance, calculation and
evaluation of the incidence of HAI within the facility shall conform to CDC's
National NHSN or CDC publications as applicable.
c. Calculate HAI rates;
d. Measures for assessing and identifying
patients and health care workers at risk for HAI and communicable
diseases;
e. Methods for obtaining
reports of infections and communicable diseases in patients and health care
workers in a manner and time sufficient to limit the spread of
infection;
f. A plan for monitoring
and evaluating at least the following areas or departments to ensure policies
and procedures are followed:
1) Inpatient and
outpatient surgery;
2)
Delivery;
3) Nursery;
4) Central sterilization and
supply;
5) Housekeeping;
6) Laundry;
7) Food and Nutrition;
8) Laboratory;
9) Nursing;
10) Maintenance;
11) Invasive specialty laboratories (special
procedures);
12) Radiology;
and
13) Hemodialysis
units.
g. Measures for
prevention of infections including but not limited to:
1) Intravenous (IV) devices;
2) Indwelling urinary catheters;
3) Ventilator care;
4) Burns; and
5) Immune suppressed patients.
h. Measures for prevention of
communicable disease outbreaks, especially Mycobacterium tuberculosis (TB). All
plans for the prevention of transmission of TB shall conform to the most
current CDC Guidelines for Preventing the Transmission of Mycobacterium
Tuberculosis in Health Care Facilities;
i. Isolation procedures and requirements for
infected, immune suppressed patients and patients colonized or infected with
resistant organisms. Procedures shall conform to the most current CDC
Guidelines.
j. Provisions for
education of patients and their families concerning infections and communicable
diseases to include hand hygiene and any isolation precautions;
k. A plan for monitoring and evaluating all
aseptic, isolation and sanitation techniques employed in the facility to ensure
that approved infection prevention and control procedures are
followed;
l. Techniques for:
1) Hand hygiene including policies and
procedures that reflect facility-selected national guidelines for soap and
water as well as alcohol based hand rub if used;
2) Respiratory protection including policies
and procedures that reflect facility-selected national guidelines;
3) Asepsis/sterile technique;
4) Sterilization;
5) Sanitary food preparation;
6) Disinfection;
7) Housekeeping;
8) Linen care;
9) Liquid and solid waste disposal of both
infectious and regular waste. Disposal of infectious waste shall conform to the
latest edition of the Rules and Regulations Pertaining to the Management of
Medical Waste from Generators and Health Care Related Facilities;
10) Sharps safety;
11) Separation of clean from dirty process;
and
12) Other means of limiting the
spread of contagion.
m.
Authority and indications for obtaining microbiological cultures from
patients;
n. Employee health;
and
o. Visitation rules, especially
for patients in isolation, critical care, pediatrics and other special care
units, including postpartum care.
6. There shall be an orientation program for
all new health care workers concerning the importance of infection prevention
and control and each health care worker's responsibility in the hospital's
infection prevention and control program.
7. There shall be a plan for each employee to
receive annual educational programs as indicated based on assessments of the
Infection Prevention and Control process.
8. Maintain a log of documentation of
reportable diseases.
9. No items
shall be used past the expiration date.
B. Infection Prevention and Control
Committee.
1. There shall be a
multidisciplinary committee appointed by Administration to develop, implement
and monitor direction for the Infection Prevention and Control program based on
services impacting the infection prevention and control process.
2. The Medical Staff shall appoint a
physician to serve as chairperson of the Infection Prevention and Control
Committee. Additional physician members may be appointed.
3. The Infection Prevention and Control
Committee shall meet at least quarterly. Minutes of the meetings shall reflect
the Committee's actions in monitoring and directing the hospital's Infection
Prevention and Control program.
4.
The Infection Prevention and Control Committee shall fulfill the following
responsibilities:
a. Assist in the development
and approval of all infection prevention and control policies and procedures
within the facility;
b. Ensure that
an antibiogram is prepared at least annually and compared to the previous one
to identify trends;
c. Monitor any
contractual services relative to infection prevention and control (e.g. waste
management and laundry) to ensure compliance with all applicable rules;
and
d. Review any special infection
prevention and control studies conducted within the facility; and
e. Provide oversight for disinfectants and
sterilants.
C.
Employee Health.
1. There shall be policies
and procedures for screening health care workers for infectious/communicable
diseases and monitoring for health care workers exposed to patients with any
communicable diseases. The policies and procedures shall reflect
facility-selected national guidelines.
2. There shall be employee health policies
and procedures regarding preventing the transmission of infectious diseases.
The policies and procedures shall reflect facility-selected national
guidelines
3. There shall be
policies which clearly state when health care workers shall not render direct
patient care.
4. There shall be a
plan for ensuring that:
a. each health care
worker is free from TB; and
b. The
facility follows the latest tuberculosis screening and tuberculosis prevention
guidelines approved by the Arkansas Department of Health (Rules Pertaining to:
the Control of Communicable Diseases-Tuberculosis).
5. There shall be a plan for ensuring that
all health care workers who are exposed to blood and other potentially
infectious body fluids are offered immunizations for Hepatitis B.
SECTION 19
: LABORATORY.
A. General.
1. Each Critical Access Hospital shall
provide onsite laboratory services essential to the immediate diagnosis and
treatment of patients served by the facility. Provision shall be made for the
following laboratory services:
a. Chemistry
and microscopic examination of urine;
b. Complete blood count including hemoglobin,
hematocrit, red blood cells, white blood cells and platelets;
c. Routine chemistry procedures including
blood glucose, blood urea nitrogen, sodium, potassium, chloride, arterial blood
gases and cardiac enzyme(s);
d.
Fecal occult blood;
e. Pregnancy
tests;
f. Primary culturing for
transmittal to a certified laboratory;
g. Procurement, safekeeping and transfusion
of blood or blood products on an emergency basis either directly or through
written arrangement with another facility.
2. The requirements of the most current rule
of the Clinical Laboratory Improvement Amendments of 1988 (CLIA) shall be
met.
3. All laboratory testing that
is performed at any site owned and/or operated by the facility shall be
approved, in writing, by the Governing Body. The Governing Body shall authorize
the director of the hospital laboratory to provide oversight of all testing to
ensure the quality of the laboratory services provided. A comprehensive list of
all testing sites shall be made available to the Medical Staff.
4. A laboratory shall refer specimens for
testing only to a laboratory possessing a valid Clinical Laboratory Improvement
Amendments (CLIA) certificate authorizing the performance of testing in the
specialty or subspecialty of service for the level of complexity in which the
referred test is categorized.
5.
Only results from the Critical Access Hospital laboratory or from other
approved laboratories, as determined by hospital policy, shall be placed in the
patient's medical record.
6.
Laboratory tests shall be authorized by a physician or other persons authorized
by the Medical Staff and the Governing Body to order laboratory
examinations.
7. The laboratory
shall maintain accurate counts of total patient procedures for such specialty
in which tests are performed.
8.
Current reference material, such as textbooks, shall be available for every
laboratory category in which tests are performed.
9. The laboratory shall make available to the
Medical Staff a list of all tests performed onsite, including the reference
range for each test.
B.
Personnel.
1. A member of the Medical Staff
shall be appointed to act as a liaison between the laboratory and the Medical
Staff.
2. The laboratory shall be
under the oversight of a pathologist who is board certified or eligible. A
pathologist who is not based at the hospital shall make at least a monthly
visit and submit a monthly written report to the Hospital Administrator.
NOTE: A hospital which provides only limited laboratory
services (e.g., blood gas laboratory only) shall not be subject to the
requirement of oversight of a pathologist.
3. The laboratory director, as defined by
CLIA 88, shall be responsible for the overall operation of the laboratory but
may delegate specific responsibilities to supervisory personnel. However, the
director remains responsible for ensuring that all duties are properly
performed and documented. The laboratory director hall be responsible for the
following:
a. Ensuring that testing systems
developed and used for each of the tests performed in the laboratory provide
quality laboratory services for all aspects of test performance, which includes
the pre-analytic, analytic and post-analytic phases of testing;
b. Ensuring that the physical plant and
environmental conditions of the laboratory are appropriate for the testing
performed and provide a safe environment in which employees are protected from
physical, chemical and biological hazards;
c. Ensuring that:
1) The test methodologies selected have the
capability of providing the quality of results required for patient
care;
2) Verification procedures
used are adequate to determine the accuracy, precision and other pertinent
performance characteristics of the method;
3) Laboratory personnel are performing the
test methods as required for accurate and reliable results;
d. Ensuring that the laboratory is
enrolled in a proficiency testing program approved by Health and Human Services
(HHS) for the testing performed and that:
1)
The proficiency testing samples are tested in the same manner as the patient
samples;
2) The results are
returned within the time frames established by the proficiency testing
program;
3) All proficiency testing
reports are reviewed by the appropriate staff to evaluate the laboratory's
performance and to identify any problems that require corrective
action;
4) An approved corrective
action plan is followed when any proficiency testing result is found to be
unacceptable or unsatisfactory;
e. Ensuring that the quality control and
quality assurance/performance improvement programs are established and
maintained to assure the quality of laboratory services provided and to
identify failures in quality as they occur;
f. Ensuring the establishment and maintenance
of acceptable levels of analytical performance for each test system;
g. Ensuring that all necessary remedial
actions are taken and documented whenever significant deviations from the
laboratory's established performance characteristics are identified and that
patient test results are reported only when the system is functioning
properly;
h. Ensuring that reports
of test results include pertinent information required for
interpretation;
i. Ensuring that
consultation is available to the laboratory's clients and to the Medical Staff
on matters relating to the quality of the test results reported and
interpretation concerning specific patient conditions;
j. Ensuring there is a sufficient number of
laboratory personnel with the appropriate education and either training or
experience to provide appropriate consultation, properly supervise and
accurately perform tests and report test results;
k. Ensuring all personnel have the
appropriate education and experience, receive the appropriate training for the
type of services offered, and have demonstrated that they can perform all
testing operations reliably to provide and report accurate results;
l. Ensuring there is documentation of
training for laboratory personnel who perform special procedures such as
arterial punctures and therapeutic phlebotomies;
m. Ensuring that qualified testing personnel
are on duty or on call at all times;
n. Ensuring that policies and procedures are
established for monitoring individuals who conduct pre-analytical, analytical
and post-analytical phases of testing to assure that they are competent and
maintain their competency to process specimens, perform test procedures and
report test results promptly and proficiently, and whenever necessary, identify
needs for remedial training or continuing education to improve skills. The
procedures for evaluation of the competency of the staff shall include, but are
not limited to the following:
1) Direct
observations of routine patient test performance, including patient
preparation, if applicable, specimen handling, processing and
testing;
2) Monitoring the
recording and reporting of test results;
3) Review of intermediate test results or
worksheets, quality control records, proficiency testing results and preventive
maintenance records;
4) Direct
observation of performance of instrument maintenance and function
checks;
5) Assessment of test
performance through testing previously analyzed specimens, internal blind
testing samples or external proficiency testing samples;
6) Assessment of problem solving
skills;
7) Evaluation and
documentation of the performance of all personnel with at least the following
frequency:
a) Semiannually during the first
year of employment in the laboratory;
b) Annually after the first year;
c) Prior to reporting patient test results if
test methodology or instrumentation changes;
o. Ensuring that an approved procedure manual
is available to all personnel responsible for any aspect of the testing
process;
p. Ensuring there is a
plan for providing continuing education for the laboratory staff and there is
documentation of each employee's participation.
q. Specifying the responsibilities and duties
of each consultant and each supervisor, as well as each person engaged in the
performance of the pre-analytic, analytic and post-analytic phases of
testing;
r. Specifying the
examinations and procedures each individual is authorized to perform, whether
supervision is required for specimen processing, test performance or result
reporting and whether supervisory or director review is required prior to
reporting patient test results;
4. There shall be a supervisor accessible at
all times when testing is performed.
5. Personnel responsible for day-to-day
supervision of the laboratory shall meet at least one of the following
qualifications:
a. A bachelor's degree in
medical technology from an accredited institution and at least one (1) year of
clinical laboratory training or experience relative to the specialties being
supervised;
b. A bachelor's degree
in a chemical, physical, biological or clinical laboratory science from an
accredited institution with at least two (2) years of clinical laboratory
training or experience relative to the specialties being supervised;
c. An associate degree in a laboratory
science or medical laboratory technology from an accredited institution with at
least two (2) years of clinical laboratory training or experience relative to
the specialties being supervised;
d. A passing score on the Clinical Laboratory
Technology Proficiency examination approved by HHS (HEW) and at least six (6)
years of clinical laboratory experience with at least two (2) years of
experience relative to the specialties being supervised;
e. Employment as a laboratory supervisor
prior to January 1, 1995, in a hospital licensed by the Arkansas Department of
Health.
6. Testing
personnel shall meet at least the following qualifications:
a. Have earned a high school diploma or
equivalent;
b. Have documentation
of training appropriate for the testing performed prior to analyzing patient
specimens. Such training shall ensure that the individual has the following:
1) Skills required for proper patient
preparation and specimen collection, to include the following:
a) Labeling;
b) Handling;
c) Preservation or fixation;
d) Processing or preparation;
e) Transportation and storage.
2) The skills required for
implementing all standard laboratory procedures;
3) The skills required for performing each
test method and for proper instrument use;
4) The skills required for performing
preventive maintenance, trouble-shooting and calibration procedures related to
each test performed;
5) A working
knowledge of reagent stability and storage;
6) The skills required to implement the
quality control policies and procedures of the laboratory;
7) An awareness of the factors that influence
test results;
8) The skills
required to assess and verify the validity of patient test results through the
evaluation of quality control sample values prior to reporting test
results.
C. Procedure Manual.
1. There shall be a procedure manual for the
performance of all analytical methods used by the laboratory readily available
and followed by laboratory personnel. Textbooks may be used as supplements but
shall not be used in lieu of the laboratory's written procedures for testing or
examining specimens. The procedure manual shall include, when applicable to the
test procedure, the following:
a. Requirements
for patient preparation, specimen collection and processing, labeling,
preservation and transportation, including criteria for specimen
rejection;
b. Procedures for
microscopic examinations, including the detection of inadequately prepared
slides;
c. Step-by-step performance
of the procedure, including test calculations and interpretation of
results;
d. Preparation of slides,
solutions, calibrators, controls, reagents, stains and other materials used in
testing;
e. Calibration and
calibration verification procedures;
f. The reportable range for patient test
results as verified by the laboratory;
g. Quality control procedures for each test
to include the following:
1) Type of
control;
2) Identity of
control;
3) Number of
controls;
4) Frequency of testing
controls;
5) Criteria for
determining acceptability of control results.
h. Remedial actions to be taken when any of
the following occur:
1) Calibration results
are unacceptable;
2) Control
results are unacceptable;
3)
Equipment or test methodologies fail;
4) Patient test values are outside the
laboratory's reportable range of patient test results;
5) The laboratory cannot report patient test
results within its established time frames;
6) Errors in reported patient test results
are detected.
i.
Limitations in methodologies, including interfering substances;
j. Reference ranges (normal
values);
k. A list of "panic
values" with written instructions for reporting such values;
l. Pertinent literature references;
m. Appropriate criteria for specimen storage
and preservation to ensure specimen integrity until testing is
completed;
n. The laboratory's
system for reporting patient test results;
o. Description of the course of action to be
taken in the event that a test system becomes inoperable;
p. Criteria for the referral of specimens,
including procedures for specimen submission and handling and for record
keeping.
2. The procedure
manual shall be reviewed, approved, signed and dated by the current director of
the laboratory or by an individual designated by the director in compliance
with the CLIA 88 requirements.
3.
Each revision or addition to the procedure manual shall be reviewed, approved,
signed and dated by the current director of the laboratory or by an individual
designated by the director in compliance with the CLIA 88
requirements.
4. The laboratory
shall maintain a copy of each discontinued procedure for two years, with the
dates of initial use and discontinuance.
D. Record System.
1. The laboratory shall have policies and
procedures for a record system which shall assure positive identification of
patient specimens from the time of specimen collection until the time of test
completion and results reporting. The record system shall include provisions
for test requisitions, test records and test reports. The configuration of the
system may be established by the laboratory, provided all of the required
information is readily retrievable for at least two years.
2. The laboratory shall perform tests at the
written or electronic request of an authorized person.
3. Records of test requisitions or test
authorizations shall be retained for a minimum of two years.
4. The test requisition shall include:
a. Identification of the patient;
b. The name of the authorized person who
ordered the test;
c. The test(s)
requested;
d. The date the test is
to be performed;
e. For Pap smears,
the patient's last menstrual period, age or date of birth and indication of
whether the patient had a previous abnormal report, treatment or
biopsy;
f. Any additional
information relevant and necessary to a specific test to assure accurate and
timely testing and reporting of results (Examples: age, sex, current
medications, time of specimen collection, diagnosis, type of specimen,
fasting).
5. Records of
patient testing, including instrument printouts, shall be retained for at least
two years. Immune hematology records and transfusion records shall be retained
for at least five years. (Exception: If an instrument is interfaced with a
computer, and the electronic data cannot be edited, the instrument printouts do
not have to be retained.)
6. Test
records shall provide documentation of the information required for test
requisitions as well as the following information:
a. Unique identification of the patient
specimen;
b. The date and time of
specimen receipt into the laboratory;
c. The condition and disposition of specimens
that do not meet the laboratory's criteria for specimen
acceptability;
d. The tests and
date of performance of each;
e. The
time of completion of testing;
f.
The identity of the person who performs each test.
7. The laboratory report shall be sent
promptly to the authorized person who requested the test.
8. A duplicate of each test report, including
both preliminary and final reports, shall be retained for at least two years.
The duplicate may be retained electronically as long as it contains the exact
information sent to the individual ordering the test and utilizing the test
results. For test reports requiring an authorized signature or containing
personnel identifiers, the exact duplicate must include the signature or
identifiers. Immunohematology reports shall be retained for at least five
years, and pathology reports shall be retained for at least 10 years.
9. The test report shall include the
following:
a. Identification of the
patient;
b. Date of specimen
collection;
c. The test(s)
performed;
d. Test results and, if
applicable, the units of measurement;
e. Date results were reported;
f. The condition and disposition of specimens
that do not meet the laboratory's criteria for acceptability;
g. Any additional information relevant and
necessary for the interpretation of the results of a specific test (Examples:
Type of specimen, time of specimen collection, fasting).
10. The laboratory shall have policies and
procedures for referring patient specimens to reference laboratories, to
include:
a. Current list of reference
laboratories, with the following information:
1) CLIA number;
2) Specialties and subspecialties in which
the laboratory is certified;
3)
Expiration date of CLIA certificate;
b. Specimen submission and
handling;
c. Record keeping
system.
11. The
laboratory shall not revise results or information directly related to the
interpretation of results provided by a reference laboratory.
12. The laboratory shall retain an exact
duplicate of each reference laboratory report, including each preliminary and
corrected report, for at least two years. Pathology reports from reference
laboratories shall be retained for 10 years, and immunohematology reports shall
be retained for five years.
13. The
laboratory's report shall indicate the test(s) performed by a reference
laboratory and the name and address of each laboratory location at which a test
was performed.
E. General
Quality Control.
1. The laboratory shall be
constructed, arranged and maintained to ensure the space, ventilation and
utilities necessary for conducting all phases of testing.
2. The laboratory shall have appropriate and
sufficient equipment, instruments, reagents, materials and supplies for the
type and volume of testing performed and for the maintenance of quality during
all phases of testing.
3. The
manufacturer's instructions shall be followed when using an instrument, kit or
test system.
4. Components of
reagent kits of different lot numbers shall not be interchanged unless
otherwise specified by the manufacturer.
5. The laboratory shall define criteria for
those conditions that are essential for proper storage of reagents and
specimens and for accurate and reliable test system operation and test result
reporting. These conditions shall include if applicable water quality,
temperature, humidity and protection of equipment and instrumentation from
fluctuations and interruptions in electrical current that adversely affect
patient test results and test reports. There shall be documentation of the
remedial actions taken to correct problems with these conditions.
6. Reagents, solutions, culture media,
control materials, calibration materials and other supplies, as appropriate,
shall be labeled to indicate the following:
a.
Identity and, when significant, titer, strength or concentration;
b. Recommended storage
requirements;
c. Preparation and
expiration dates;
d. Other
pertinent information required for proper use.
7. Reagents, solutions, culture media,
control materials, calibration materials and other supplies shall be prepared,
stored and handled in a manner to ensure that they are not used when the
expiration date has been exceeded or when they have deteriorated or are of
substandard quality.
8. The
laboratory shall comply with the Food and Drug Administration (FDA) product
dating requirements of
21 CFR
610.53 for blood, blood products and other
biologicals and with labeling requirements in
21 CFR
809.10 for all other in vitro diagnostics.
Any exception to the product dating requirements in
21 CFR
610.53 shall be granted by the FDA in the
form of an amendment of the product license, in accordance with
21 CFR
610.53(d). All exceptions
shall be documented by the laboratory.
9. Test methodologies and equipment shall be
selected and testing performed in a manner that provides test results within
the laboratory's stated performance specifications for each test.
10. Before the laboratory reports patient
test values using a new method or device, it shall first verify or establish
for each method the performance specifications for the following performance
characteristics, as applicable:
a.
Accuracy;
b. Precision;
c. Analytical sensitivity and specificity, to
include interfering substances;
d.
Reportable range of patient test results;
e. Reference range (normal values);
f. Any other performance characteristics
required for test performance;
The laboratory shall have documentation of the verification or
establishment of all applicable test performance specifications and shall
establish control and calibration procedures based upon those
specifications.
11. The laboratory shall perform maintenance
and function checks for all equipment, instruments and test systems according
to the manufacturers' instructions. If the manufacturer does not define
maintenance or function checks, the laboratory shall establish protocols
ensuring equipment, instruments or test systems perform accurately and
reliably. Maintenance and function checks shall be performed with at least the
frequency of the manufacturer's instructions.
12. All function checks and maintenance
activities shall be documented. The function checks shall be within the
laboratory's or manufacturer's established limits before patient testing is
conducted.
13. For each method or
device the laboratory shall perform calibration procedures:
a. At a minimum, in accordance with
manufacturer's instructions, if provided, using calibration materials provided
as specified, as appropriate, and with at least the frequency recommended by
the manufacturer; and
b. In
accordance with established laboratory criteria to include:
1) The number, type and concentration of
calibration materials, acceptable limits for calibration and the frequency of
calibration; and
2) Using
calibration materials appropriate for the methodology and, if possible,
traceable to a reference method or reference material of known value;
and
c. Whenever
calibration verification fails to meet the laboratory's established acceptable
limits for calibration verification.
14. For each method or device the laboratory
shall perform calibration verification procedures:
a. At a minimum, in accordance with the
manufacturer's instructions, if provided; and
b. In accordance with established laboratory
criteria to include:
1) The number, type and
concentration of calibration materials, acceptable limits for calibration
verification, and frequency of calibration verification;
2) Calibration materials appropriate for the
methodology and, if possible, traceable to a reference method or reference
material of known value;
3)
Verification of the laboratory's established reportable range of patient test
results, which shall include at least a minimal (or zero) value, a mid-point
value, and a maximum value at the upper limit of that range;
4) Performance of calibration verification at
least every six months or when the following occur:
a) A complete change of reagents for a
procedure is introduced, unless the laboratory can demonstrate that changing
reagent lot numbers does not affect the range used to report patient test
results and control values are not adversely affected by reagent lot number
changes;
b) There is a major
preventive maintenance or replacement of critical parts that may influence test
performance;
c) Controls reflect an
unusual trend or shift or are outside the laboratory's acceptable limits and
other means of assessing and correcting unacceptable control values have failed
to identify and correct the problem;
d) The laboratory's established schedule for
verifying the reportable range for patient test results requires more frequent
calibration verification than specified by the manufacturer.
15. All
calibration and calibration verification activities shall be
documented.
16. Control Procedures
- (Controls shall be performed as defined or as otherwise defined under a
specific category heading.)
a. For each device
the laboratory shall evaluate instrument and reagent stability and operator
variance in determining the number, type and frequency of testing calibration
or control materials and establish criteria for acceptability used to monitor
test performance during a run of patient specimen(s). A run is an interval
within which the accuracy and precision of a testing system is expected to be
stable, but it cannot be greater than 24 hours or less than the frequency
recommended by the manufacturer. For each procedure, the laboratory shall
monitor test performance using calibration materials or control materials or a
combination thereof.
Controls shall be performed as follows:
1) For qualitative tests, the laboratory
shall include a positive and a negative control with each run of patient
specimens. Internal procedural controls (both positive and negative) may be
used to satisfy this requirement.
2) For quantitative tests, the laboratory
shall include at least two samples of different concentrations of either
calibration materials, control materials, or a combination thereof with the
frequency not less than two levels per 24 hours of operation.
3) If calibration and control materials are
not available, the laboratory shall have an alternative mechanism to assure the
validity of patient test results.
4) Control samples shall be tested in the
same manner as patient test specimens.
5) When calibration or control materials are
used, statistical parameters (e.g., mean and standard deviation) for each lot
number of calibration or control material shall be determined through
repetitive testing. Levy-Jennings plots or other visual representation methods
shall be used to evaluate statistical data for trends and shifts. Weekly
supervisory review is required. Control values shall be evaluated as
follows:
a) The stated
values of assayed control material may be used as the target values provided
the stated values correspond to the methodology and instrumentation employed by
the laboratory and are verified by the laboratory;
b) Statistical parameters for unassayed
materials shall be established over time by the laboratory through concurrent
testing with calibration materials or control materials having previously
determined statistical parameters; and
c) Control results shall meet the
laboratory's criteria for acceptability prior to reporting patient test
results.
17. The
laboratory shall document all control activities. Documentation shall be
retained for a period of two years. Immunohematology quality control records
shall be retained for a period of five years. Cytology and histopathology
quality control records shall be retained for a period of 10 years.
F. Chemistry.
1. The following requirements apply only to
blood gas analysis, regardless of the testing site:
a. Follow the manufacturer's instructions
regarding calibration of the blood gas analyzer;
b. Test at least one (1) level of control
material each eight hours of patient testing;
c. Rotate the order in which the controls are
performed so that normal, alkalosis and acidosis levels are tested;
and
d. Test one (1) sample of
calibration material or control material each time patients are tested if the
instrument does not internally verify calibration at least every
30minutes.
2. For
electrophoretic determinations:
a. At least
one control sample shall be used in each electrophoretic cell;
b. The control sample shall contain fractions
representative of those routinely reported in the patient specimens.
G. Hematology.
1. There shall be at least two levels of
controls for non-manual hematology testing systems each eight hours in which
patient testing is performed.
2.
There shall be at least one level of control for manual cell counts each eight
hours in which patient testing is performed.
3. Manual cell counts shall be performed in
duplicate with documentation of both counts. The laboratory shall establish
criteria for the acceptable difference between duplicate counts.
4. There shall be two levels of controls for
non-manual coagulation testing systems each eight hours in which patient
testing is performed and each time a change in reagents occurs.
5. Each individual shall test two levels of
controls before performing manual coagulation testing on patient samples and
each time a change in reagents occurs.
6. Manual coagulation tests on both patient
and control specimens shall be performed in duplicate with documentation of
both times. The laboratory shall establish criteria for the acceptable
difference between duplicate times.
7. Background counts of diluents shall be
performed daily and results recorded.
8. If the microhematocrit centrifuge is used,
the maximum packing time shall be determined at least every six
months.
9. The laboratory director
shall establish written criteria for abnormal cell morphology requiring review
by a qualified physician who is board-certified or board-eligible in either
pathology or hematology.
10. The
laboratory shall maintain a file of unusual hematology slides to be used in the
orientation, training and continuing education of laboratory
personnel.
H. Immunology.
1. The equipment, glassware, reagents,
controls and techniques for tests for syphilis shall conform to manufacturers'
specifications.
2. The laboratory
shall run serologic tests on patient specimens concurrently with a positive
serum control of known titer or controls of graded reactivity plus a negative
control. (If patient results are reported in terms of graded reactivity,
controls of graded reactivity shall be used; if patient results are reported as
a titer, controls of known titer shall be used with results reported as a
titer.)
3. The laboratory shall
employ controls that evaluate all phases of the test system to ensure
reactivity and uniform dosages when positive and negative controls alone are
not sufficient.
4. A facility
manufacturing blood and blood products for transfusion or serving as a referral
laboratory for such a facility shall meet the following:
a. Syphilis serology testing requirements of
21 CFR
606.65 (c&e) and 640.5(a);
b. HIV testing requirements of 21 CFR 610.45
; and
c. Hepatitis testing
requirements of
21 CFR
610.40.
I. Immunohematology.
1. There shall be provision for prompt ABO
blood grouping, D(Rho) typing, unexpected antibody detection, compatibility
testing and laboratory investigation of transfusion reactions, either through
the facility or under arrangement with an approved facility that is certified
in Immunohematology and Transfusion Services and Blood Banking under the
Clinical Laboratory Improvement Amendments of 1988 (CLIA 88).
2. If the facility does not provide
immunohematological or blood banking services onsite, there shall be a written
agreement with an outside laboratory or blood bank that governs the
procurement, transfer and availability of blood and blood products. The
agreement shall be reviewed and approved by the laboratory director.
3. The laboratory shall perform and document
ABO group and D(Rho) typing on all donor red cells received from outside
sources prior to transfusing.
4.
The laboratory shall perform ABO group and D(Rho) typing, unexpected antibody
detection, antibody identification and compatibility testing in accordance with
manufacturers' instructions, if provided, and as applicable, with 21 CFR Part
606 (with the exception of
21 CFR
606.20.a, Personnel) and 21 CFR 640 et
seq.
5. The laboratory shall
perform ABO group by concurrently testing unknown red cells with anti-A and
anti-B grouping reagents. For confirmation of ABO group, the unknown serum
shall be tested with known A1 and B red cells. All reactions shall be
documented.
6. The laboratory shall
determine the D(Rho) type by testing and documenting the reaction of unknown
red cells with anti-D(Rho) blood grouping reagent.
7. If required in the manufacturer's package
insert for anti-D(Rho) reagents, the laboratory shall employ a control system
(Rh-hr control) capable of detecting false positive D(Rho) test
results.
8. Each day of use the
laboratory shall perform and document the following quality control checks for
each vial of antisera and reagent red cells:
a. Positive control only for ABO antisera,
ABO reagent red cells and antibody screening cells (at least one known
antibody); and
b. Positive and
negative controls for D(Rho) antisera, other antisera and anti-human globulin
(Coombs serum).
9.
Records shall identify the source and lot number of each reagent on each day of
use.
10. Policies and procedures to
ensure positive identification of a blood or blood product recipient shall be
established and followed.
11. Donor
blood and blood products shall be stored or maintained for transfusion under
conditions required to prevent deterioration and to ensure optimum integrity,
whether in the blood bank or in a remote storage refrigerator.
12. Donor blood shall be stored in a
refrigerator which meets the following criteria:
a. The refrigerator shall be connected to an
emergency power source;
b. An
audible alarm system shall monitor proper storage temperature and shall sound
at a location that is staffed 24 hours per day;
c. The refrigerator shall not be used for the
storage of hazardous or contaminated items;
d. The refrigerator shall have adequate space
to provide for segregated storage of the following:
1) Donor blood prior to completion of
tests;
2) Donor blood not suitable
for use; and
3) Autologous
units;
e. A temperature
recorder shall be connected to the refrigerator.
13. The high and low activation temperatures
of the alarm system shall be checked and documented at least quarterly. The
response to the activated alarm shall be documented.
14. The temperature recorder shall be
compared daily to a thermometer in the refrigerator. Results of the temperature
checks shall be documented.
15. The
temperature recorder chart shall be changed weekly, and the individual who
changes the chart shall initial and date it.
16. Written criteria shall be established for
daily inspection of the blood storage unit for:
a. Outdated blood;
b. Hemolysis;
c. Bacterial contamination; and
d. Unit integrity.
e. Blood shall be visually inspected at the
time of issue. Results of all inspections shall be
recorded.
17. Records
shall be maintained of all blood or blood components received, cross matched,
transfused, expired or returned to the supplier.
18. Patient's serum less than 72 hours old
shall be used in the compatibility procedure.
19. All blood for transfusions, except for
autologous transfusions, shall be tested for hepatitis and for HIV antibodies
before it is transfused. The tests for hepatitis and/or HIV antibodies may be
performed by the supplier or by the institution in which the blood is
transfused.
20. Samples of both
patient and donor blood shall be retained at least seven days following
transfusion.
21. Procedures shall
be established for the prompt investigation of all suspected transfusion
reactions. The laboratory director shall review all suspected transfusion
reactions, and a report shall be given to a committee of the Medical
Staff.
22. Criteria shall be
established for the reissuing of donor blood to ensure that the blood has been
maintained under conditions required to ensure the safety of individuals being
transfused within the facility.
23.
Records of therapeutic phlebotomies shall be maintained, detailing the patient
name, date, time, amount drawn, phlebotomist and disposition of the blood.
Blood drawn as a therapeutic phlebotomy shall not be used for
transfusion.
24. A committee of the
Medical Staff shall fulfill the following responsibilities:
a. Establish criteria for the proper use of
blood and its components;
b.
Monitor the transfusion of blood and its components to ensure the established
criteria for proper use are met;
c.
Review the reports of suspected transfusion reactions;
d. Establish criteria for therapeutic
phlebotomies.
25. Blood
banking policies and procedures shall conform to the current Standards for
Blood Banks and Transfusion Services of the American Association of Blood
Banks.
J. Urinalysis.
1. Routine urinalysis shall be performed
within two hours of collection of the specimen unless the specimen is
refrigerated.
2. Manufacturers'
instructions shall be followed for all tests.
3. Two levels of controls shall be performed
and documented each day of patient testing utilizing an automated strip
reader.
4. A refractometer for
measuring urine specific gravity shall be checked each day of use with a low
(1.000) and upper level standard or control.
K. Microbiology.
1. Each day of use, the laboratory shall
evaluate the detection phase of direct antigen systems using an appropriate
positive and negative control organism or antigen extract. When direct antigen
systems include an extraction phase, the system shall be checked, each day of
use, using a positive organism.
2.
The laboratory shall check each batch or shipment of reagents, discs, stains,
antisera and identification systems (systems using two or more substrates) when
prepared or opened for positive and negative reactivity, as well as graded
reactivity, if applicable.
3.
Unless otherwise specified, each day of use the laboratory shall test staining
materials for intended reactivity to ensure predictable staining
characteristics.
4. The laboratory
shall check fluorescent stains for positive and negative reactivity each time
of use (unless otherwise specified).
5. The laboratory shall check each batch or
shipment of media for sterility, if it is intended to be sterile and sterility
is required for testing. Media shall be checked for its ability to support
growth and, as appropriate, selectivity/inhibition and/or biochemical
response.
6. The laboratory may use
the manufacturer's control checks of media provided the manufacturers' product
insert specifies that the manufacturer's quality control checks meet the
National Committee for Clinical Laboratory Standards (NCCLS) for media quality
control. The laboratory shall document that the physical characteristics of the
media are not compromised and report any deterioration of the media to the
manufacturer.
7. The laboratory
shall follow the manufacturer's specifications for using the media and be
responsible for the test results.
8. The following media shall be retested
using NCCLS standards for growth, inhibition and selectivity, as applicable:
a. Campylobacter agar;
b. Media for the selective isolation of
pathogenic Neisseria;
c. Media used
to isolate parasites, viruses, Mycoplasma, Chlamydia;
d. Mueller-Hinton media used for
antimicrobial susceptibility tests; and
e. Media commercially prepared and packaged
as a unit or system consisting of two or more different substrates, primarily
used for microbial identification.
9. The laboratory shall check positive and
negative reactivity with control organisms as follows:
a. Each day of use for catalase, coagulase,
beta-lactamase, and oxidase reagents and DNA probes;
b. Each week of use for Gram and acid-fast
stains and for bacitracin, optochin, ONPG, X and V discs or strips;
c. Each month of use for antisera;
d. Each week of use the laboratory shall
check XV discs or strips with a positive control;
e. For antimicrobial susceptibility tests,
the laboratory shall check each new batch of media and each lot of
antimicrobial discs or wells before or concurrent with initial use using
approved reference organisms:
1) The
laboratory's zone sizes or minimum inhibitory concentrations (MIC) for
reference organisms shall be within established limits before reporting patient
test results;
2) Each day tests are
performed the laboratory shall use the appropriate control organisms to check
the procedure unless adequate precision can be demonstrated. Once adequate
precision is demonstrated, the controls may be performed each week of use.
Documentation of precision studies is required.
10. Antibiotic sensitivities shall be
performed using a recognized method. If the Kirby-Bauer method is utilized:
a. Proper sized petri dishes shall be
used;
b. Disc zone sizes shall be
measured and recorded, or a template shall be used; and
c. A standardized inoculum shall be
used.
11. Records shall
reflect all tests used to isolate and identify organisms.
12. For laboratories performing
mycobacteriological testing, the laboratory shall:
a. Each day of use check the iron uptake test
with at least one positive and one negative acid-fast control organism. Check
all other reagents or test procedures used for identification with at least a
positive acid-fast control organism.
b. Each week of use check the fluorochrome
acid-fast stain's reactivity with a positive and a negative control
organism;
c. Each week of use check
the acid-fast stain's reactivity with a positive control organism;
and
d. Each week of use, check the
procedure for susceptibility tests performed on Mycobacterium tuberculosis
isolated with a strain of Mycobacterium tuberculosis susceptible to all
antimycobacterial agents tested.
13. For laboratories conducting mycological
testing, the laboratory shall:
a. Each day of
use, if using the auxanographic medium for nitrate assimilation, check the
nitrate reagents with a peptone control;
b. Each week of use check the acid-fast
stain's reactivity with a positive and a negative control organism;
and
c. Each day of use test each
drug for susceptibility tests with at least one control strain that is
susceptible to the drug and ensure that patient test results are reported only
when control results are within the laboratory's established control
limits.
14. For
laboratories performing parasitology tests, the laboratory shall:
a. Have available a reference collection of
slides or photographs and, if available, gross specimens for identification of
parasites and use these references in the laboratory for appropriate comparison
with diagnostic specimens;
b.
Calibrate and use the calibrated ocular micrometer for determining the size of
ova and parasites, if size is a critical parameter. Calibration of the
micrometer shall be checked annually or after microscope repair or major
maintenance. Documentation of the calibration is required; and
c. Check permanent stains each month of use
using a fecal sample control that will demonstrate staining
characteristics.
15. For
laboratories performing virology tests, the laboratory shall:
a. Have available host systems for the
isolation of viruses and identification methods that cover the entire range of
viruses that are etiologically related to clinical diseases for which services
are offered;
b. Maintain records
that reflect the systems used and the reactions observed; and
c. Simultaneously culture, for identification
tests, uninoculated cells or cell substrate controls as a negative control to
detect erroneous identification results.
16. A microbiological safety cabinet shall be
used when mycobacteriology or mycology cultures are manipulated. The cabinet
shall meet the following special requirements:
a. Have a face velocity of at least 75 feet
per minute;
b. Be connected to an
independent exhaust system;
c. Have
filters with 99.97 percent efficiency (based on the dioctylphthalate (DOP) test
method) in the exhaust system;
d.
Be designed and equipped to permit the safe removal, disposal and replacement
of contaminated filters; and
e. Be
provided with a means of disinfection.
17. Mycology, mycobacteriology or virology
cultures shall be disinfected prior to leaving the control of the
laboratory.
L. Pathology
(Histopathology and Cytology).
1. The
ventilation system shall be adequate to properly remove vapors, fumes and
excessive heat.
2. Staining dishes
shall be properly labeled and covered when not in use.
3. Flow charts that reflect the staining
procedure used shall be available.
4. A control slide of known reactivity shall
be included with each slide or group of slides for differential or special
stains. Reaction of the control slide with each special stain shall be
documented.
5. For cytology stains:
a. All gynecologic smears shall be stained
using a Papanicolaou (PAP) or modified PAP staining method;
b. Effective measures shall be taken to
prevent cross-contamination between gynecologic and non-gynecologic specimens
during the staining process;
c.
Non-gynecologic specimens that have a high potential for cross contamination
shall be stained separately from other non- gynecologic specimens, and the
stains shall be filtered or changed following staining.
6. All cytology slide preparations shall be
retained for five years.
7. For
histopathology:
a. All stained slides shall be
retained at least 10 years;
b. All
specimen blocks shall be retained at least two years; and
c. All remnants of tissue specimens shall be
retained in a manner that assures proper preservation of the tissue specimens
until the portions submitted for microscopic examination have been examined and
a diagnosis has been made.
8. An exact duplicate of each test report
shall be retained for at least 10 years.
9. The following reports shall be signed to
reflect the review of a board- certified pathologist, or, as applicable,
another individual meeting the qualifications specified in the CLIA
requirements:
a. All tissue pathology
reports;
b. All non-gynecologic
cytology reports;
c. All
gynecologic cytology reports on smears containing cells exhibiting reactive or
reparative changes, atypical squamous/glandular cells, premalignant or
malignant condition.
NOTE: If an electronic signature is used, the laboratory shall
ensure that only the authorized person can release the signature. Refer to
Section 14, Health Information Services.
10. The laboratory shall compare clinical
information, when available, with cytology reports and shall compare each
malignant and premalignant gynecology report with the histopathology report, if
available, and determine the causes of any discrepancies.
11. All tissues surgically removed shall be
examined by an anatomic pathologist. The Medical Staff shall develop a list of
tissues that need not be examined.
12. A frozen section diagnosis, as reported
to the surgeon, shall be documented and signed by the pathologist at the time
the frozen section is performed. The documentation may be on the requisition, a
patient test log, or a report form.
13. Autopsy services shall be under the
supervision of a board-certified pathologist.
14. Autopsy findings in a complete protocol
shall be filed in the patient's medical record within 60 days of the autopsy. A
provisional anatomical diagnosis shall be recorded within 72hours after
autopsy. A duplicate copy of the autopsy report shall be maintained in the
laboratory autopsy file.
M. Radiobioassay.
1. Background checks shall be performed each
day at the proper window setting for each type of isotope being used, as
applicable.
2. Criteria for
unacceptable changes in background levels shall be established.
3. Safety precautions shall be written and
appropriately displayed. Film badges and/or rings shall be worn, as
applicable.
4. There shall be
written procedures to assure reliability of testing and safety of patients and
personnel.
5. All procedures for
safety and disposal of radioactive waste shall conform to the most current
Rules and Regulations for Control of Sources of Ionizing Radiation adopted and
promulgated by the Arkansas State Board of Health.
N. Quality Assurance/Performance Improvement.
1. Each laboratory shall establish a Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement plan. The plan shall follow written policies
and procedures for a comprehensive program which monitors and evaluates the
ongoing and overall quality of the total testing process. The plan shall
evaluate the effectiveness of the laboratory's policies and procedures,
identify and correct problems, assure the accurate, reliable and prompt
reporting of test results, and assure the adequacy and competency of the staff.
As necessary, the laboratory shall revise policies and procedures based upon
the results of those evaluations.
2. All Quality Assurance/Performance
Improvement activities shall be documented.
3. The laboratory shall have an ongoing
mechanism for monitoring and evaluating the following:
a. The criteria established for patient
preparation, specimen collection, labeling, preservation and
transportation;
b. The information
solicited and obtained on the laboratory requisition for its completeness,
relevance and necessity for testing patient specimens;
c. The use and appropriateness of criteria
established for specimen rejection;
d. The completeness, usefulness and accuracy
of the test report information necessary for the interpretation or utilization
of test results;
e. The timely
reporting of test results based on testing priorities (STAT, routine,
manufacturer's instructions, etc.);
f. The accuracy and reliability of test
reporting and record storage and retrieval;
g. The effectiveness of corrective actions
taken for:
1) Problems identified during the
evaluation of calibration and control data for each test method;
2) Problems identified during the evaluation
of patient test values for the purpose of verifying the reference range of a
test method;
3) Errors detected in
previously reported test results.
h. The effectiveness of corrective actions
taken for any unacceptable, unsatisfactory or unsuccessful proficiency testing
results.
4. Laboratories
that perform the same testing using different methodologies or instruments, or
perform the same test at multiple testing sites, shall have a system that twice
a year evaluates and defines the relationship between test results using
different methodologies, instruments or test sites.
5. Laboratories that perform tests that are
not challenged with a proficiency testing program shall have a system for
verifying the accuracy and reliability of its test results at least twice per
year.
6. The laboratory shall have
a mechanism to identify and evaluate patient test results that appear
inconsistent with relevant criteria such as patient age, sex, diagnosis or
pertinent clinical data, when provided; distribution of patient test results,
when available; and relationship with other test parameters, when
available.
7. The laboratory shall
have an ongoing mechanism to evaluate the effectiveness of its policies and
procedures for assuring employee competence.
8. The laboratory shall have a system in
place to document problems that occur as a result of breakdowns in
communication between the laboratory and the authorized individual who orders
or receives the results of test procedures or examinations. Corrective actions
shall be taken, as necessary, to resolve the problems and minimize
communication breakdowns.
9. The
laboratory shall have a system in place to assure that all complaints and
problems reported to the laboratory are documented. Investigations of
complaints shall be made, when appropriate, and, as necessary, corrective
actions shall be instituted.
10.
The laboratory shall have a mechanism for documenting and assessing problems
identified during quality assurance/performance improvement reviews and
discussing them with the staff. The laboratory shall take corrective actions
that prevent reoccurrences.
11. The
laboratory shall maintain documentation of all quality assurance/performance
improvement activities, including problems identified and corrective actions
taken. All quality assurance/performance improvement records shall be available
and maintained for a period of two years.
O. Safety.
1. The physical plant and environmental
conditions of the laboratory shall provide a safe environment in which
employees, as well as all other individuals, are protected from physical,
chemical and biological hazards.
2.
Safety precautions shall be established, posted and observed to ensure
protection from physical, chemical, biochemical and electrical hazards as well
as biohazardous materials.
P. Point of Care Testing.
1. The requirements under this section apply
only to the following tests which employ simple and accurate methodologies, as
defined by the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC):
a. Dipstick or tablet reagent
urinalysis;
b. Fecal occult
blood;
c. Urine pregnancy tests
(visual color comparison);
d.
Hemoglobin by single analyte instrument with self-contained or component
features to perform specimen/reagent interaction, providing direct measurement
and readout;
e. Whole blood glucose
by devices approved for home use;
f. Spun microhematocrit;
g. Whole blood immunoassay for Helicobacter
pylori;
h. Rapid test for Group A
streptococcal antigen from throat swabs; and
i. Glycosylated hemoglobin (Hgb
Alc).
2. All testing
personnel shall have earned a high school diploma or equivalent.
3. There shall be documentation that prior to
testing patients' specimens each individual has received training for each test
to be performed and has demonstrated the ability to perform all testing
operations reliably.
4.
Manufacturer's instructions for each of the tests shall be available in each
area in which the specific test is performed and shall be followed by all
testing personnel.
5. Components of
reagent kits of different lot numbers shall not be interchanged unless
otherwise specified by the manufacturer.
6. Reagents, control and calibration
materials and other supplies shall be stored and handled in a manner to ensure
that they are not used when the expiration date has been exceeded or when they
have deteriorated or are of substandard quality.
7. Quality control procedures shall be
performed in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions, at a minimum.
Additional quality control procedures shall be performed as determined by the
director of the hospital laboratory.
8. Maximum packing time of the
microhematocrit centrifuge shall be determined at least every six
months.
9. The test record system
shall include at least the following:
a.
Identification of the patient;
b.
Name of the authorized person who ordered the test;
c. Test performed;
d. Date and time of test
performance;
e. Identity of the
person who performed the test;
f.
Test results; and
g. Any additional
information relevant and necessary for the interpretation of the results of a
specific test.
10. The
configuration of the test system shall be determined by the facility.
11. All required records shall be readily
retrievable for at least two (2) years.
12. Point of Care Testing shall be included
in the hospital laboratory's Quality Assurance/Performance Improvement
program.
13. Any tests other than
those specified in P(1) above shall be subject to all of the requirements of
Section 19.
SECTION
20
: RADIOLOGICAL SERVICES.
A. Radiology.
1. Each hospital shall have shock-proof
diagnostic X-ray facilities.
2.
Radiological Services shall be under the direction of a physician, who is a
member of the Medical Staff.
a. The physician
director shall be certified (or eligible for examination) by the American Board
of Radiology.
b. At a minimum, a
board certified radiologist shall be available on a consultative basis.
Documentation of the radiologist's visits shall be required.
3. Radiological Services shall be
supervised by a technologist who is qualified by experience or education and
has at least two years technical experience.
4. A radiologic technologist with at least
two years training shall be on duty 24 hours or on call at all times.
5. Radiologic staff who use the radiologic
equipment and administer procedures shall have written verification of training
and shall have approval in writing by the physician director.
6. Radiologic technologists shall not
independently perform fluoroscopic procedures.
7. Radiologic staff who administer agents for
diagnostic purposes shall have written verification of training. A current list
of radiology employees who administer agents for diagnostic purposes shall be
approved by the physician director and maintained by the facility.
8. Radiology personnel who participate in
direct patient care shall maintain competency in life support measures or the
equivalent.
9. Clinically relevant
educational programs shall be conducted at regularly scheduled intervals with
not less than 12 per year. There shall be evidence of program dates,
attendance, and subject matter.
10.
Policies and procedures for the department shall have evidence of ongoing
review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall have the annual
review date, signature of the department and/or person(s) conducting the
review. Policies and procedures shall include:
a. Job descriptions for every type
employee;
b. A written list of all
tests/procedures performed by the Radiology Department and the list shall be
available to the Medical Staff;
c.
Infection prevention and control measures;
d. The holding of patients;
e. Orientation practices for new
employees;
f. Operation of
equipment;
g. Management of an
adverse reaction;
h. Cleaning and
disinfecting procedures; and
i.
Posting of signs.
11.
Radiology personnel shall receive yearly instruction in:
a. Safety precautions; and
b. Managing emergency radiation hazards and
accidents.
12. A
documented preventive maintenance and quality control program shall include:
a. Radiology personnel shall follow the
dosimetry requirements identified in the Rules for Control of Sources
of Ionizing Radiation.
b.
Preventive maintenance for all diagnostic and therapeutic radiologic equipment
to assure a safe working condition. Safety and calibration checks shall be made
according to manufacturer's directions, not exceeding one year
intervals;
c. Annual inspection of
all leaded gloves, aprons and similar protective devices at least once a year
with documentation to include: the name of the examiner, identification of the
protective device examined and the results plus corrective action
taken;
d. Documentation of safety,
calibration, and inspection checks maintained for the life of the equipment;
and
e. Remedial and corrective
action recorded in response to equipment "down time," with documentation to
include: the piece of equipment involved, time/date malfunction occurred,
action taken, time/date when the equipment became operational.
13. X-ray films shall not be
stored in radiologic examination rooms.
14. X-ray films shall be filed according to a
recognized filing system.
15. X-ray
prescription/work requests shall be authorized by a written and signed
physician's order and shall include the following:
a. Identification of the patient;
b. Date the test was ordered;
c. Physician's name;
d. Concise statement as to the reason why the
X-ray/test was ordered; and
e.
Originator's signature.
16. The radiologic report shall be signed by
a physician and shall be placed in the medical record.
17. The Radiological Services shall have an
ongoing QA/PI program that addresses patient care issues. A mechanism for
reporting results of audits shall be provided, to include: indicators
monitored, thresholds/standards, results, corrective plan/corrective action
taken and follow-up.
18. This
section establishes requirements for radiology that are in addition to, not in
substitution of the Rules for Control of Sources of Ionizing
Radiation.
19. Actual X-ray film
shall be retained for five years.
20. X-ray films and reports shall be stored
in a room that is equipped with a smoke detection system. An extinguishing
system shall be made available.
21.
Locked security shall be ensured for the written reports maintained in the
X-ray file when the storage area is not under the direct supervision of
radiology personnel.
22. Dual image
viewing shall be available in the OR, ER & Radiology areas.
23. Facilities shall maintain the capacity to
view x-ray films.
B.
Nuclear Medicine Services.
1. Nuclear Medicine
procedures shall be under the direction of a physician, qualified in Nuclear
Medicine, who is a member of the Medical Staff.
2. Nuclear Medicine services shall be
supervised by a nuclear medicine technologist who has completed certification
requirements and has at least two years technical experience.
3. Nuclear Medicine staff who use the
equipment and administer procedures shall have written verification of training
and shall have approval in writing by the physician director and Medical
Staff.
4. All radioactive materials
shall be purchased, stored, administered and disposed of in a manner consistent
with the requirements of the Rules for Control of Sources of Ionizing Radiation
or with the specific condition of a Radioactive Material License issued
pursuant to these rules.
5. The
policy and procedure manual shall be reviewed annually and revised as
necessary. Included in the manual shall be a cover page with signatures of
those reviewing the manual and a month/day/year of review. The policies and
procedures shall include:
a. Job description
for each employee;
b. A list of
tests/procedures performed by Nuclear Medicine;
c. Safety practices;
d. Management of an adverse
reaction;
e. Orientation for new
employees;
f. Operation of
equipment;
g. Cleaning and
disinfecting procedures;
h. Posting
of signs;
i. Quality
control;
j. Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement;
k. Clean up of spills;
l. Receipt/disposal of radioactive materials;
and
m. Radiation safety
plan.
6. All nuclear
medicine personnel who participate in direct patient care shall maintain
competency in life support measures.
7. There shall be a documented preventive
maintenance and quality control program:
a.
Monitoring of nuclear medicine personnel for exposure to radiation shall be
integrated over a period not to exceed one month;
b. Nuclear medicine personnel shall follow
the dosimetry requirements identified in the Rules and Regulations for
Control of Sources of Ionizing Radiation;
c. All nuclear medicine equipment shall be
maintained in safe working condition. Preventive maintenance, safety and
calibration checks shall be made according to manufacturer's directions, not to
exceed one-year interval;
d.
Documentation of all safety, calibration and inspection checks shall be
maintained for the life of the equipment; and
e. Remedial and corrective action shall be
recorded in response to equipment "down time." Documentation shall include: the
piece of equipment involved, time/date malfunction occurred, action taken, and
time/date when equipment became operational again.
8. The nuclear medicine "hot lab" shall be
kept locked when not under the direct supervision of authorized
personnel.
9. There shall be an
emergency eye wash available in the nuclear medicine "hot lab".
10. All nuclear medicine staff who administer
agents for diagnostic purposes shall have written verification of training and
approval by the physician director and individual(s) supervising the
training.
11. Clinically relevant
educational programs shall be conducted on regularly scheduled intervals at not
less than 12 per year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance,
and subject matter.
12. All nuclear
medicine requests shall be authorized by a written and signed physician's order
and shall include the following:
a.
Identification of the patient;
b.
Date;
c. Physician's
name;
d. Originator's signature;
and
e. Reason/justification for the
test.
13. The nuclear
medicine report shall be signed by a physician. The original shall be placed in
the medical record.
14. Films shall
not be stored in radiologic or nuclear medicine examination rooms.
15. The storage of nuclear medicine films
shall comply with the guidelines under Section 20, Radiological
Services.
C. Guidelines
for Mobile Services. The Governing Body and Medical Staff shall approve the
provisions for establishing services in accordance with the following criteria:
1. General Considerations.
a. The installation is governed by the
following Arkansas Department of Health publications:
1) Rules for Hospitals and Related
Institutions in Arkansas, Section 20, Radiological Services; and
2) Rules for Control of Source of Ionizing
Radiation.
b. Approvals
shall be granted by the Arkansas Department of Health:
1) Health Facility Services; and
2) Radiation Control and Emergency
Management.
c. The mobile
service provider shall maintain fire, theft, general and professional liability
insurance.
2. Operating
Policies.
a. All examinations shall be
authorized by a written and signed physician's order;
b. Examinations shall be performed under the
direction of and interpreted by a qualified physician, with documented training
or experience, who is a member of the hospital's Medical Staff;
c. Examinations shall be performed by a
licensed radiologic technologist;
d. The Radiology Department shall maintain
current policies and procedures for use of the mobile units to include
infection prevention and control and safety;
e. All personnel who administer agents for
diagnostic purposes shall have written verification of training and approval by
the physician director and individual(s) supervising the training;
f. Hospital personnel shall transport
patients to and from the mobile unit according to hospital safety
policies;
g. Oxygen and emergency
medical supplies shall be maintained and readily available;
h. The hospital Pharmacy may provide
necessary medical supplies including contrast media, but proper handling and
control of dated items shall be ensured;
i. A log of all patients shall be
maintained;
j. Films shall be
maintained in the same manner as X-ray films;
k. Personnel who participate in direct
patient care shall be competent in life support measures; and
l. Contracted services shall be under current
agreement and the contractor shall fulfill all requirements of this
section.
3. Refer to
Section 52, Physical Facilities, Imaging Suite
SECTION 21
: PHYSICAL THERAPY.
Licensed physical therapist means any person licensed to
practice physical therapy by the Arkansas State Board of Physical
Therapy.
The practice of licensed physical therapy assistants shall be
performed under the supervision of the licensed physical therapist. The
supervising therapist shall be readily available for consultations, evaluations
and establishment of each program prior to delegation of any treatments and
determination of patient discharge.
If physical therapy services are rendered by an individual who
does not meet at least the assistantlevel qualifications (aide/technician), a
qualified physical therapist shall be on the premises and immediately available
to provide assistance and direction throughout the time the services are
rendered.
A. Physical therapy services
shall be provided under the direction of a physician member of the Medical
Staff.
B. Physical therapy services
shall be supervised by a physical therapist licensed by the Arkansas State
Board of Physical Therapy. Physical therapy assistants and aides shall comply
with all state licensure requirements.
C. A policy and procedure manual for Physical
Therapy shall be developed. The manual shall have evidence of ongoing review
and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall have the annual review
date, signature of the department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the
review.
D. There shall be written
policies and procedures which shall include:
1. Job descriptions for each type of
employee;
2. Infection prevention
and control measures;
3. Standards
of care;
4. Criteria for assuring
continuous communication of the patient's therapy and progress to the
physician;
5. Assembly and
operation of equipment;
6. Physical
therapy services provided and a list of services made available to the Medical
Staff;
7. Documentation specifying
who may perform special procedures and give patient instruction; this shall be
verified by the physician director;
8. Safety practices;
9. Orientation practices for new employees;
and
10. Cleaning, disinfecting and
sterilizing procedures.
E. There shall be an adequate supply of
reference material for the physical therapist which shall include current
literature.
F. All physical therapy
prescriptions/work requests shall be authorized by a written and signed
physician's order.
G. Equipment
shall be adequate for the services offered and maintained in good repair.
1. Equipment shall be serviced, calibrated
and operated according to the manufacturer's directions.
2. All physical therapy equipment shall be
under the control of the physical therapy supervisor.
3. A preventive maintenance program shall be
implemented with periodic inspection of all equipment and appropriate records
maintained for the life of each piece of equipment.
4. All temperature-dependent patient use
equipment shall have the temperature checked and recorded before each patient
use or at least daily, if used, to ensure patient safety.
H. Physical therapy records for each patient
shall include:
1. Current written plan of
care;
2. Statement of treatment
objectives;
3. Statement of
patient's short-term and long-term rehabilitation potential;
4. Functional limitations;
5. Justification of continued rehabilitative
care; and
6. Documentation of daily
treatments.
I. Clinically
relevant educational programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled
interval not less than 12 times per year. There shall be evidence of program
dates, attendance and subject matter.
J. All physical therapy personnel who
participate in direct patient care shall be competent in life support
measures.
K. There shall be an
ongoing QA/PI program.
L. Hospitals
which have swimming pools shall comply with applicable sections of Rules
Pertaining to Swimming Pools and Other Related Facilities.
M. Contracted physical therapy services shall
be under current agreement and the contractor shall fulfill all requirements of
this Section.
SECTION 22
: OCCUPATIONAL THERAPY.
In facilities with an organized Occupational Therapy
Department, the following shall apply:
A. Occupational Therapy Services shall be
under the direction of a physician member of the Medical Staff.
B. Occupational Therapy Services shall be
supervised by a currently licensed therapist in the field of rehabilitation
services.
C. There shall be
sufficient occupational therapy supportive technical staff to provide
authorized Occupational Therapy Services.
D. The policy and procedure manual shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department supervisor and/or
person(s) conducting the review.
E.
There shall be written policies and procedures which shall include:
1. Job descriptions for every type of
employee;
2. Documentation
specifying who may perform special procedures and give patient instructions.
This shall be verified by the physician director;
3. Orientation practices for new
employees;
4. Occupational therapy
services provided and a list of services provided to the Medical Staff;
and
5. Safety practices.
F. Current reference material
shall be available for the occupational therapist.
G. All occupational therapy
prescriptions/work requests shall be authorized by a written and signed
physician's order.
H. Equipment
shall be adequate for the services offered and maintained in good repair.
1. Equipment shall be serviced, calibrated
and operated according to the manufacturer's directions.
2. All occupational therapy equipment shall
be under the control of the occupational therapy supervisor.
3. A preventive maintenance program shall be
implemented with periodic inspection of all equipment and appropriate records
maintained for the life of each piece of equipment.
4. All temperature-dependent patient use
equipment shall have the temperature checked and recorded before each patient
use.
When appropriate elements are planned and arranged for shared
use by physical therapy patients and staff, one or both services shall be
responsible for the preventive maintenance program and the retention of
records.
I.
Occupational therapy records for each patient shall include:
1. Current written plan of care;
2. Statement of treatment
objectives;
3. Statement of
patient's short-term and long-term rehabilitation potential;
4. Justification of any continued
rehabilitation care; and
5.
Documentation of the patient's condition and response to treatments.
J. Clinically relevant educational
programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis at not less than 12
per year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
K. All occupational therapy
personnel shall maintain competency in life support measures.
L. There shall be an ongoing QA/PI
program.
M. Contracted occupational
therapy services shall be under current agreement and the contractor shall
fulfill all requirements of this Section.
SECTION 23
: SPEECH PATHOLOGY/AUDIOLOGY
SERVICES.
In facilities with an organized Speech Language
Pathology/Audiology Services Department, the following shall apply:
A. Speech Pathology/Audiology Services shall
be under the direction of a physician member of the Medical Staff.
B. Speech Pathology/Audiology Services shall
be supervised by a therapist who is currently licensed.
C. There shall be sufficient supportive
personnel to provide authorized speech pathology/audiology services.
D. There shall be documentation, verified by
the physician director, of who may perform special procedures and give patient
instructions.
E. Policies and
procedures shall have evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first
page of each manual shall have the annual review date, signature of the
department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the review.
F. There shall be written policies and
procedures which shall include:
1. Job
descriptions for every type of employee;
2. Orientation procedures for new
employees;
3. Infection prevention
and control measures;
4. A listing
of services/treatments available to the Medical Staff; and
5. Safety practices.
G. Equipment shall be in good repair and
under the control of the therapist supervisor. Documentation of preventive
maintenance shall be maintained for the life of each piece of
equipment.
H. Current reference
material shall be available for the department.
I. Clinically relevant educational programs
shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis at not less than 12 per year.
There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
J. All speech
pathology/audiology prescriptions/work requests shall be authorized by a
written and signed physician's order.
K. Speech Pathology/Audiology Services
records for each patient shall include:
1.
Current written plan of care;
2.
Statement of treatment objectives;
3. Statement of patient's short-term and
long-term rehabilitation potential;
4. Justification of any continued
rehabilitation care; and
5.
Documentation of progress notes following treatment given to
patients.
L. All Speech
Pathology/Audiology personnel shall maintain competency in life support
measures.
M. There shall be an
ongoing QA/PI program.
N.
Contracted Speech Pathology/Audiology Services shall be under current agreement
and the contractor shall fulfill all requirements of this Section.
SECTION 24
: RECREATIONAL
THERAPY.
In facilities with organized Recreational Therapy Services, the
following shall apply:
A. Recreational
Therapy Services shall be under the direction of a physician member of the
Medical Staff.
B. Recreational
Therapy Services shall be supervised by a therapist with current
certification.
C. There shall be
sufficient Recreational Therapy supportive staff to provide authorized
Recreational Therapy Services.
D.
There shall be documentation, verified by the physician director, of who may
perform special procedures and give patient instructions.
E. The policy and procedure manual shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision.
The first page of the manual shall have the annual review date,
signature of the department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the
review.
F. There shall be
written policies and procedures which shall include:
1. Job descriptions;
2. Infection prevention and control
measures;
3. Recreational Therapy
Services provided and a list of services shall be made available to the Medical
Staff;
4. Orientation practices for
new employees and volunteer personnel;
5. Assembly, operation and maintenance of all
equipment;
6. Safety
practices;
7. Security of supplies
and tools; and
8. Activities
off-campus.
G. All
equipment, tools and machines shall be in good repair and under the control of
the therapist supervisor. Documentation of preventive maintenance shall be
maintained for the life of each piece of equipment.
H. Current reference material shall be
available for the department.
I.
Clinically relevant educational programs shall be conducted on a regularly
scheduled basis at not less than 12 per year. There shall be evidence of
program dates, attendance, and subject matter.
J. All recreational therapy
prescriptions/work requests shall be authorized by a written and signed
physician's order and shall include:
1.
Identification of the patient;
2.
Date;
3. Physician's
name;
4. Type, frequency and
duration of treatment; and
5.
Originating signature.
K.
Recreational Therapy Service records for each patient shall include:
1. Current written plan of care;
2. Documentation of attendance by the
therapist in team meetings and the contribution by the therapist to the
treatment plan;
3. Statement of
treatment objectives;
4. Statement
of patient's short-term and long-term rehabilitation potential;
5. Record of daily activity
participation;
6. Justification of
any continued rehabilitation care; and
7. Progress notes.
L. All Recreational Therapy personnel shall
maintain competency in life support measures.
M. There shall be an ongoing QA/PI
program.
N. If food and/or
nutritional service functions are offered, infection prevention and control,
storage and supervision shall be coordinated with the Dietary Department of the
facility.
O. Contracted
Recreational Therapy Services shall be under current agreement and the
contractor shall fulfill all requirements of this Section.
SECTION 25
: PET THERAPY PROGRAM
Definitions.
"Program" means Pet Therapy Program.
"Pet" means an animal that has been specifically screened,
trained, and authorized by the hospital to participate in the Program.
"Handler" means an individual who has been specifically
credentialed and authorized by the hospital to participate in, and to accompany
and control pets participating in, the Program.
A. The Program shall be approved by the
Governing Body, Medical Staff, and the Infection Prevention and Control
Committee.
B. The Infection
Prevention and Control Committee shall, in conjunction with a licensed
Veterinarian, establish the Medical Criteria that each pet shall meet in order
to participate in the Program.
C.
The hospital shall establish the Behavioral Criteria that each pet shall meet
before participating in the Program.
D. A licensed Veterinarian shall certify that
a participating pet:
1. Meets the hospital's
medical criteria; and
2. Is free of
zoonotic communicable disease causing organisms.
E. A licensed Veterinarian, a local
protection society or a pet therapy association or society shall certify that a
participating pet meets the Hospital's Behavioral Criteria.
F. Pets found to have a communicable disease
shall be excluded from the Pet Therapy Program until the pet is treated and has
one negative culture, if culturing of the causative agent is feasible. Pets
expressing behavioral problems will be excluded from the program until the
behavioral problem is remedied.
G.
Pets shall be bathed and groomed before each hospital visit. Pets shall be free
of fleas while visiting the hospital.
H. The hospital shall establish an
orientation program for the Handlers. Handlers shall attend this program before
participating in the Program. The orientation program shall include, at least,
patient confidentiality, appropriate infection prevention and control measures,
safety, and appropriate emergency protocols. Records of the orientation program
shall be kept.
I. The hospital
shall keep records of each visit the Pet makes. The records shall include, at
least, the date, the identity of the Pet, the identity of the Handler, all the
patients visited; the area in which the patient visits were made, and any
infectious condition the patient had or any type isolation the patient was in
at the time of the visit.
J. The
pet and handler shall be escorted at all times by a staff member appropriate to
the area visited. Patient safety and confidentiality shall be maintained at all
times.
K. The Pet shall be under
the direct supervision of the handler at all times and shall be on a leash or
in a crate at all times while in the hospital. Other patients, visitors, and
employees shall be discouraged from petting the pet.
L. The Hospital shall provide an area to walk
the pet. There shall be procedures for immediate cleanup of all
accidents.
M. There shall be
procedures for patient hand washing, visit area clean up and cleaning of the
patient's room. If a pet visits a patient in bed, the bed linens will be
changed immediately after the visit. A barrier shall be placed over the bed if
the pet is placed directly on the patient's bed.
N. The attending physician in conjunction
with the Infection Control Officer, will determine the appropriateness of the
pet visits. The attending physician shall approve and order each Pet visit. The
orders shall be documented in the medical record.
SECTION 26
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES:
SURGICAL SERVICES.
A. Organization and
Supervision.
1. An organizational plan shall
be developed.
2. Surgical Services
shall be under the medical direction of a qualified physician or a physician
committee.
3. A Surgical Services
Registered Nurse supervisor shall be accountable and responsible for patient
care.
4. Surgical Services shall
have written policies and procedures that include:
a. Operative and special consents;
b. Fire and disaster plans;
c. Environmental control;
d. Visitor and traffic control to include
allowance for no one other than staff or professionals without the expressed
consent of the physician and operating room supervisor;
e. Safety practices;
f. Infection prevention and control
measures;
g. Care and disposition
of surgical specimens, cultures and foreign bodies;
h. Care of special equipment including
preventive maintenance contracts and records;
i. Emergency management;
j. Orientation of all personnel;
and
k. Medication accountability.
(Refer to Section 11, Patient Care Service and Section 16, Pharmacy.)
5. Clinically relevant educational
programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis not less than 12 per
year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
6. A surgery schedule shall
be maintained in the surgery suite.
7. There shall be a continuous QA/PI program
that is specific to the patient care administered.
8. A current roster of physicians and
dentists with a delineation of each physicians and dentists surgical privileges
shall be accessible and available in the confidential files of the Surgical
Services Registered Nurse and in the files of the hospital
administrator.
9. The following
information shall be maintained in the surgery services log:
a. Patient's full name;
b. Hospital number;
c. Surgeon;
d. Assistant surgeon;
e. Type of anesthetic and person
administering;
f. Pre and
postoperative diagnoses;
g.
Circulating nurse;
h. Scrub
nurse(s);
i. Procedures;
j. Complications;
k. Sponge, needle, and instrument
count;
l. Time of beginning and
ending of case; and
m. Other
persons present.
B. Environment, Equipment and Supplies.
1. A safe operating room environment shall be
established, controlled and consistently monitored.
2. At a minimum, the following general
equipment and supplies shall be in the surgical suite:
a. Call-in system;
b. Crash cart;
c. Cardiac monitor
d. Defibrillator;
e. Resuscitating equipment;
f. Suction equipment; and
g. Thoracotomy set.
3. Equipment and supplies necessary to meet
the requirements of the services provided:
a.
Stretcher;
b. Anesthetic equipment
and supplies;
c. Adjustable
operating table with waterproof pad;
d. Side tables;
e. Approved surgical light;
f. Medical gases;
g. 24-hour supply of sterile linen;
h. Wall clock; and
i. Equipment and supplies for timed
scrubbing technique.
C. Staffing.
1. Surgical personnel including a Registered
Nurse shall be available to provide emergency surgical services on a 24-hour
basis.
2. A Registered Nurse shall
be present in the operating room for the duration of the surgical procedure.
Additional auxiliary personnel shall be available as necessary.
3. Only qualified Registered Nurses may
perform circulating duties in the operating room.
4. There shall be documentation of training
and/or experience for all operating room personnel assigned to surgical
procedures.
SECTION
27
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES: POSTANESTHESIA CARE UNIT.
A. Postanesthesia Care Unit (PACU) Services
shall be provided in a well-organized manner under the direction of a qualified
physician and under the supervision of a Registered Nurse.
B. Policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department supervisor and/or
person(s) conducting the review. Policies and procedures shall include:
1. Lines of authority and nursing
supervision;
2. Transfer of
patients from the Operating Room to Postanesthesia Care Unit;
3. Criteria for discharge of patients from
the Postanesthesia Care Unit; and
4. The care of patients in the event the
Postanesthesia Care Unit closes (including provisions of adequate nursing
staff).
C. There shall be
adequate nursing staff in attendance with every patient during anesthesia
recovery.
D. A physician shall
order the discharge of the patient from the Postanesthesia Care Unit.
E. Equipment shall be available in accordance
with services provided.
F. The
Registered Nurse shall assess and document assessment of each PACU
patient.
G. Clinically relevant
educational programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis not less
than 12 per year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and
subject matter.
H. There shall be
an ongoing QA/PI program that is specific to the patient care
administered.
SECTION 28
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES: AMBULATORY SURGERY SERVICES.
A. There shall be policies and procedures
specific to Ambulatory Surgery Services. Policies and procedures for the
department shall have evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first
page of each manual shall have the annual review date, signature of the
department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the review.
B. Policies and procedures shall include:
1. Scheduling of patients for
surgery;
2. Admission and discharge
criteria;
3. Perioperative patient
care;
4. Operative and special
consents;
5. Obtaining a documented
history and physical on the patient's medical record prior to the
procedure;
6. Preoperative
assessment procedures required by the Medical Staff; and
7. Medication accountability. (Refer to
Section 11, Patient Care Service, Section 12, Medications and Section 16,
Pharmacy.)
C. A physician
shall order the discharge of the patient from the facility.
D. For additional requirements refer to
Patient Care Service, Section 11, Specialized Services: Surgical Services,
Section 26 and Specialized Services: Post anesthesia Care Unit, Section
27.
SECTION 29
:
SPECIALIZED SERVICES: ANESTHESIA SERVICES.
A. Organization and Staffing. Anesthesia
Services shall be provided in a well- organized manner under the direction of a
qualified physician. The service is responsible for all anesthesia
administered.
B. Those
administering anesthesia shall be credentialed by Medical Staff and approved by
the Governing Body. A current roster, with delineation of privileges for those
administering anesthesia, shall be maintained and readily available.
C. Anesthesia shall be administered by the
following:
1. Anesthesiologist;
2. Physician qualified to administer
anesthesia; or
3. Certified
Registered Nurse Anesthetist (CRNA) in consultation with a physician.
D. Written policies and procedures
specific to Anesthesia Services shall have evidence of ongoing review and/or
revision. The first page of the manual shall have the annual review date,
signature of the department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the
review.
E. Policies and procedures
shall include:
1. Preanesthesia
evaluation;
2. Approved anesthesia
agents;
3. Methods of delivery of
anesthesia;
4. Intraoperative
anesthesia record;
5. Post
anesthesia follow-up report;
6.
Mechanism for routine checking and maintenance of anesthesia machines and
equipment for safe use;
7.
Medication accountability. See Section 16, Pharmacy, Section 11, Patient Care
Service, and Section 12, Medications;
8. Responsibilities in the discharge of
patients from the Post anesthesia Care Unit. See Section 27, Post anesthesia
Care Unit; and
9. Infection
prevention and control measures.
F. All medications and anesthetic agents
administered to the patient shall be ordered by the prescriber and/or
anesthesia provider. This includes preoperative as well as intraoperative and
postoperative medications.
G. There
shall be an ongoing QA/PI program that is specific to the patient care
administered.
SECTION 30
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES: LABOR, DELIVERY, LABOR DELIVERY RECOVERY (LDR),
LABOR DELIVERY RECOVERY POST PARTUM (LDRP), POST PARTUM AND MATERNAL-CHILD
EDUCATION.
A. Labor Room and/or LDR,
LDRP Room.
1. Provisions shall be made for
patients in labor in either a designated labor room and/or birthing room. Rooms
used only for labor shall be in close proximity to the delivery room.
Furniture, washable wallpaper, pictures, radio, television, and other items may
be used as long as the needs of the mother and baby are not compromised. Items
selected shall be made of durable materials, with a smooth, impervious surface
which can be easily cleaned and disinfected.
2. All beds used for labor shall be equipped
with side rails.
3. There shall be
equipment and supplies available for the examination and preparation of
patients in labor, which shall consist of the following:
a. Precipitous delivery tray;
b. Stethoscope;
c. Suction equipment;
d. Sterile gloves;
e. Emergency medications as approved by the
Pharmacy and Therapeutics Committee and supplies to include laryngoscopes,
airways, endotracheal tubes and infant ambu bags; and
f. Fetal monitoring device.
4. A physician shall be
immediately available when Oxytocin is administered.
"Immediately available" shall be determined by the hospital's
administrative staff, Medical Staff and Governing Body.
5. Father or support persons may be allowed
with the patient during labor unless medically contraindicated.
B. Delivery Areas.
1. Hospitals offering delivery and maternity
services shall comply with the requirements of this section. (See Section 14,
Health Information Services and Section 11, Patient Care Service.)
2. General operating rooms may not be used
for deliveries, except for major surgical deliveries. Delivery rooms shall be
separate from operating rooms and shall not be used for any other purpose, with
the exception of a tubal ligation immediately following a delivery. Delivery
rooms may be used for Caesarean sections provided the usual operating room
equipment is used, and surgical policies and procedures related to the delivery
are made a part of the labor and delivery manual.
3. The following equipment and supplies shall
be provided:
a. Supply of medications as
approved by the Pharmacy and Therapeutics Committee;
b. Infant identification and supplies.
Identification shall be done in the delivery room at the time of birth and
shall remain in place during the entire period of hospitalization.
Identification information shall be sufficient to identify the infant(s) with
one mother. Identification bands shall be waterproof plastic with tag inserts
written in waterproof ink;
c.
Heated bassinet, crib, or incubator;
d. Supply of prophylaxis medication for the
prevention of infant blindness. The medication shall be administered within one
and one-half hours of the time of birth per written order of the
physician;
e. Commercially
manufactured delivery table/birthing bed with a waterproof non-conductive table
pad;
f. Side tables for instruments
and other necessary equipment;
g.
Approved surgical light;
h. Wall
clock;
i. Equipment and supplies
for timed scrub technique and an approved disinfectant soap;
j. Apgar score chart;
k. Suction equipment (infant and
adult);
l. Sphygmomanometer;
and
m. Fetal monitoring
device.
C.
Organization.
1. Delivery services shall be
under the direction of a qualified physician and under the supervision of a
Registered Nurse. A Registered Nurse shall be present during labor, delivery
and post-delivery of each patient. The birth shall be attended by a physician
or a certified nurse midwife with hospital privileges.
2. Patients shall be provided with direct
care by a Registered Nurse during labor, delivery, recovery and postpartum.
a. All patients in active labor shall be
attended and/or monitored.
b.
Qualified nurses, in adequate numbers shall be provided to meet the needs of
each patient.
3. An
on-call schedule shall be provided to ensure that a physician with obstetrical
privileges is readily available to perform obstetrical services at all times.
"Readily available" shall be determined by the hospital's Administrative Staff,
Medical Staff and Governing Body.
4. Qualified Registered Nurses shall always
be available in-house for labor and delivery patients. When there are no
patients, on-call staff may be utilized if approved by the Medical Staff and
Governing Body.
5. Procedures for
obtaining the mother's Rh factor shall be provided by the facility or
documented by the mother's attending physician upon admission.
6. When a patient presents to the hospital
for evaluation, the physician shall be notified.
7. Policies and procedures shall include:
a. Immediate delivery;
b. Obstetrical emergencies;
c. Setting up and cleaning the delivery room,
LDR or LDRP room, and C- section room;
d. Equipment requirements;
e. Visitation;
f. Climate control (physical);
g. Infection prevention and control
measures;
h. Aseptic
techniques;
i. Intermittent rooming
in;
j. Anesthesia;
k. Deliveries occurring outside the delivery
area;
l. Infectious patients;
and
m. Infant security.
8. A permanent record of all
deliveries shall be maintained. There shall be a reasonable attempt to collect
current information to include the following:
a. Mother's name, date of birth, maiden name,
father's name if available, hospital number, gravida-para, ABO type, Rh factor,
mother's Hepatitis C status and length of gestational period;
b. Baby's sex, race, date of birth, time of
birth, weight, apgar score, and baby identification band number;
c. The healthcare provider shall record in
the medical record if the pregnant women declines to be tested for Hepatitis
C.
D.
Anesthesia.
1. Only a physician,
anesthesiologist or Certified Registered Nurse Anesthetist (CRNA) shall be
permitted to initiate and reinject continual epidural or caudal anesthesia and
to initiate or continue general or regional anesthesia.
2. A physician shall be immediately available
for consultation if CRNAs are administering anesthesia. "Immediately available"
shall be determined by the hospital's Administrative Staff, Medical Staff and
Governing Body.
3. The permanent
record shall contain the names of the physician, anesthesiologist, anesthetist
or CRNA.
E. Postpartum
Care.
1. Policies and procedures shall be
developed specific to the care of maternity patients.
2. Maternity patients shall not be routinely
cared for in rooms with patients admitted for diagnosis other than
maternity.
3. After an observation
period, the infant may stay in the room with the mother for the duration of the
hospital stay.
4. Mothers with
infection, fever or other condition that could adversely affect the safety and
welfare of others shall be immediately segregated and isolated in a separate
room.
F. Maternal-Child
Education. The hospital shall develop an educational program for the care of
the obstetrical patient and infant. Policies and procedures shall include:
1. Personal hygiene;
2. Dietary instruction;
3. Care of episiotomy and perineum;
4. Care of incision;
5. Breast care;
6. Exercise program;
7. Car seat safety (Ark. Code Ann. §
27-34-101 et seq.);
8. Preventive health;
9. Referral services;
10. Infant care; and
11. Hepatitis C counseling.
12. Distributing educational materials for
shaken baby syndrome (Ark. Code Ann. §
20-9-1401 et
seq.)
SECTION
31
: NURSERY SERVICES.
The newborn nursery shall be under the direct supervision of a
Registered Nurse with clinical skills in newborn nursing. The newborn nursery
shall be located within or adjacent to the postpartum unit. The following
requirements shall apply to all nurseries:
A. Nurseries shall not be used for any other
purpose and shall never be left unattended when occupied.
B. Infants born outside the hospital or with
proven or potential infections shall be isolated from other infants in the
Nursery. Infants with infections, skin rash or diarrhea shall be immediately
separated and isolated.
C.
Isolettes shall not serve as a sole means of isolation. Provisions for
isolation shall be provided.
D. The
following equipment shall be provided in nurseries:
1. Individual approved type hospital
bassinets. Wicker or woven type bassinets shall not be used;
2. Metal or approved plastic diaper and waste
containers. The lids on these containers shall be operated by a foot control or
equivalent device;
3. Infant
scales;
4. Blankets and
linen;
5. Suction equipment;
and
6. Incubators suitable for the
care of premature infants provided in the ratio of at least one incubator to 20
bassinets.
E. Infant
emergency supplies:
1. Emergency medications
approved by the Pharmacy and Therapeutics Committee;
2. Infant laryngoscope;
3. Suction catheters;
4. Endotracheal tubes;
5. Stylets; and
6. Infant airways and IV supplies.
F. Newborn testing for critical
congenital heart defects shall include the performance of pulse oximetry
testing all newborns before discharge Ark. Code Ann. §
20-9-103. Performance of a pulse
oximetry test on a newborn is not required if the parent or legal guardian of
the newborn object to the testing on medical, religious, or philosophical
grounds.
G. Newborn testing for
genetic illnesses shall be in accordance with Arkansas Rules Pertaining to
Testing of Newborn Infants and Ark. Code Ann. § 20-15- 302.
H. Newborn testing for early detection of
hearing loss shall be in accordance with Arkansas Rules Pertaining to the
Universal Newborn/Infant Hearing Screening, Tracking and Intervention Program
and Ark. Code Ann.
20-15-1105.
I. Strict hand hygiene techniques shall be
maintained by all personnel. A clean barrier shall be used by anyone handling
the infant.
J. Infant clothing
shall be furnished by the hospital; however, if the mother wishes to provide
clothing for the infant, hospital personnel shall examine the clothing to make
sure it meets hospital requirements. Diapers shall be available in necessary
quantities.
K. Formula Feedings.
1. Any individually packaged, presterilized
formula delivered by an outside source shall be approved by the
facility.
2. There shall be an
adequate supply of sterile disposable ready-to-use formula bottles
available.
3. Formulas shall be
stored in enclosed cabinets.
4. The
expiration date shall be checked on each bottle prior to infant
feeding.
5. Policies and procedures
shall be developed in conjunction with the Infection Prevention and Control
Committee regarding the handling, labeling and storing (separately) of breast
milk.
6. Individual nipple shields
and breast pumps used in infant feeding shall be cleaned according to hospital
infection prevention and control policies and procedures.
7. If the facility has a breast milk bank the
policies and procedures shall be submitted to and approved by the Arkansas
Department of Health and hospital Infection Prevention and Control
Committee.
L. Rooming-In
Service. Hospitals providing a newborn nursery may provide rooming in for
infants on an intermittent or 24-hour basis based on the mother's
request.
SECTION 32
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES: CRITICAL CARE.
A Critical Care Unit is a section of the hospital where
intensive care nursing, necessary monitoring and treatment equipment and
supplies are provided to those patients who, in the opinion of the attending
physician, require such specialized services.
A. Staffing.
1. Critical Care Units shall be staffed with
a Registered Nurse each shift.
2.
All critical care nursing staff shall be oriented and trained in life support
measures, interpretation of dysrhythmias and shall demonstrate competency in
critical care nursing specific to patient types. Competency in the specific
areas shall be maintained.
B. Policies and Procedures. Procedures shall
include:
1. Admission and continuing stay
criteria;
2. Discharge
criteria;
3.
Triage/transfer;
4. Use of
protocols; and
5. Definition of the
clinical scope of the hospital's critical care service.
C. Equipment. Equipment shall include:
1. Suction;
2. Diagnostic monitoring equipment to include
electrocardiographic monitoring;
3.
"Crash Cart" containing emergency medications and supplies;
4. Defibrillator;
5. Wall clock;
6. Accommodations to maintain privacy;
and
7. Weighing device for bed
patients.
D. Isolation.
An isolation room shall be available for the treatment of potentially
infectious or immune suppressed critical care patients.
E. Pediatric Critical Care. If the facility
offers critical care for the pediatric patient there shall be:
1. Policies, procedures and equipment
specific to the needs of pediatric patients; and
2. Nursing staff oriented and trained in life
support measures, interpretation of dysrhythmias and competency in critical
care nursing specific to the pediatric patient.
SECTION 33
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES:
DENTAL SERVICES.
A. Dental Services
shall comply with the requirements of this section. (See Section 14, Health
Information Services, Section 11, Patient Care Services, Section 16, Pharmacy
and all applicable Sections.)
B.
Patients admitted to the hospital for dental care shall be given the same
medical appraisal as those admitted to other services. The care of dental
patients shall be the dual responsibility of the dentist and a physician on the
hospital staff.
C. Dental services
shall be under the direction of a dentist.
D. Policies and procedures shall be
provided.
SECTION 34
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES: CENTRAL STERILIZATION AND SUPPLY.
A. Each hospital shall provide central
medical and surgical supply services with facilities that are responsible for
processing, sterilizing, storing, distributing supplies and equipment to all
units of the hospital. (Refer to Section 66, Physical Facilities, Central
Medical and Surgical Supply Department, for space and equipment
requirements.)
B. The central
sterilization and supply service shall be under the direct supervision of a
Registered Nurse or other qualified person who is trained in management,
aseptic procedures, supply processing and control methods which are applicable
to central sterilization and supply service.
C. Policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department and/or person(s)
conducting the review.
D. Policies
and procedures shall include:
1. Job
descriptions;
2. Infection
prevention and control measures;
3.
Assembly and operation of equipment;
4. Safety practices;
5. Orientation for new employees;
6. Care and cleaning of equipment;
7. Evaluation of:
a. Cleaning effectiveness; and
b. Sterilizing effectiveness.
8. Receiving, decontaminating,
cleaning, preparing, disinfecting and sterilizing reusable items;
9. Assembling and wrapping of packs (to
include the double-wrapped techniques);
10. Storage and distribution of sterile
equipment/medical supplies;
11. Use
of chemical indicators and biological spore tests for sterilizers;
12. Recalling and disposing/reprocessing of
outdated sterile supplies;
13.
Cleaning and disinfecting of surfaces, utensils, and equipment;
14. Specifications for cold-liquid
sterilization and gas sterilization (if used); and
15. Collection and disposal of supplies
recalled by the manufacturer.
E. There shall be an ongoing QA/PI program
specific to the area.
F.
Precautions shall be exercised to prevent the mixing of sterile and unsterile
supplies and equipment. The precautions shall be set forth in written
policies.
G. Procedures shall be
developed for unloading and transporting flash sterilized items. The procedures
shall be developed with the assistance of the Infection Prevention and Control
Committee and shall provide for the aseptic transfer within the physical
constraints of the facility.
H.
Relevant educational programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis
not less than 12 per year. There shall be written documentation with employee
signature, program title/subject, presenter, date and outline or narrative of
presented program.
I. A liaison
with the Infection Prevention and Control Committee shall be
maintained.
J. Records shall be
maintained of all autoclave loads, both routine and immediate use or "flash,"
which shall include the date, time, lot number (on routine loads), the time at
temperature (where a recorder is not available), item(s) sterilized and shall
identify the person performing the task.
1.
Autoclaves shall meet the following requirements:
2. The efficacy of autoclaves, both for
routine and immediate use or "flash" use, shall be determined weekly through
the use of biological spore monitors:
3. The results of all biological spore
monitoring shall be reported to the Infection Prevention and Control Committee;
and
4. Failures of the biological
spore test shall be brought to the attention of the Infection Prevention and
Control Officer or designee immediately so the appropriate surveillance
measures can be initiated.
NOTE: All materials sterilized from the date of the biological
spore monitor failure to the last successful biological spore monitor shall be
re-sterilized before use.
K. All autoclaves within the facility shall
be maintained in accordance with the manufacturer's written directions. Records
shall be maintained of all maintenance and repairs for the life of the
equipment.
L. Chemical indicators
for sterility shall be used with each cycle
M. The facility shall validate compliance and
efficacy of the sterilization policy through the quality review process. The
sterilization policy shall describe the mechanism used to determine the shelf
life of sterilized packages. The policy shall:
1. Be consistent with published industry
standards (AAMI and APIC).
2.
Stress that sterility is related to integrity of pack regardless of whether
expiration dating or event-related expiration is utilized.
N. Event-related dating of sterile packs is
acceptable.
ALLOWABLE SHELF LIFE |
Double-wrapped Muslin |
Use for rapid turn-around items only in well controlled
environment, < 30 days |
Double-wrapped Muslin Placed in a Plastic Dust Cover
Then Heat Sealed or Bonded |
Event related |
Paper or Polypropylene Peel Pack (Paper, Plastic or
Tyvek/Mylar) |
Event related and/or per manufacturer's
instructions |
Rigid Containers, Caskets, etc. |
Per manufacturer's instructions |
NOTE:
1. Sterile
storage areas shall maintain a temperature of no more than 75°F and a
relative humidity of no more than 70%. Ventilation shall be 10 air changes per
hour and shall follow clean to dirty flow.
2. The interior of the dust cover shall not
be considered sterile.
3. Packages
that are wet, dropped on the floor, compressed or torn shall be
rejected.
4. The lot number or
control number and expiration statement shall be visible through the package or
another tag shall be placed on the outside.
5. Containers for sterilization systems shall
be scientifically proven suitable for the specific sterilization cycle used;
the container system shall be verified as the correct one for the cycle.
(Manufacturer's instructions shall be followed.)
6. Double-wrapped shall mean the end results
of the wrapping technique will yield a two-ply covering.
7. The date of sterilization and load control
number shall be placed on each sterilized pack.
O. Immediate use or "flash" (autoclaving)
shall be restricted to unplanned or emergency situations. Flash sterilization
shall never be used as a convenience to compensate for inadequate inventories
of instruments or implantables. Flash sterilization of implantables shall be
restricted to the direst circumstances.
P. Items which are to be immediate use flash
sterilized shall be cleaned and decontaminated before the sterilization
process.
Q. Traffic areas in which
immediate use or flash sterilization is carried out shall be restricted to
authorized personnel wearing surgical attire consisting of surgical scrubs,
shoe covers, masks and hair covers. The sterilizer shall not be located
adjacent to any potential sources of contamination such as scrub sinks,
clinical sinks or hoppers, wash sinks, linen or trash disposal areas.
R. For immediate use or flash sterilization,
minimal time at effective temperature shall conform to the following:
AUTOCLAVE |
LOA |
MINIMAL TIME AT
TEMPERATURE |
Gravity |
Nonporous (Simple Metal Instruments) |
3 minutes at 132EC (270EF) |
Gravity |
Porous (Towels, Rubber, Plastic) Nonporous
Mix |
10 minutes at 132EC (270EF) |
Gravity |
Nonporous with Lumens, Deep Grooves, Sliding
Parts |
10 minutes at 132EC (270EF) |
Gravity/Prevacuum |
Complex Devices, Air-powered Drills |
Per Manufacturer's Instructions |
Prevacuum |
Nonporous |
3 minutes at 132EC (270EF) |
Prevacuum |
Porous/Nonporous |
4 minutes at 132EC (270EF) |
S.
Items that previously have been packaged, sterilized, and issued, but not used
may be returned to the sterile storage area if the integrity of the packaging
has not been compromised and there is no evidence of contamination; such items
may be dispensed when needed.
Items that previously have been packaged, sterilized and issued
to the patient care units or other areas where the environment is not
controlled shall be discarded if they are single use items, or unwrapped and
reprocessed through decontamination if they are reusable.
T. Sterile materials shall be stored eight to
ten inches from the floor and at least 18 inches from the ceiling and at least
two inches from outside walls. Items shall be positioned so that packages are
not crushed, bent, compressed, or punctured and sterility is not
compromised.
U. All sterilization
techniques other than steam (plasma, ethylene oxide, chemical, etc.) shall
follow the manufacturer's directions and meet all state and federal
regulations.
SECTION 35
: SPECIALIZED SERVICES: RESPIRATORY CARE.
A. Respiratory Care Services shall be under
the direction of a physician member of the Medical Staff.
B. Respiratory Care Services, including
equipment, shall be supervised by a qualified and trained respiratory
therapist.
C. here shall be
sufficient personnel qualified and trained in respiratory care to provide
respiratory care services.
1. Services may be
performed by an assistant only when a qualified and trained respiratory
therapist is readily available for consultation; and
2. Personnel qualified and trained in
respiratory care shall be on the premises whenever continuous ventilatory
support is provided to patients.
D. All respiratory care personnel shall
maintain competency in:
1. Life support
measures;
2. Isolation techniques;
and
3. Safety techniques for oxygen
and oxygen equipment.
E.
The policy and procedure manual shall have evidence of ongoing review and/or
revision. The first page of the manual shall have the annual review date and
signature of the department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the
review.
F. Policies and procedures
shall include:
1. Job descriptions;
2. Documentation, verified by the physician
director, of who may perform special procedures and give patient
instructions;
3. Safety
practices;
4. Handling, storage and
dispensing of therapeutic gases;
5.
Infection prevention and control measures;
6. Assembly and operation of
equipment;
7. Respiratory care
services provided and a list of services shall be available to the Medical
Staff;
8. Steps to take in the
event of an adverse reaction;
9.
Cleaning, disinfecting and sterilizing procedures; and
10. Orientation policies for new
employees.
G. Clinically
relevant educational programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis
not less than 12 per year. There shall be evidence of program dates,
attendance, and subject matter.
H.
If arterial blood gases are performed the Respiratory Care department shall
subscribe to a nationally recognized proficiency testing program for blood
gases and meet the quality control requirements for clinical
laboratories.
I. The Respiratory
Care Service shall have sufficient equipment and adequate facilities
appropriate for safety and effective provision of care.
1. Equipment shall be serviced calibrated,
and operated according to manufacturers' directions.
2. An approved safety system shall be used
with therapeutic gases.
3.
Resuscitation, ventilatory and oxygenation support equipment shall be available
for patients of all sizes.
4.
Ventilators for continuous assistance or controlled breathing shall be equipped
with alarm systems.
5. preventive
maintenance program shall be implemented and records maintained for the life of
the equipment.
J. All
Respiratory Care prescription/work requests shall specify the type, frequency
and duration of each treatment, and, as required, the type and dose of
medication and the type of diluent and oxygen or medical air.
K. Respiratory Care reports of blood gas
results shall be prepared in duplicate and signed by the therapist responsible
for the procedure/test. The original shall be placed in the patient's medical
record and the copy retained in the department file.
L. Accurate records shall be maintained
regarding the type and duration of each treatment given. These records shall be
correlated with the patient's medical record.
M. Respiratory Care documentation for each
patient shall include:
1. Current written plan
of care to include goals and objectives;
2. Instructions to patient or patient's
family; and
3. Type and duration of
the treatment given.
N.
When oxygen is being administered to a patient:
1. Patients, visitors and personnel shall be
apprised of the fire hazard; and
2.
If the patient is in a tent, alcohol or rub-on lotion shall not be
used.
O. Oxygen shall be
humidified in accordance with physician's orders.
P. If reusable reservoirs are used to
humidify the oxygen, the reservoirs shall be cleaned and disinfected to a
high-level of disinfection. (A high-level disinfection can be expected to kill
all microorganisms with the exception of high numbers of bacterial endospores.
Only sterile solutions and diluents shall be used in humidification and
nebulizing equipment. Nebulizers (in- line and hand-held), between treatments
on the same patient, shall be disinfected to a high level and rinsed in sterile
water or, if a small volume medication nebulizer, air dried. All other
semicritical equipment shall be cleaned and disinfected in accordance with the
Center for Disease Control and Prevention's Guidelines.
Q. After use, all equipment shall be returned
to a central location for thorough cleaning, servicing and disinfecting before
use on another patient.
R. here
shall be an ongoing QA/PI program.
S. Contracted Respiratory Care Services shall
be under current agreement and the contractor shall fulfill all requirements of
this section.
NOTE: The National Fire Protection Association Vol. 99, Health
Care Facilities, is a mandatory reference for developing safety regulations for
Respiratory Care Services.
SECTION 36
: SPECIALIZED SERVICE:
EMERGENCY SERVICES.
NOTE: Federal EMTALA requirements apply
A. Every licensed hospital shall have a
dedicated emergency department. The following hospitals are excepted:
1. Psychiatric hospitals;
2. Rehabilitation hospitals;
3. Long term acute care hospitals;
and
4. Prison hospitals.
B. The hospital's emergency
department shall have organized services, procedures, and nationally recognized
protocols for emergencies.
C.
Diagnostic and treatment equipment, medications, supplies and space shall be
adequate in terms of the size and scope of services provided. Resuscitation and
life support equipment shall include but not be limited to:
1. Airway control and ventilation equipment
including laryngoscope and endotracheal tubes, valve-mask resuscitator, sources
of oxygen, pulse oximeter, CO2 monitoring;
2. Suction devices;
3. Standard IV fluids and administration
devices, including IV catheters;
4.
Intravenous fluid and blood warmers;
5. Sterile surgical sets for standard ED
procedures;
6. Gastric lavage
equipment; and
7. Blood pressure
monitoring equipment.
D.
Each emergency department shall have diagnostic imaging and diagnostic
laboratory capabilities available twenty-four (24) hours per day, seven (7)
days per week. Such laboratory services shall include:
1. Standard analyses of blood, urine, and
other body fluids;
2. Blood typing
and cross-matching;
3. Coagulation
studies;
4. Comprehensive blood
bank or access to a community central blood band and adequate hospital storage
facilities; and
5. Blood gases and
pH determination.
E. An
inventory list of all supplies and equipment including all items on the crash
cart, shall be checked each shift and after each use.
F. The location and telephone number of the
nearest poison control center and a list of poison antidotes shall be posted in
the emergency department.
G.
Screening examination
Each patient presenting to the emergency department ("ED")
shall have a medical screening examination by a qualified medical personnel.
The examination shall be completely documented.
H. Treatment and Disposition
1. If a patient is screened as having an
emergency medical condition, a physician shall be contacted to discuss the
assessment findings and patient's condition. A physician shall determine
disposition of the patient.
2. If a
patient is screened as having a non-emergency medical condition, a hospital may
allow treatment and disposition of the patient by a physician or nonphysician
licensed medical professional. This individual must be appropriately
credentialed by the medical staff with approval by the governing body to
provide non-emergent medical care in the Emergency Department.
I. Physician availability
1. Arrangements shall be provided, such as a
duty or on-call roster, to ensure a physician is available for all emergency
patients as determined by the screening examination.
2. Arrangements shall be made for obtaining
specialized medical services.
J. Staffing.
1. The Emergency Service shall be under the
supervision of a Registered Nurse.
2. All patient care personnel assigned to the
emergency department shall receive orientation and be competent in life support
measures.
3. An Advanced Cardiac
Life Support (ACLS) or Pediatric Advanced Life Support (PALS) (as appropriate)
trained person shall be in-house and immediately available.
4. The Registered Nurse shall assume the
responsibility for the nursing functions of the Emergency Services. This
includes:
a. Supervision;
b. Evaluation of the patient's emergency
nursing care needs;
c. The
assignment of nursing care for each patient to other nursing personnel in
accordance with the patient's needs and the preparation and competence of the
nursing staff;
d. Supplies and
equipment;
e. The emergency
department record (See Section 7, General Administration and Sections 15,
Medical Record Requirements for Outpatient Services, Emergency Room and
Observation Services.); and
f.
Maintenance of an emergency department log.
5. Emergency Medical Technician (EMT).
Pursuant to the Arkansas Emergency Medical Service Act Ark. Code Ann.
§§
20-13-201 et seq., if a hospital
allows an Arkansas Certified Emergency Medical Technician to perform specified
procedures within the Emergency Room or be a member of a hospital code team the
following action shall be taken:
a. The
Medical Staff shall approve the privileges granted to the individual EMT with
concurrence of the hospital's Governing Body. Specific policies governing the
supervision and the procedures to be performed by an EMT shall be developed by
the Medical Staff and approved by the hospital's Governing Body. In no event
shall an EMT perform a procedure that he/she is not certified to do by the
Office of Emergency Services of the Arkansas Department of Health;
b. Approved EMT's shall function in
accordance with physician's orders and under the direct supervision of either
the physician or Registered Nurse responsible for Emergency Services;
c. Students in EMT training programs approved
by the Office of Emergency Medical Services of the Arkansas Department of
Health shall be trained by qualified instructors within the hospital under
guidelines established by the Medical Staff and approved by the Governing Body;
and
d. A roster with the
delineation of privileges shall be maintained and readily available.
K. Medications. (See
Section 16, Pharmacy and Section 12, Medications.)
L. Off-Campus Emergency Departments
(off-campus EDs). Off-campus EDs shall meet all requirements for hospital EDs.
Off-campus EDs shall:
1. Function as a
department of the parent hospital.
2. Be fully integrated into the parent
hospital's systems and operations.
a. Medical
staff must be part of the parent hospital's single organized medical
staff.
b. Nursing personnel must be
part of the hospital's single organized nursing service.
c. Emergency laboratory and imaging services
must be available 24 hours/day, 7 days/week.
d. Quality assessment/performance improvement
(QAPI) program must be integrated into the parent hospital's QAPI
program.
e. Records must be
maintained as part of the hospital's single medical record system.
f. Infection prevention and control practices
must meet the requirements of the parent hospital's infection control policies
and practices.
g. Emergency
services must meet accepted standards of practice for hospital emergency
department.
h. Patients who require
further care must have access to all services of the main hospital.
3. Be open 24 hours per day, 7
days per week.
M.
Emergency Services Facility. The Arkansas Department of Health may license
under Ark. Code Ann. §
20-9-218, hospitals which have
discontinued inpatient services to continue to provide emergency services if
there is no other hospital Emergency Service in the community.
1. The Emergency Services Facility shall be
subject to inspection and to all other provisions of Ark. Code Ann.
§§
20-9-201 et. seq. and
20-13-201 et. seq., as
amended.
2. The Emergency Services
Facility shall have agreements with licensed hospitals to accept patients who
are in need of inpatient hospital services.
3. An emergency facility shall not have
licensed inpatient beds, however, at least one holding/observation bed shall be
provided for patient use not to exceed 24 hours.
4. Emergency Service Facilities shall
provide, or contract to provide emergency ambulance services licensed by the
Arkansas Department of Health, that include radio communication and patient
telemetry. It is further required that contractual agreements be made for
patient air transport services.
5.
Policies and procedures shall be developed and approved by Health Facility
Services of the Arkansas Department of Health, prior to issuance of a license,
and the facility may not provide services without a license.
6. Clinically relevant educational program
shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis not less than 12 per year.
There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
7. There shall be an
ongoing QA/PI program that is specific to the patient care
administered.
SECTION
37
: SPECIALIZED SERVICE: PSYCHIATRIC SERVICES.
A. Psychiatric care units in general
hospitals shall meet the construction requirements of Section 48, Psychiatric
Nursing Unit, and shall in all respects comply with the requirements of Section
42, Physical Facilities, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical,
Communicable or Pulmonary Disease) except furniture, equipment and supplies may
be modified by the attending physician on an individual patient basis as
verified by signed orders.
B.
General Requirements.
1. Each psychiatric care
unit shall have a written plan describing the organization of services or the
arrangement for the provision of such services to meet patient needs.
2. The services shall include, but not be
limited to, diagnostic evaluation, individual or group therapy, consultation
and rehabilitation.
3. The unit
shall be under the direction and management of a psychiatrist who is qualified
by training and experience for examination by the American Board of Psychiatry
and Neurology or the American Osteopathic Board of Neurology and Psychiatry and
licensed in the State of Arkansas.
4. The Program Director of the unit shall be
an individual with at least two years administrative experience.
5. The unit shall furnish, through the use of
qualified personnel, psychological services, social work services, occupational
therapy, recreational therapy and psychiatric nursing.
6. The unit shall have a qualified Director
of Nursing with a Master's Degree or be qualified by education and experience
in the care of the mentally ill. If the director does not meet the
qualifications, there shall be regular documented consultation by a qualified
Registered Nurse.
7. Staffing for
the unit shall ensure the presence in the unit of a Registered Nurse at all
times. There shall be adequate numbers of Registered Nurses, Licensed Practical
Nurses, and mental health workers to provide the care necessary under each
patient's active treatment program.
8. The unit shall provide or have available,
psychological services to meet the needs of the patients.
9. There shall be a social service staff to
provide services in accordance with accepted standards of practice and
established policies and procedures.
10. The unit shall provide a therapeutic
activities program. The program shall be appropriate to the needs and interests
of the patients and be directed toward restoring and maintaining optimal levels
of physical and psychosocial functioning.
11. There shall be a procedure for referrals
for needed services.
12. There
shall be adequate space, equipment and supplies for services to be provided
effectively and efficiently in functional surroundings that are readily
accessible to the patients. All space, equipment and facilities, both within
the psychiatric facility and those utilized outside the facility, shall be well
maintained and shall meet applicable federal, state and local requirements for
safety, fire, health and sanitation.
13. Policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department director and/or
person(s) conducting the review.
14. Clinically relevant educational program
shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis not less than 12 per year.
There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
15. Staff meetings shall be
held at least monthly. Dated minutes of each meeting shall be kept in
writing.
16. There shall be an
ongoing program for orientation of staff.
17. All psychiatric services personnel shall
maintain competency in life support measures.
18. There shall be an ongoing QA/PI
program.
C. Medical
records shall include at least:
1.
Identification data including patient's legal status;
2. Admitting psychiatric diagnosis as well as
diagnoses of medical problems;
3.
Reason for the patient's admission;
4. Social service records including reports
of interviews with patients, family members and others and a social history and
assessment;
5. Psychiatric
evaluation (See Section 15, Medical Record Requirements for Outpatient
Services, Emergency Room, Observation Services and Psychiatric Records);
and
6. Treatment plan (See Section
15, Medical Record Requirements for Outpatient Services, Emergency Room,
Observation Services and Psychiatric Records).
D. Medications. (See Section 16,
Pharmacy.)
E. Food and Nutritional
Services. (See Section 17, Food and Nutrition Services.)
F. Organization of psychiatric nursing units
and services in general hospitals:
1. Medical
direction shall be provided by a qualified psychiatrist and under the
supervision of a Registered Nurse, qualified by training and experience in
psychiatric nursing.
2. In addition
to the requirements set forth for Nursing Services in Section 11, Patient Care
Service, policies and procedures shall be developed specific to the care of the
psychiatric patient.
G.
Supplies and equipment shall be commensurate with the type of services
offered.
H. Medical Records (See
Section 15, Medical Record Requirements for Outpatient Services, Emergency
Room, Observation Services and Psychiatric Records).
SECTION 38
: SPECIALIZED SERVICE: CARE
OF PATIENTS WITH PULMONARY DISEASE IN CRITICAL ACCESS HOSPITALS.
A. In addition to the Patient Care Services
requirements set forth in Section 11, the policies and procedures shall include
specialized procedures specific to respiratory disease patients and shall
include:
1. Collection of sputum;
2. Utilization of respiratory care;
3. Skin test procedures;
4. Tuberculosis control program for
personnel;
5. Follow-up service for
patients after discharge from the hospital; and
6. Provision for individual patient's plan of
care.
SECTION
39
: OUTPATIENT PSYCHIATRIC CENTERS.
Any facility in which psychiatric services are offered for a
period of 8 to 16 hours a day, and where, in the opinion of the attending
psychiatrist, hospitalization, as defined in the present licensure law, is not
necessary, is considered an Outpatient Psychiatric Facility. This definition
does not include Community Mental Health Clinics and Centers as they now exist.
Such facilities shall conform with applicable sections if those services are
provided within the facility. Such facilities shall conform with applicable
sections of Section 75, Physical Facilities, Outpatient Care Facilities.
A. General Requirements.
1. Each psychiatric facility shall have a
written plan describing the organization of outpatient services or the
arrangement for the provision of such services to meet patient needs.
2. The outpatient services shall include, but
not be limited to, diagnostic evaluation, individual or group therapy,
consultation and rehabilitation.
3.
The center shall be under the direction and management of a psychiatrist who is
qualified by training and experience requirements for examination by the
American Board of Psychiatry and Neurology or the American Osteopathic Board of
Neurology and Psychiatry and licensed in the State of Arkansas.
4. The Program Director of the Outpatient
Center shall be an individual with at least two years of administrative
experience.
5. The center shall
furnish, through the use of qualified personnel, psychological services, social
work services, occupational therapy, recreational therapy and psychiatric
nursing.
6. The center shall have a
qualified Director of Nursing with a Master's Degree or be qualified by
education and experience in the care of the mentally ill. If the director does
not meet the qualifications, there shall be regular documented consultation by
a qualified Registered Nurse.
7.
Staffing for the center shall insure the presence in the center of a Registered
Nurse during the hours the unit is open. There shall be adequate numbers of
Registered Nurses, Licensed Practical Nurses and mental health workers to
provide the care necessary under each patient's active treatment
program.
8. The center shall
provide or have available, psychological services to meet the needs of the
patients.
9. There shall be a
social service staff to provide services in accordance with accepted standards
of practice and established policies and procedures.
10. The center shall provide a therapeutic
activities program. The program shall be appropriate to the needs and interests
of the patients and be directed toward restoring and maintaining optimal levels
of physical and psychosocial functioning.
11. There shall be a procedure for referrals
for needed services that are not provided directly by the facility.
12. There shall be adequate space, equipment
and supplies for outpatient services to be provided effectively and efficiently
in functional surroundings that are readily accessible and acceptable to the
patients and community services. All space, equipment and facilities, both
within the psychiatric facility and those utilized outside the facility, shall
be well maintained and shall meet applicable federal, state and local
requirements for safety, fire, health and sanitation.
13. Policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department supervisor and/or
person(s) conducting the review.
14. Clinically relevant educational program
shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis not less than 12 per year.
There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and subject
matter.
15. Regular staff meetings
shall be held at least monthly. Dated minutes of each meeting shall be kept in
writing.
16. There shall be an
ongoing program for orientation of staff.
17. There shall be an ongoing QA/PI
program.
B. Medical
records shall include at least:
1.
Identification data including patient's legal status;
2. Admitting psychiatric diagnosis as well as
diagnoses of medical problems;
3.
The reasons for the patient's admission to this level of care;
4. Social service records including reports
of interviews with patients, family members and others and a social history and
assessment;
5. Psychiatric
evaluation (See Section 37, Specialized Services: Psychiatric
Services.);
6. Treatment plan (See
Section 37, Specialized Services: Psychiatric Services.);
and
C. Medications.
Outpatient Services utilizing medications in therapeutic programs shall fulfill
the requirements in Section 16, Pharmacy.
D. Food and Nutritional Services. (See
Section 17, Food and Nutrition Services.)
E. Physical Facilities. The Outpatient
Psychiatric Centers shall comply with Section 75, Physical Facilities,
Outpatient Care Facilities.
SECTION
40
: REHABILITATION HOSPITALS AND UNITS.
A. General Requirements.
1. Rehabilitation Hospital means a hospital
or a distinct part of a hospital as designated in Section 3, Definitions, of
these rules which is used for the primary purpose of providing rehabilitative
services as so defined and shall comply with Sections 1, Authority, through
Section 38, Specialized Services: Care of Patients with Pulmonary Disease in
General Hospitals. Each hospital or unit shall have the capability of providing
or arranging for emergency services 24 hours per day, seven days per
week.
2. Any comprehensive physical
rehabilitative program shall provide through the use of qualified professional
personnel, at a minimum, the following clinical services:
a. Physical therapy;
b. Occupational therapy;
c. Speech therapy; and
d. Social services or psychological services.
NOTE: May be provided under contract or arrangement on an as
needed basis.
3. A
physician qualified by training, experience and knowledge of rehabilitative
medicine shall be appointed as the Medical Director.
4. Nursing Services shall be under the direct
supervision of a Registered Nurse who has a Master's Degree or be qualified by
education and experience in Rehabilitative Nursing. If the Registered Nurse
does not have the required credentials, a Master's prepared Registered Nurse
shall be available as a consultant. The number of Registered Nurses, Licensed
Practical Nurses and other nursing personnel shall be adequate to formulate and
carry out the nursing components of the individual treatment plan for each
patient. There shall be a Registered Nurse on duty 24 hours per day, seven days
per week, to plan, assign, supervise and evaluate nursing care and to provide
for the delivery of nursing care to patients.
5. A physician licensed in the State of
Arkansas shall be responsible for each patient's general medical condition as
needed. Medical services shall be available 24 hours per day, seven days per
week as needed. Upon admission there shall be written orders for the immediate
care of the patient.
6. Policies
and procedures shall be developed. The manual shall have evidence of ongoing
review and/or revision. The first page of the manual shall have the annual
review date, signature of the department supervisor and/or person(s) conducting
the review.
7. Clinically relevant
educational programs shall be conducted on a regularly scheduled basis not less
than 12 per year. There shall be evidence of program dates, attendance, and
subject matter.
8. Regular staff
meetings shall be held at least monthly. Dated minutes of each meeting shall be
kept in writing.
9. There shall be
an ongoing QA/PI program.
B. Special Medical Record Requirements.
(Refer also to Section 14, Health Information Services.) The medical record
shall include:
1. Reason for referral to
physical rehabilitation services or admission to the comprehensive physical
rehabilitation program;
2. History
and physical examination including patient's clinical condition, functional
strengths and limitations, indications and contra-indications for specific
physical rehabilitative services and prognosis;
3. Goals of treatment and the treatment plan,
including any problem that may affect the outcome of physical rehabilitation
services, and criteria for the discontinuation of services;
4. Interdisciplinary treatment plans to
include measurable goals of treatment and criteria for discharge. The plan
shall include ongoing assessments as required by the patient's medical
condition. Documentation of patient and family in the development of the
treatment plan and resolution of problems and rehabilitation
potential;
5. A discharge summary
that includes recommendations for further care; and
6. Patient evaluation procedures, including
treatment plan for each patient based on the functional assessment and
evaluation. The initial treatment plan shall be developed within 24 hours, and
a comprehensive individualized plan developed no later than one week after
admission and updated at least monthly. The plan shall state the rehabilitative
problem, goals and required therapeutic services, as well as prognosis,
anticipated length of stay and discharge disposition.
C. Physical Environment. The Rehabilitation
Facility shall comply with Section 42, Physical Environment.
D. Physical Facilities. The Rehabilitation
Facility shall comply with Section 76, Physical Facilities, and Rehabilitation
Facilities.
SECTION 41
: RECUPERATION CENTERS.
Any facility which includes inpatient beds with an organized
Medical Staff, and with medical services including physician services and
continuous nursing services to provide treatment for patients who are not in an
acute phase of illness but who currently require primarily convalescent or
restorative services, shall be considered a recuperation center and shall
comply with applicable Sections 1, Authority, through 72, Physical Facilities,
Electrical Standards.
A. Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement, Infection Prevention and Control, Pharmacy
and Therapeutics, and Utilization Review.
1.
The Recuperation Center shall maintain a Quality Assurance/Performance
Improvement Committee consisting of the Nurse Manager, Medical Director, and at
least three other members of the center's staff, which shall meet at least
quarterly to provide oversight and direction for the center's quality
assurance/performance improvement activities. Minutes of the Quality
Assurance/Performance Improvement Committee shall be maintained.
2. QA/PI activities shall include ongoing
monitoring, with identification of opportunities for improvement, actions
taken, and evaluation of the results of actions. QA/PI activities shall be
reported at least quarterly to the Medical Staff and Governing Body through the
hospital-wide QA/PI program.
3.
Reporting of all infection prevention and control, medication and utilization
review issues specific to the center shall be evident in the minutes of the
hospital-wide Infection Prevention and Control, Pharmacy and Therapeutics and
Utilization Review Committees. Frequency of reporting shall be defined in
policies and procedures consistent with State laws.
B. Patient identification. Patient armbands
shall not be routinely used. Reasonable measures shall be used to identify
patients.
C. Restraints. See
Section 13, Restraints.
D.
Documentation Requirements.
1. An assessment
of the patient's needs shall be completed by a Registered Nurse on
admission.
2. Each assessment shall
be coordinated with all health professionals.
3. The interdisciplinary team shall develop a
comprehensive care plan based on the patient's identified needs, measurable
goals of treatment, methods of intervention, and documentation of resolution or
continuance. There shall be documentation of the patient and family's
participation in the development of the care plan.
4. Verbal/telephone orders shall be reduced
to writing and countersigned by the physician.
E. Physical Environment. The requirements in
Section 44, Physical Facilities, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical,
Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary Disease) shall apply to recuperation
centers with the following exceptions:
1. The
patient dining, recreation, and day room(s) may be in separate or adjoining
rooms and shall have a total of 35 square feet per patient bed.
2. Patient corridors shall have handrails on
both sides of the corridors. A clear distance of one and one-half inches shall
be provided between the handrail and the wall. The top of the gripping surface
of handrails shall be 32 inches minimum and 36 inches maximum above the finish
floor. Ends of handrails and grab bars shall be constructed to prevent snagging
the clothes of patients. Exception, special care areas such as those serving
children.
F. Health
Information Services. Applicable parts of item D. of Section 14, Health
Information Services and Section 15, Medical Record Requirements for Outpatient
Services, Emergency Room, Observation Services and Psychiatric
Records.
G. Nursing Services. A
Registered Nurse shall observe each patient at least once per shift and the
observations shall be documented in the patient's medical record.
SECTION 42
: PHYSICAL
ENVIRONMENT.
A. Building and Grounds.
1. The building and equipment shall be
maintained in a state of good repair at all times.
2. Facilities and their premises shall be
kept clean, neat and free of litter, rubbish.
3. Rooms for gas fired equipment shall not be
used for storage except for noncombustible materials.
4. Portable equipment shall be supervised by
the department having control of such equipment and shall be stored in areas
which are not accessible to patients, visitors, or untrained
personnel.
5. Exit Access Corridors
shall be maintained clear and unobstructed of stationary and non-patient
related portable equipment. Stationary or portable non-patient care furnishings
or equipment shall not be stored in an Exit Access Corridor. Any portable
equipment such as a gurney, wheelchair, linen care, etc. that is not actively
used within a 30-minute time period is considered "Stored". The facility's fire
plan and training program shall address the relocation of these items during a
fire. Exit Access Corridors for Health Care Occupancies are those aisles,
corridors and ramps required for exit access that are located outside of a
"suite of sleeping rooms" greater than 5,000 sq. ft. or "suite of rooms"
greater than 10,000 sp. Ft (area is defined as occupiable net floor space).
Encroachments on the width of the means of egress in an Exit Access Corridor by
stationary objects or furnishings shall not be allowed. The width of the means
of egress in an Exit Access Corridor shall be defined by physical means such as
corridor walls, columns, or other approved methods. The means of egress may
provide both visual and physical barrier design characteristics conducive to
establishing a common egress that provides for either a change in floor texture
or self-illumination in the dark. Alternative consideration: the Means of
Egress Requirements for Health Care Occupancies of NFPA 101 (or equivalency per
Section 43 of these rules).
6. Each
hospital shall develop a written preventive maintenance plan. This plan shall
be available to the Department for review at any time. Such plans shall provide
for maintenance as recommended by manufacturer, applicable codes, or
designer.
7. The hand washing
facilities in visitors' rest rooms and the handwashing facilities used by staff
personnel shall be equipped with a soap dispenser, and a towel
dispenser.
8. A supply of hot water
for patient use shall be available at all times. A weekly hot water temperature
log shall be maintained.
9.
Heating, ventilating and air-conditioning (HVAC) systems shall be operated, and
maintained in a manner to provide a comfortable and safe environment for
patients, personnel, and visitors. An air filter change out log shall be
maintained.
B.
Maintenance and Engineering.
1. The physical
plant and equipment maintenance programs shall be under the direction of a
person qualified by training and/or experience and licensed where
required.
2. Equipment Management
Program (EMP). There shall be a preventive maintenance program designed to
assure the electrically powered patient care equipment used to monitor,
diagnose, or provide therapy, performs properly and safely. This program shall
be administered by individuals qualified through training and/or experience or
by procuring a contractual maintenance agreement. The following are minimum
program elements:
a. A current list of
electrically powered patient care equipment shall be maintained regardless of
location or ownership;
b. Each
device, or identical group of devices, shall have a procedure establishing
minimum criteria against which performance and safety are measured. The
elements of these procedures shall be based on the manufacturer's
directions;
c. Each device shall be
tested at intervals of not more than six months unless there is documented
evidence that less frequent testing is justified;
d. Historical records documenting acceptable
performance as established by the procedures shall be maintained;
e. A program to identify and repair equipment
failures shall be maintained;
f.
User or owner departments shall be notified of the status of their equipment
when it will be out of service more than 24 hours;
g. There are operator and maintenance
instructions for each device, or group of similar devices on the electrically
powered patient care equipment list; and
h. Individuals shall be trained to operate
and maintain equipment used in the performance of their duties. This training
shall be documented.
3.
Utilities Management Program (UMP). There shall be a preventive maintenance
program designed to assure that the physical plant equipment and building
systems perform properly and safely. This program shall be administered by
individuals qualified through training and/or experience or by procuring a
contractual agreement. This program shall consist of at least the following
minimum elements:
a. A list of physical plant
equipment and/or building system(s) shall be maintained regardless of location
or ownership;
b. Equipment and/or
building system(s), shall have a procedure establishing minimum criteria
against which performance and safety are measured. The elements of these
procedures shall be based on the manufacturer's directions and/or the
experience of the repair technician or operator;
c. Equipment and/or building system(s), shall
be tested, serviced, or inspected at intervals of not more than 12months unless
there is documented evidence that less frequent service is justified;
d. Historical records documenting acceptable
performance as established by the procedures shall be maintained;
e. A program to identify and repair equipment
failures shall be maintained;
f.
User or owner departments shall be notified of the status of their equipment or
system when it will be out of service for more than 24hours;
g. There shall be operator and/or maintenance
instructions for each piece of equipment or building system on the list;
and
h. Individuals shall be trained
to operate and maintain physical plant equipment and/or building systems. This
training shall be documented.
4. Life Safety Management Program (LSM).
There shall be a preventive maintenance program designed to assure that all
circuits of fire alarm and detection systems shall be inspected, tested and
maintained in accordance with NFPA 72. Analog detection devices that provide
automatic self-testing are exempt from the quarterly testing requirement. This
program shall be administered by individuals qualified through training and/or
experience or by procuring a contractual maintenance agreement. This program
shall consist of the following minimum elements:
a. A list of all fire protection equipment or
component groups shall be maintained;
b. Equipment and/or component groups, shall
have a procedure establishing minimum criteria against which performance and
safety are measured. The elements of these procedures shall be based on the
manufacturer's recommendations and/or the experience of the repair technician
or operator;
c. Fans or dampers in
air handling and smoke management systems shall be reliable and functional at
all times;
d. Automatic fire
extinguishing systems shall be inspected and tested annually; actual discharge
of the fire extinguishing system is not required. Records documenting
acceptable performance as established by the procedures shall be
maintained;
e. A program to
identify and repair equipment and/or component group failures shall be
maintained;
f. Systems for
transmitting fire alarms to the local fire department shall be reliable and
functional at all times;
g. There
shall be operator and maintenance instructions for each piece of equipment
and/or component group on the list;
h. Individuals shall be trained to operate
and maintain all equipment and/or component group on the list; and
i. Portable fire extinguishers shall be
clearly identified.
5.
Emergency Procedures Program (EPP). There shall be written emergency procedures
or a disaster management plan for utility system disruptions or failures which
address the specific and concise procedures to follow in the event of a utility
system malfunction or failure of the water supply, hot water system, medical
gas system, sewer system, bulk waste disposal system, natural gas system,
commercial power system, communication system, boiler or steam delivery system.
a. These procedures shall be kept separate
from all other policy and procedure manuals as to facilitate their rapid
implementation.
b. These procedures
shall contain but are not limited to the following information:
1) A method of obtaining alternative sources
of essential utilities;
2) A method
of shutoff and location of valves for malfunctioning systems;
3) A method of notification of hospital staff
in affected areas; and
4) A method
of obtaining repair services.
6. Policies and procedures shall include job
descriptions and orientation practices for employees.
7. Policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department supervisor and/or
person(s) conducting the review.
8.
Relevant educational programs shall be conducted at regularly scheduled
intervals with no less than six per year. There shall be evidence of program
dates, attendance and subject matter.
9. The department director shall ensure that
all employees annually attend mandatory educational programs on the fire
safety, back safety, infection prevention and control, universal precautions,
emergency procedures and disaster preparedness or make provisions to conduct
these departmentally.
10. There
shall be sufficient supervisory and support personnel to provide maintenance
services in relation to the size and complexity of the facility and the
services that are provided.
11. An
ongoing QA/PI program with a liaison with the Infection Prevention and Control
and Safety Committees.
C.
Environmental Services.
1. The environmental
services shall be under the direction of a person qualified by training and/or
experience and licensed where required.
2. There shall be written policies and
procedures which include:
a. Cleaning of the
physical plant;
b. The use, care,
and cleaning of equipment; and
c.
Specific cleaning methods used for:
1)
Operating rooms;
2) Delivery
rooms;
3) Nurseries/infant care
units;
4) Emergency
rooms;
5) Isolation areas;
and
6) Other units as
appropriate.
d. Job
descriptions;
e. Orientation
practices;
f. Safety
practices;
g. Infection prevention
and control measures;
h. Methods
used for evaluation of cleaning effectiveness;
i. Personal hygiene;
j. The selection of housekeeping and cleaning
supplies; and
k. The proper use of
housekeeping and cleaning supplies.
3. The policy and procedure manual shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department and/or person(s)
conducting the review.
4. Relevant
in-service educational programs shall be conducted at regularly scheduled
intervals with no less than six per year. There shall be written documentation
with employee signatures, program title/subject, presenter, date, and outline
or narrative of presented program.
5. Expendable supplies (i.e., soap, paper
products, etc.) shall be stored in a manner that shall prevent their
contamination prior to use.
6.
Solutions, cleaning compounds, disinfectants, vermin control chemicals, and all
other potentially hazardous substances that are used in connection with
environmental services shall be:
a. Kept in
containers which accurately reflect at least the following:
1) Content name;
2) Concentration of solution;
3) Expiration date and lot number;
b. Stored in a secured area. Under
no circumstances shall these substances be stored in or near food storage or
food preparation areas;
c. Selected
by the director of environmental services or other appointed qualified person.
The Infection Prevention and Control Committee shall initially approve the list
of chemicals used in the facility and thereafter, any additions or deletions to
the list.
7. A designee
from this department shall be a member of the Infection Prevention and Control
Committee.
8. The use of common
towels and common drinking utensils shall be prohibited.
9. Dry, or untreated dusting, sweeping, or
mopping, except vacuum type cleaning shall be prohibited within the
facility.
10. There shall be an
ongoing QA/PI Program with a mechanism for reporting results.
D. Linen Services.
1. Laundry services shall be under the
direction of a person qualified by training and/or experience and licensed
where required.
2. There shall be
sufficient support personnel to provide linen services in relation to the size
and complexity of the facility and the services that are provided.
3. There shall be written policies and
procedures which include:
a. Collection of
soiled, wet, and contaminated linen;
b. Transporting of soiled, wet, and
contaminated linen to the laundry service or to a designated area for
commercial pick-up;
c. Storage of
soiled, wet, and contaminated linen until laundering or being picked up by the
commercial laundry;
d. Storage of
clean linen; and
e. Specific
laundry requirements (type detergent, sours, bleach, time and temperatures
used) for washing:
1) New linen;
2) Diapers;
3) Soiled, wet, and contaminated
linen.
f. Personal
hygiene;
g. Evaluation of
washing/cleaning effectiveness;
h.
Job descriptions;
i. Orientation
practices for new employees;
j.
Safety practices; and
k. Infection
prevention and control measures.
4. Policies and procedures for Linen Services
shall have evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of the
manual shall have the annual review date, signature of the department
supervisor and/or person(s) conducting the review.
5. Relevant in-service educational programs
shall be conducted at regularly scheduled intervals with no less than six per
year. There shall be written documentation with employee signature, program
title/subject, presenter, date and outline or narrative of presented
program.
6. Facility linen service:
a. Sorting of soiled laundry shall be done in
a designated area;
b. Tables or
bins shall be provided for sorting of soiled laundry;
c. Lint traps shall be provided on dryers and
shall be cleaned regularly;
d.
Prerinsing shall be done in the laundry service not in showers, bathtubs or
lavatories;
e. Removal of solid
soil shall be done in soiled utility rooms or rooms that are designated for
this purpose;
f. Patient clothing
may be washed in the patient area if a separate equipped laundry room is
available;
g. A rinsing sink shall
be provided in the soiled linen area of the laundry;
h. Hot water supplied to laundry areas shall
be in accordance with Table 9 of the Appendix;
i. Linen contained in hot water soluble
plastic bags (identified as being contaminated) shall be placed directly into
the washing machine without being removed from the bag for sorting;
j. A lavatory equipped with wrist action
controls, a soap dispenser and a towel dispenser shall be provided in the
laundry for use by the personnel;
k. Personnel with infectious disease or open
wounds shall not be permitted in the laundry; and
l. Personnel assigned to laundry duties shall
wash their hands:
1) After handling wet or
soiled laundry;
2) Before leaving
the laundry;
3) After using the
toilet; and
4) As often as is
necessary to maintain good hygiene.
NOTE: Laundry equipment and installation requirements are set
forth in Section 64, Physical Facilities, Linen Service.
7. Soiled linen from
isolation areas, surgical cases, etc., shall be placed into impervious bags
and, if leakage occurs, bagged into a second bag with proper identification.
Suitable precautions shall be taken in transport, handling, and
processing.
8. Soiled, wet, and
contaminated linens shall be transported in a closed container.
9. Soiled, wet, and contaminated linens shall
be stored in closed containers or impervious bags in designated areas off the
floor. Areas for storage of soiled, wet, and contaminated linens shall have
forced ventilation to the outside of the building.
10. All new clothing, linen and diapers shall
be laundered before being used.
11.
There shall be a designated area for the storage of clean linens.
12. The linen service within the facility
shall have a capacity sufficient to process a continuous supply of clean
laundry ready for use.
13.
Temperature used in the dryer will depend on the type fabric. An employee shall
be present at all times when the dryer is in operation.
14. There shall be an ongoing QA/PI Program
with a mechanism for reporting results.
15. Linen Service shall include a written
contingency plan indicating an alternative provision that may be followed in
the event the laundry is unable to meet the production demand of the
facility.
16. Separate containers
for the disposal of infectious waste and sharps shall be located in the soiled
linen sorting area.
17. Laundry
workers handling infectious linens shall wear protective equipment, including
but not limited to waterproof, puncture-resistant gloves, protective
overclothing, and where necessary, face shields or goggles.
18. Facilities which do not have linen
services:
a. The facility shall determine that
all launderable items are processed in a commercial laundry in accordance with
standards set forth in this section and shall conduct annual onsite inspections
of the commercial laundry and shall require written verification of compliance
by the laundry.
b. Soiled, wet, and
contaminated laundry shall be stored in a the commercial laundry;
c. A designated clean area shall be provided
for receiving clean laundry and shall be separate from the soiled linen
area;
d. Clean linen shall be
packaged and protected from contamination during transportation and
storage.
19. Refer to
Section 18, Infection Prevention and Control, for additional
requirements.
E. Safety
Services.
1. There shall be an effective
program to enhance safety within the facility and grounds. The program shall be
monitored by a Safety Committee appointed by the Administrator. Committee
members may be selected from areas such as Administration, Nursing,
Maintenance, Housekeeping, Laboratory, Respiratory Care, Rehabilitation
Services, the Medical Staff and others as appropriate.
2. The Safety Committee shall meet a minimum
four times per year to fulfill safety objectives. Minutes of each meeting shall
be recorded and kept in the facility.
3. The Administrator shall designate a
specific individual to carry out policies established by the Committee and to
gather data for the Committee to study safety related incidents.
4. Safety policies and procedures shall have
evidence of ongoing review and/or revision. The first page of each manual shall
have the annual review date, signature of the department supervisor and/or
person(s) conducting the review. Safety policies and procedures shall include:
a. Facility wide hazard surveillance
program;
b. Response to
medical-device recalls and hazard notices;
c. Safety education;
d. Reporting of all accidents, injuries, and
safety hazards;
e. External and
internal disaster plans;
f. Fire
safety; and
g. Safety devices and
operational practices.
5.
The orientation program for the facility shall include the importance of
general safety, fire safety and the responsibility of each individual to the
program.
6. The Safety Committee
shall have the following functions:
a.
Monitoring the results of the safety program and analyzing the effectiveness of
the program annually;
b. Monitor
fire drills and disaster drills at required intervals;
c. Conclusions, recommendations, and actions
of the committee shall be reported to the Board at a minimum annually;
and
d. Ensuring each department or
service shall have a safety policy and procedure manual within their own area
that is a part of the overall facility safety manual and establishes safety
policies and procedures specific to each area.
7. Fire extinguishers shall be provided in
adequate numbers, of the correct type, and shall be properly located and
installed. Personnel shall be trained in the proper use of fire extinguishers
and equipment. Personnel shall follow procedures in fire containment and
evacuating patients in case of fire or explosion. There shall be an annual
check of all fire extinguishers by qualified persons in accordance with the
applicable sections of the National Fire Protection Association's Standard 10
(NFPA 10). The date the check was made and the initials of the inspector shall
be recorded on the fire extinguisher or on a tag attached to the
extinguisher.
8. Any fire or
disaster event at the facility shall be reported immediately to the Arkansas
Department of Health by telephone 501-661-2201 during regular working hours or
to 501-661-2136 after normal working hours, holidays and weekends. If any
fire(s) or disaster is not reported to the Department, the facility is subject
to a fine, refer to item J. of Section 4, Licensure and Codes.
9. There shall be policies and procedures
governing the routine methods of handling and storing flammable and explosive
agents, particularly in operating rooms, delivery rooms, laundries and in areas
where oxygen therapy is administered.
10. There shall be keys available to assure
prompt access to all locked areas. All doors shall be devised so they can be
opened from the inside of the locked area. Special door locking devices are
acceptable in limited areas. Usage is subject to all codes and
regulations.
11. All required exit
doors shall remain unlocked per NFPA requirements.
12. A list of Material Safety Data Sheets
(MSDS) for solutions, cleaning compounds, disinfectants, vermin control
chemicals, and other potentially hazardous substances used in connection with
the facility shall be readily available to the Safety Committee, Emergency
Room, Environmental Services and as directed by facility policy and
procedures.
SECTION
43
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES.
A. General Considerations.
1. The requirements set forth herein have
been established by the Department and constitute minimum requirements for the
design, construction, renovation, and repair of facilities requiring licensure
under these rules.
2. Facilities
shall be accessible to the public, staff, and patients with physical
disabilities. Minimum requirements shall be those set forth by the Arkansas
State Building Services, Minimum Standards and Criteria - Accessibility for the
Physically Disabled Standards.
3.
Projects involving renovation and additions to existing facilities shall be
programmed and phased to minimize disruption of the existing functions. Access,
exits and fire protection shall be maintained for the occupant's and the
facility's safety.
4. Codes and
Standards. Nothing stated herein shall relieve the owner from compliance with
building codes, ordinances, and regulations which are enforced by city, county,
or other State jurisdictions. Where such codes, ordinances, and regulations are
not in effect, the owner shall consult the state building codes for all
components of the building type which are not specifically covered by these
minimum requirements. In location where there is a history of tornadoes,
floods, earthquakes or other regional disasters, planning and design shall
consider the need to protect the occupants and the facility.
B. Occupancy: Each licensed
facility or portion of a licensed facility shall be classified as indicated
below:
1. General Hospital: A facility or
portion of a facility licensed by the Department as a General Hospital that
provide for patient care, treatment, or diagnosis on a 24-hour basis and
provides treatment or anesthesia for patients that renders the patients
incapable of taking action for self- preservation under emergency conditions
without the assistance of others.
2. Mobile, Transportable, and Relocatable
Unit: A portion of a facility licensed by the Department that meets the
definitions provided in Section 54 for mobile, transportable, and relocatable
units.
3. Outpatient Care Facility:
A portion of a facility licensed by the Department that provides patient care,
treatment or diagnosis on a less than 24-hour basis and does not provide
treatment or anesthesia for patients that renders the patients incapable of
taking action for self- preservation under emergency conditions without the
assistance of others. Outpatient care facilities may be utilized on occasion by
hospital inpatients provided that such use is limited to a less than 24 hour
basis.
4. Rehabilitation Facility:
A facility or portion of a facility licensed by the Department as a
Rehabilitation Facility.
5.
Non-Healthcare Occupancy: A portion of a licensed facility that does not
contain areas intended for patient care, treatment, or diagnosis and does not
contain equipment (mechanical, electrical, plumbing, communication, fire alarm,
etc.) that serves areas intended for patient care, treatment, or
diagnosis.
C. Multiple
Occupancy: Facilities may contain more than one occupancy (as described above)
provided each different occupancy is separated from all other occupancies by a
2-hour fire resistive rated smoke barrier.
D. Construction Projects: Each construction
project shall be classified as indicated below:
1. Addition: A project that increases the
floor area of a licensed facility.
2. Repair: A project that provides for the
repair or renewal of a licensed facility or portion of a licensed facility
solely for the purpose of its maintenance.
3. Simple Renovation: A project other than
repair that meets all of the criteria listed below:
a. The project does not increase the floor
area of a licensed facility.
b. The
project does not change the occupancy of a licensed facility or portion of a
licensed facility.
c. The project
does not involve more than two (2) smoke compartments.
d. The smoke compartments affected by the
project were completely protected by an automatic sprinkler system prior to the
project or the project provides for the installation of a complete automatic
sprinkler system in all smoke compartments that are affected by the
project.
E.
Applicable Requirements Based upon Occupancy:
1. Existing Facilities: Existing facilities
that do not comply with these rules shall be permitted to continue in service,
provided the lack of conformity with these rules does not present a serious
hazard to the occupants as determined by Health Facility Services or other
authorities having jurisdiction.
2.
General Hospital: Facilities or portions of facilities classified as a General
Hospital occupancy shall be designed, constructed, and renovated in accordance
with the Sections of these rules listed below and all publications and
Appendices referenced by these Sections.
a.
Section 42
b. Section 43
c. Section 44 through 53
d. Sections 54 through 76
3. Mobile, Transportable, and
Relocatable Unit: Facilities or portions of facilities classified as a Mobile,
Transportable, and Relocatable Unit occupancy shall be designed, constructed,
and renovated in accordance with the Sections of these rules listed below and
all publications and Appendices referenced by these Sections.
a. Section 42
b. Section 43
c. Section 54
4. Outpatient Care Facility: Facilities or
portions of facilities classified as Outpatient Care Facility occupancy shall
be designed, constructed, and renovated in accordance with the Sections of
these rules listed below and all publications and Appendices referenced by
these Sections.
a. Section 42
b. Section 43
c. Section 75
5. Rehabilitation Facility: Facilities or
portions of facilities classified as an Outpatient Care Facility occupancy
shall be designed, constructed, and renovated in accordance with the Sections
of these rules listed below and all publications and Appendices referenced by
these Sections.
a. Section 42
b. Section 43
c. Section 76
6. Non-Healthcare Occupancy Facilities or
portions of facilities classified as a Non-Healthcare occupancy shall be
designed, constructed, and renovated in accordance with the Sections of these
rules listed below and all publications and Appendices referenced by these
Sections.
a. Section 42
b. Section 43
F. Applicable Requirements Based upon the
Type of Project:
1. General:
a. Where renovation work is done within an
existing facility, all new work, or additions, or both, shall comply, insofar
as practical with applicable sections of these rules and appropriate sections
of National Fire Protection Association (NFPA) 101 Life Safety Code covering
new occupancies. Where major structural elements make total compliance
impractical or impossible, exceptions will be considered.
b. In renovation projects and projects
involving additions to existing facilities, only that portion of the total
facility affected by the project shall comply with applicable sections of these
rules and with appropriate parts of NFPA 101 covering new occupancies. Existing
portions of the facility that are not included in the project but essential to
the functioning of a complete facility shall comply (at a minimum) with the
appropriate sections of NFPA 101 covering existing occupancies. Existing
portions of the facility that receive less then substantial amounts of new
work, shall also comply (at a minimum) with the appropriate sections of NFPA
101 covering existing occupancies.
c. Facilities or portions of facilities shall
be permitted to be occupied during construction, renovation, and repair only
where required means of egress and required fire protection features are in
place and continuously maintained for the portion occupied or where alternate
life safety measures acceptable to Health Facility Services and other
authorities having jurisdiction are in place.
2. Addition, Simple Renovation, and Complex
Renovation shall be designed, constructed, and renovated in accordance with the
applicable Sections of these rules and all Appendices and publications
referenced by these Sections.
3.
Repair projects shall be designed and constructed in a manner that does not
diminish the safety level that existed prior to the start of the
work.
G. Project Review
and Approval Process.
1. Coordination: Health
Facilities Services will coordinate the review and approval process for all
offices of the Department.
2.
Addition or Complex Renovation Projects shall be reviewed and approved by
Health Facility Services as indicated below:
a. Drawing Review and Approval Process:
1) Submission of Plan Review Fee: A plan
review fee in the amount of one percent of the total cost of construction or
$500.00, whichever is less, shall be paid for the review of plans and
specifications. The plan review fee check is to be made payable to Arkansas
Department of Health. A detailed estimate shall accompany the plans unless the
maximum fee of $500.00 is paid.
2)
Submission of Functional Program: Refer to Section 43, Paragraph H.
3) Submission of Site Location: Refer to
paragraph Section 43, Paragraph I.
4) Submission of Preliminary Plans: Refer to
Section 43, Paragraph J.
5) Review
of Functional Program, Site Location, and Preliminary Plans: Health Facility
Services shall review the Functional Program, Site Location, and Preliminary
Plans and forward a written response with comments to the Facility.
6) Submission of Final Construction
Documents: Refer to Section 43, Paragraph K.
7) Review and Approval of Final Construction
Documents: Health Facility Services shall review the Final Construction
Documents and forward a written response with comments to the Facility and the
Design Professional. Health Facility Services shall have a minimum of six (6)
weeks to review Final Construction Documents. The written response shall
indicate whether or not the Final Construction Documents are approved. If the
Final Construction Documents are not approved, the written response shall
indicate the design modifications required to secure approval.
8) Plans may be certified by a Licensed
Architect or Professional Engineer with respect to compliance with the
applicable codes, rules, and standards.
b. Approval to Begin Construction: Facilities
may proceed with Addition and Complex Renovation projects after receiving a
letter from Health Facility Services stating that the Final Construction
Documents have been reviewed and approved and after receiving approval from
other authorities having jurisdiction.
c. Site Inspections During Construction:
Refer to Section 43, Paragraph L.
d. Final Site Inspection: Refer to Section
43, Paragraph M.
2.
Repair: Repair projects do not require Health Facility Services review and
approval.
3. Simple Renovation
Projects submitted to Health Facility Services shall be reviewed and approved
by Health Facility Services as indicated below:
a. Drawing Review and Approval Process:
1) Submission of Plan Review Fee: A plan
review fee in the amount of one percent of the total cost of construction or
$500.00, whichever is less, shall be paid for the review of plans and
specifications. The plan review fee check is to be made payable to the Arkansas
Department of Health. A detailed estimate shall accompany the plans unless the
maximum fee of $500.00 is paid.
2)
Submission of Functional Program: Refer to Section 43, Paragraph H.
3) Submission of Final Construction
Documents: Refer to Section 43, Paragraph K.
4) Review and Approval of Final Construction
Documents: Health Facility Services shall review the Final Construction
Documents and forward a written response with comments to the Facility. Health
Facility Services shall have a minimum of six (6) weeks to review Final
Construction Documents. The written response shall indicate whether or not the
Final Construction Documents are approved. If the Final Construction Documents
are not approved, the written response shall indicate the design modifications
required to secure approval.
5)
Plans may be certified by a Licensed Architect or Professional Engineer with
respect to compliance with the applicable codes, rules, and
standards.
b. Approval to
Begin Construction: Facilities may proceed with Simple Renovation projects
after receiving a letter from Health Facility Services stating that the Final
Construction Documents have been reviewed and approved and after receiving
approval from other authorities having jurisdiction.
c. Site Inspections During Construction:
Refer to Section 43, Paragraph L.
d. Final Site Inspection: Refer to Section
43, Paragraph M.
H. Functional Program.
The facility shall supply for each project (other than repair
project) a functional program that describes the purpose of the project and
indicates the estimated cost of construction.
I. Site Location.
1. Location.
a. The site of any medical facility should be
easily accessible to the community and to service vehicles such as fire
protection apparatus.
b. Facilities
should be located with due regard to the accessibility by public transportation
for patients, staff, and visitors, and availability of competent medical and
surgical consultation.
c. The
facility should have security measures for patients, personnel, and the public
consistent with the conditions and risks inherent in the location of the
facility. These measures shall include a program designed to protect human and
capital resources.
d. The facility
should be located to provide reliable utilities (water, natural gas, sewer and
electricity).
e. The site should
afford good drainage and shall not be subject to flooding nor be located near
insect breeding areas, excessive noise, nor other nuisance producing locations,
nor near airports, railways, air pollution, penal institutions (except prison
infirmaries), or a cemetery.
2. Roads and Parking.
a. Paved roads and walks shall be provided
within the lot lines to provide access to the main entrance and service
entrance, including loading and unloading docks for delivery trucks. Hospitals
having an organized emergency services department shall have the emergency
entrance well marked to facilitate entry from the public roads or streets
serving the site. Access to the emergency entrance shall not conflict with
other vehicular traffic or pedestrian traffic. Paved walkways shall be provided
for necessary pedestrian traffic.
b. Each facility shall have parking spaces to
satisfy the minimum needs of patients, employees, staff, and visitors. In the
absence of a formal parking study, each facility shall provide not less than
one space for each day shift staff member and employee plus one space for each
patient bed. This ratio may be reduced in an area convenient to a public
transportation system or to a public parking facility if proper justification
is given and provided that approval of any reduction is obtained from the
Department. Additional parking shall be required to accommodate outpatient and
other services when they are provided. Space shall be provided for emergency
and delivery vehicles.
3.
Subsoil Investigation. Subsoil investigation shall be made to determine the
subsurface soil and water conditions. The investigation shall include a
sufficient number of test pits or test borings to determine, in the judgment of
the architect and the structural engineer, the true subsurface conditions.
Results of the investigation shall be available in the form of a soil
investigation report or a foundation engineering report. The investigation
shall be made in close cooperation with the architect and structural engineer
and shall contain detailed recommendations for foundation design and gradings.
The following is a general outline of the suggested scope of soil
investigation:
a. The borings or test pits
shall extend into stable soils well below the bottom of any proposed
foundations. A field log of the borings shall be made and the thickness,
consistency, and character of each layer recorded;
b. The amount and elevation of groundwater
encountered in each pit or boring and its probable variation with the seasons
and effect on the subsoil shall be determined. High or low water levels of
nearby bodies of water affecting the ground level shall also be
determined;
c. Laboratory tests
shall be performed to determine the safe bearing value and compressibility
characteristics of the various strata encountered in each pit or
boring;
d. Maximum depth of frost
penetration below surface of the ground shall be recorded;
e. Tests shall be made to determine whether
the soil contains alkali in sufficient quantities to affect concrete
foundations;
4. Approval.
The new building site shall be inspected and approved by the Department before
construction begins.
J.
Preliminary Plans: Preliminary plans submitted to Health Facility Services
shall include minimum the following information:
1. Floor plans drawn to scale that indicate
room names, room dimensions, corridor dimensions, locations of fire resistive
rated partitions, and locations of rated smoke barriers.
2. An existing floor plan indicating existing
spaces and exits and their relationship to the new construction (renovation
projects only)
3. Building sections
that establish the proposed construction type and fire rating. Sections shall
be drawn at a scale sufficiently large to clearly present the proposed
construction system.
4. A site plan
that indicates the location of proposed roads, walks, service and entrance
courts, parking and orientation.
5.
Simple horizontal and vertical space diagrams that indicate the relationship of
various departments and services to each other the general room arrangement in
each department.
6. A narrative
description of proposed mechanical, electrical, and fire protection
systems.
K. Final
Construction Documents.
1. Construction
Documents shall be prepared by an architect and/or professional engineer
licensed by the State of Arkansas.
2. Architectural construction documents shall
be prepared by an architect and engineering construction documents (structural,
mechanical, electrical, and civil) shall be prepared by a qualified engineer.
The documents shall be stamped with appropriate seals for each
discipline.
3. Periodic
observations of construction shall be provided and documented by each design
professional. Design professionals shall verify that the construction is in
accordance with the construction documents and that the Record Drawings are
properly maintained.
4. The
construction contract shall contain a provision to withhold progress payments
to the contractor until the Record Drawings are current.
5. Final Construction Documents shall include
drawings and specifications. Separate drawings and specifications shall be
prepared for each of the following branches of work: architectural, structural,
mechanical, electrical, life safety and fire protection.
6. The drawings shall include the following
information:
a. Architectural.
1) Approved plan showing all new topography,
newly established levels and grades, existing structures on the site (if any),
new buildings and structures, roadways, walks, and the extent of the areas to
be planted. All structures and improvements removed under the construction
contract. A print of the survey included with the working drawings.
2) Plan of each floor, roof, and all
intermediate levels.
3) Elevations
of each exterior wall.
4) Sections
through building.
5) Scale details
as necessary to properly indicate portions of the work.
6) Schedule of finishes.
b. Equipment.
1) Large scale drawings of typical and
special rooms indicating all fixed equipment and major items of furniture and
movable equipment.
2) The furniture
and movable equipment not included in the construction contract shall be
indicated by dotted lines.
c. Structural.
1) Plans of foundations, floors, roofs, and
all intermediate levels shall show a complete design with sizes, sections, and
the relative location of the various members and schedule of beams, girders,
and columns.
2) Dimensional floor
levels, column centers and offsets.
3) Special openings.
4) Details of all special connections,
assemblies, and expansion joints.
5) Name of the governing building
code.
d. Mechanical.
1) Heating, piping, and air-conditioning
systems:
a) Steam heated equipment, such as
sterilizers, warmers, and steam tables;
b) Heating and steam mains and branches with
pipe sizes;
c) Diagram of heating
and steam risers with pipe sizes;
d) Sizes, types, and heating surfaces of
boilers and oil burners, if any;
e)
Pumps, tanks, boiler breeching and piping, and boiler room
accessories;
f) Air-conditioning
systems with required equipment, water refrigerant piping, and ductwork showing
required fire smoke/dampers;
g) Air
quantities for all room supply, return, and exhaust ventilating duct
openings;
h) A ventilation schedule
specifying the following information: room number, room name, room volume
(ft3), required room air changes, required outside air changes, required air
movement relative to adjacent area, required air filtration (% efficiency),
required room total supply air quantity (CFM), required room exhaust air
quantity (CFM), design room total supply air quantity (CFM), design room return
air quantity (CFM), design outside air quantity(CFM), design room exhaust air
quantity (CFM), design room air filtration (% efficiency), room design summer
('F) dry bulb/wet bulb (DB/WB), room design winter ('F) DB/WB, outside air
design summer ('F) DB/WB, and outside air design winter ('F) DB/WB.
i) Air filter design pressure drop both clean
and dirty.
2) Plumbing,
drainage, and standpipe systems:
a) Size and
elevation of street sewer, house sewer, house drains, and street water
main;
b) Locations and size of
soil, waste, and vent stacks with connections to house drains, clean outs,
fixtures and equipment;
c) Size and
location of hot and cold circulating mains, branches, and risers from the
service entrance and tanks;
d)
Riser diagram to show all plumbing stacks with vents, water risers, and fixture
connections;
e) Gas, oxygen, and
special connections;
f) Standpipe
and sprinkler systems;
g) Plumbing
fixtures and equipment which require water and drain connections;
3) Elevators and dumbwaiters:
Details and dimensions of shaft, pit and machine room, pit sumps with alarms
when required, sizes of car platform and doors.
4) Kitchens, laundry, refrigeration, and
laboratories detailed at a satisfactory scale (1/4 inch scale) to show the
location, size, and connection of all fixed and moveable equipment.
e. Electrical.
1) All electrical wiring, outlets, smoke
detectors, and equipment which require electrical connections.
2) Electrical service entrance with switches,
and feeders to the public service feeders, characteristics of the light and
power current and transformers and their connections, if located in the
building.
3) Plan and diagram
showing main switchboard power panels, light panels and equipment. Diagram of
feeder and conduit sizes with a schedule of feeder breakers or
switches.
4) Light outlets,
receptacles, switches, power outlets, and circuits.
5) Telephone layout showing service entrance,
telephone switchboard, terminal boxes, and telephone outlets.
6) Nurse call systems with outlets for beds,
nurse's stations, door signal lights, annunciators, and wiring
diagrams.
7) Staff paging and
doctor's in-and-out registry systems with all equipment wiring, if
provided.
8) Fire alarm and or
security system with stations, signal devices, control board, and wiring
diagrams.
9) Emergency electrical
system with outlets, transfer switch, source of supply, feeders, and
circuits.
10) Medical gas alarm
systems.
11) All other electrically
operated systems and equipment.
f. Life Safety and Fire Protection.
1) Limits of each smoke
compartment.
2) Location of each
smoke barrier wall.
3) Dimensions
and gross areas of each smoke compartment.
4) Location of each fire rated wall or
partition, fire separation wall and horizontal exit.
5) Location of each exit sign, fire pull
station, and extinguisher cabinet and extinguisher.
6) Travel distance(s) from the most remote
location(s) in the building to an exit as defined by NFPA 101 (i.e., horizontal
exit, exit passageway, enclosed exit stair, exterior exit door).
g. Specifications.
1) Specifications shall supplement the
drawings to fully describe types, sizes, capacities, workmanships, finishes,
and other characteristics of all materials and equipment and shall include the
following:
a) Cover or title sheet with
architectural seal;
b)
Index;
c) General
conditions;
d) General
requirements;
e) Sections
describing material and workmanship in detail for each class of work.
h. All construction
documents and specifications shall be approved by the Department prior to the
beginning of construction and a letter shall be issued from the licensing
agency granting approval to commence with construction. The Department shall
have a minimum of six weeks to review construction documents and
specifications. Health Facility Services shall coordinate the plan review with
other Divisions in the Department. Penalties for starting construction without
Department approval see Section 4.I, Licensure and Codes.
L. Site Inspection During
Construction. The Department shall inspect the project during the construction
process as indicated below:
1. This Department
is to be notified when construction begins and a construction schedule shall be
submitted to determine inspection dates.
2. Representatives from the Department shall
have access to the construction premises and the construction project for
purposes of making whatever inspections deemed necessary throughout the course
of construction.
3. Any deviation
from the accepted construction documents shall not be permitted during
construction, until the written request for change(s) in the construction is
approved by this Department.
M. Final Site Inspection.
1. Upon completion of construction and prior
to the approval by the Department to occupy and use the facility, the owner
shall be furnished a complete set of recorded drawings and a complete set of
installation, operation, and maintenance manuals and parts lists for the
installed equipment.
2. A list of
final site inspection items has been provided in the Table 5 of the
Appendix.
3. No facility shall
occupy any new structure or major addition or renovation space until the
appropriate permission has been received from the local building and fire
authorities and licensing agency.
N. Referenced Publications.
1. General: These rules include references to
other codes and standards. The most current codes and standards adopted at the
time of this publication are used. Later issues will normally be acceptable
where requirements for function and safety are not reduced; however, editions
of different dates may have portions renumbered or re-titled. Care shall be
taken to ensure that appropriate sections are used.
2. Publications adopted in whole by these
rules are as listed below:
a. American
National Standards Institute (ANSI) Standard A17.1, "American National Standard
Safety Code for Elevators, Dumbwaiters, Escalators and Moving
Stairs."
b. American Society of
Civil Engineers, (ASCE), "Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and Other
Structures."
c. Arkansas Building
Authority, Minimum Standards and Criteria - Accessibility for the Physically
Disabled Standards.
d. National
Council on Radiation Protection (NCRP), Report No. 33, "Medical X-ray and Gamma
Ray Protection for Energies Up to 10 MeV Equipment Design and Use,
1986."
e. National Council on
Radiation Protection (NCRP), Report No. 49, "Medical X-ray and Gamma Ray
Protection for Energies up to 10 MeV Structural Shielding Design and
Evaluation, 1976."
f. National
Council on Radiation Protection (NCRP), Radiation Protection Design Guidelines
for 0.1pi 29100, MeV Particle Accelerator Facilities.
g. National Fire Protection Association 101,
"Life Safety Code, 2000 Edition". Note that "Mandatory References" are listed
in Chapter 2 of this document.
h.
Rules and Regulations Pertaining to the Management of Regulated Waste from
Health Care Related Facilities, Arkansas Department of Health.
3. Publications adopted in part
(only the sections specifically identified by these rules are applicable) by
these rules are as listed below:
a. American
Society of Heating, Refrigerating and Air Conditioning Engineers (ASHRAE),
"Handbook of Fundamentals" and "Handbook of Applications."
b. American Society of Heating, Refrigerating
and Air Conditioning Engineers (ASHRAE), Standard 52, "Method of Testing Air
Cleaning Devices Used in General Ventilation for Removing Particulate
Matter."
c. Illuminating
Engineering Society of North America, IESNA Publication CP29, "Lighting for
Health Care Facilities."
4. A partial list of other publications that
are applicable to the design and construction of healthcare facilities that are
not a part of these rules but may be enforced by other authorities having
jurisdiction is provided below:
a. Arkansas
State Fire Prevention Code Volumes I, II, and III (based on the 2000
International Building Code).
b.
Arkansas State Mechanical Code, Arkansas Department of Health.
c. Arkansas State Plumbing Code, Arkansas
Department of Health.
d. Arkansas
Boiler Code, Arkansas Department of Labor.
5. Publications that are not a part of these
rules but potentially helpful as reference material in the design and
construction of healthcare facilities are as listed below:
a. American Institute of Architects (AIA),
"Guidelines for Design and Construction of Hospital and Health Care Facilities
2001 Edition".
b. American Society
of Heating, Refrigeration, and Air Conditioning Engineers (ASHRAE), "HVAC
Design Manual for Hospitals and Clinics".
O. Availability of Codes and Standards.
Referenced publications can be ordered, if they are Government publications,
from the Superintendent of Documents, U.S. Government Printing Office (GPO),
Washington, DC 20402. Copies of non- government publications can be obtained at
the addresses listed below.
1. Air
Conditioning and Refrigeration Institute, 1501 Wilson Boulevard, Arlington, VA
22209.
2. American National
Standards Institute, 1430 Broadway, New York, NY 10018.
3. American Society of Civil Engineers, 345
East 47 10017 Street, New York, NY
4. American Society for Testing and
Materials, 1916 Race Street, Philadelphia, PA 19103.
5. American Society of Heating,
Refrigerating, and Air Conditioning, 1741 Tullie Circle, NE, Atlanta GA
30329.
6. Arkansas State Building
Services, 1515 West 7th Street, Suite 700, Little Rock, AR 72201.
7. Arkansas Department of Labor, 10421 West
Markham, Little Rock, AR 72205.
8.
Illuminating Engineering Society of North America (IESNA), 120 Wall Street,
17th Floor, New York, NY 10005.
9. National Council on Radiation Protection
and Measurement, 7910 Woodmont Avenue, Suite 1016, Bethesda, MD
20814.
10. National Fire Protection
Association, 1 Batterymarch Park, Post Office Box 9101, Quincy, MA
02269-9101.
11. International
Building Code Congress International, Inc., 900 Montclair Road, Birmingham, AL
35213.
P. Interpretations
of Requirements.
1. Memorandum of
Understanding: Conflicts between the Arkansas Fire Prevention Code and NFPA 101
Life Safety Code are to be resolved using the Memorandum of Understanding as
indicated below:
a. The Arkansas Fire
Prevention Code is the fire prevention code for the State of
Arkansas.
b. When the Arkansas
State Fire Prevention Code conflicts with the chapters of NFPA 101 Life Safety
Code governing new and existing health care and ambulatory health care
occupancies (Chapters 18, 19, 20, and 21), the provisions of the Life Safety
Code shall govern.
c. Requirements
found only in the Arkansas Fire Prevention Code (requirements not addressed by
NFPA 101) may be provided at the option of the facility (compliance with these
requirements is not mandatory).
2. Safety Improvement Plans: Nothing in these
rules shall be construed as restrictive to a facility that chooses to do work
as a part of a long-range safety improvement plan. These rules do not prohibit
a single phase of improvement. All hazards to life and safety all areas of
noncompliance should be corrected as soon as possible.
3. Provisions in Excess of Regulatory
Requirements: Nothing in these rules shall be construed to prohibit a better
type of building construction, an additional means of egress, or an otherwise
safer condition than that specified by the minimum requirements of these
rules.
4. Equivalency:
a. Insofar as practical, these minimum
standards have been established to obtain a desired performance result.
Prescriptive limitations, when given, such as exact minimum dimensions or
quantities, describe a condition that is recognized as a practical standard for
normal operation.
b. It is the
intent of these rules to permit and promote equivalency concepts. Nothing in
these rules shall be construed as restricting innovations that provide an
equivalent level of performance with these rules in a manner other than that
which is prescribed by these rules, provided that no other safety element or
system is compromised in order to establish equivalency.
c. Health Facility Services may approve
alternate methods, procedures, design criteria, and functional variations from
these rules, because of extraordinary circumstances, new programs, new
technology, or unusual conditions when the facility can effectively demonstrate
that the intent of the rules is met and that the variation does not reduce the
safety or operational effectiveness of the facility below that required by the
exact language of the rules.
d.
When contemplating equivalency allowances, Health Facility Services may use a
variety of expert sources to make equivalency findings. Health Facility
Services will document the reasons for approval or denial of equivalency to the
facility.
e. National Fire
Protection Association (NFPA) document 101A is a technical standard for
evaluating equivalency to certain Life Safety Code 101 requirements. The Fire
Safety Evaluation System (FSES) is a widely recognized method for establishing
a safety level equivalent to the Life Safety Code. The use of the FSES process
may be useful for evaluating existing facilities that will be affected by
renovation.
SECTION 44
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
PATIENT ACCOMMODATIONS (ADULT MEDICAL, SURGICAL, COMMUNICABLE OR PULMONARY
DISEASE).
NOTE: See other sections of this document for Special-Care area
units such as Post anesthesia Care Unit, Critical Care Units, Rehabilitation
Units, Pediatric Units, Postpartum Care Units and/or other specialty
units.
A. Patient Rooms. Each patient
room shall meet the following requirements.
1.
Maximum room capacity shall be two patients.
2. In new construction, patient rooms shall
have a minimum of 100 square feet of clear floor area per bed in semi-private
rooms and 120 square feet of clear floor are for single-bed rooms, exclusive of
toilet rooms, closets, lockers, wardrobes, alcoves or vestibules. The
dimensions and arrangement of rooms shall be such that there is a minimum of
three feet between the sides and foot of the bed and any wall, other fixed
obstruction or another bed. In semiprivate bed rooms, a clearance of four feet
shall be available at the foot of each bed to permit the passage of equipment
and beds. Minor encroachments, including columns and lavatories, that do not
interfere with functions may be ignored when determining space requirements for
patient rooms. Where renovation work is undertaken, every effort shall be made
to meet the above minimum standards.
3. Each patient room shall have a window with
outside exposure and where the operation of windows or vents requires the use
of tools or keys, such devices shall be on the same floor and easily accessible
to staff. The windowsills shall not be higher than three feet above the floor
and shall be above the grade. Patient rooms in new construction intended for 24
hour occupancy shall have windows. If operable windows are installed, such
devices shall be permanently secured or restricted to inhibit possible escape
or suicide.
4. Nurse patient
communication station shall be provided in accordance with item G. of Section
72, Physical Facilities, Electrical Standards.
5. Hand washing stations shall be provided to
serve each patient room. These hand washing stations shall be located in the
toilet room.
6. Each patient shall
have access to a toilet room without having to enter the general corridor area.
One toilet room shall serve no more than four patient beds and no more than two
patient rooms. In new construction, an additional hand washing station or
sanitizing station shall be placed in the patient room where the toilet room
serves more than one bed. The toilet room shall contain a water closet and a
hand washing station and the door shall swing outward or be double
acting.
7. Each patient shall have
within the room a separate wardrobe or closet that is suitable for hanging full
length garments and for storing personal items.
8. Visual privacy from casual observation by
other patients and visitors shall be provided for each patient in semi-private
rooms with cubicle curtains or equivalent built-in or movable dividers.
Provisions for privacy is not required within psychiatric or alcohol and drug
units. The method for providing privacy shall not obstruct passage of other
patients either to the entrance, toilet or lavatory. All curtains shall have a
flame spread of 0 to 25 and shall comply with NFPA 13 requirements for clear
space below sprinklers.
9. Each
room shall communicate directly with a corridor without passage through another
patient's room.
10. Rooms existing
partially below grade level shall not be used for patients unless they are dry,
well ventilated and are otherwise suitable for occupancy.
11. Beds shall be arranged to provide
adequate room for all patient care procedures and to prevent the transmission
of infections.
12. Individual
approved hospital type beds shall be provided. Bed rails shall be provided on
beds for children.
13. A reading
light shall be provided for each patient bed. The location and design shall be
such that the light is not annoying to other patients.
14. A bedside table with drawer shall be
provided for each bed. The lower portion of the table and/or enclosed shelves
shall be provided for individual nursing care equipment.
B. Service Areas. Each service area may be
arranged and located to serve more than one nursing unit but at least one such
service area shall be provided on each nursing floor. Some of the service areas
may be combined in a single space. The following service areas shall be located
in or readily available to each nursing unit:
1. Nursing Station. Facilities for charting,
clinical records, work counter, communication system, space for supplies and
convenient access to hand washing stations shall be provided. It may be
combined with or include centers for reception and communication.
2. Dictation area shall be provided. This
area shall be adjacent to but separate from the nurses' station;
3. Toilet room(s) for staff convenient to
nurses' station (may be unisex).
4.
Lounge facilities for staff. These facilities may be on another
floor.
5. Individual closets or
compartments for the safekeeping of coats and personal effects of nursing
personnel. These shall be located convenient to the nurses' station of
personnel or in a central location;
6. Multi-purpose room(s) for staff, patients,
patients' families for patient conferences, reports, education, training
sessions, and consultation. The rooms shall be accessible to each nursing unit.
One such room may serve several nursing units and/or departments.
7. Examination/treatment room(s). Such rooms
may be omitted if all patient rooms are single-bed rooms. It shall have a
minimum floor area of 120 square feet excluding space for vestibule, toilet,
closets, and work counters (whether fixed or movable). Centrally located
examination and treatment room(s) may serve more than one nursing unit on the
same floor. The room shall contain a lavatory or sink equipped for handwashing,
work counter, storage facilities, and a desk, counter or shelf space for
writing. The emergency treatment room may be used for this purpose if it is
conveniently located to the patient rooms.
8. Clean workroom or clean supply room. If
the room is used for preparing patient care items, it shall contain a work
counter, a handwashing fixture and storage facilities for clean and sterile
supplies. If the room is used only for storage and holding as part of a system
for distribution of clean and sterile materials, the work counter and
handwashing fixture may be omitted. Soiled and clean workrooms or holding rooms
shall be separated and have no direct connection.
9. Soiled workroom or soiled holding room.
This room shall be separate from the clean workroom. The soiled workroom shall
contain a clinical sink (or equivalent flushing-rim fixture). The room shall
contain a lavatory (or handwashing fixture). The above fixtures shall both have
a hot and cold mixing faucet. The room shall have a work counter and space for
separate covered containers for soiled linen and waste. Rooms used only for
temporary holding of soiled material may omit the clinical sink and work
counter. If the flushing-rim clinical sink is eliminated, facilities for
cleaning bedpans shall be provided elsewhere.
10. Medication Station. Provisions shall be
made for distribution of medications. This may be done from a medicine
preparation room or unit, from a selfcontained medicine dispensing unit, or by
another approved system
a. Medicine
preparation room. This room shall be designed to allow for visual supervision
by the nursing staff. It shall contain a work counter, a sink adequate for
handwashing, refrigerator, and locked storage for controlled drugs. When a
medicine preparation room is to be used to store one or more self-contained
medicine dispensing units, the room shall be designed with adequate space to
prepare medicines with the self-contained medicine dispensing unit(s)
present.
b. Self-contained medicine
dispensing unit. A self-contained medicine dispensing unit may be located at
the nurses' station, in the clean workroom, or in an alcove, provided the unit
has adequate security for controlled drugs and adequate lighting to easily
identify drugs. Convenient access to handwashing stations shall be provided.
(Standard cup-sinks provided in many self- contained units are not adequate for
handwashing.)
11. Clean
Linen Storage. A separate closet or a designated area within the clean workroom
shall be provided. If a closed cart system is used, storage may be in an
alcove. Carts shall be out of the path of traffic.
12. Nourishment Station. This shall contain a
sink equipped for handwashing, equipment for serving nourishment between
scheduled and unscheduled meals, refrigerator, storage cabinets, and ice maker
units to provide ice for patients' service and treatment. Ice for human
consumption shall be from selfdispensing units. Handwashing stations shall be
in or immediately accessible to the nourishment station;
13. Equipment Storage Room. This shall be for
equipment such as I.V. stands, inhalators, air mattresses, and
walkers;
14. Parking for stretchers
and wheelchairs. This shall be located out of path of normal traffic;
15. Showers and bathtubs. When individual
bathing facilities are not provided in patient rooms, there shall be at least
one shower and/or bathtub for each 12 beds without such facilities. Each
bathtub or shower shall be in an Individual room or enclosure that provides
privacy for bathing, drying, and dressing. Special bathing facilities,
including space for attendant, shall be provided for patients on stretchers,
carts, and wheelchairs at the ratio of one per 100 beds or a fraction thereof.
This may be on a separate floor if convenient for use.
16. Emergency Equipment Storage. Space for
emergency equipment such as a "crash cart" shall be provided and shall be under
control of the nursing staff;
17.
Environmental Services Closet. See Section 65, Physical Facilities, Cleaning
and Sanitizing Carts and Environmental Services, for detailed
requirements.
C. Airborne
Infection Isolation Room(s). Rooms for patients who are suffering from
infections shall be provided at the rate of 1 for each 30 beds or fraction
thereof. These may be located within each nursing unit or placed together in a
separate unit. See also Section 32, Physical Facilities, Critical Care Unit for
the requirements of Critical Care Units. Psychiatric and Alcohol/Drug Unit(s)
beds need not be included in the bed count ratio to establish the number of
rooms. Each isolation room shall be a single-bed room and planned as required
for a normal patient room except as follows:
1. Each airborne infection isolation room
shall have an anteroom for handwashing, gowning, and storage of clean and
soiled materials located directly outside the entry door to the patient
room.
2. Airborne infection
isolation room perimeter walls, ceiling, and floors, including penetrations,
shall be sealed tightly so that air does not infiltrate the environment from
the outside or from other spaces.
3. Airborne infection isolation room(s) shall
have self-closing devices on all room exit doors
4. Separate toilet, bathtub (or shower) and
handwashing stations are required for each airborne infection isolation
room.
5. Airborne infection
isolation rooms may be used for noninfectious patients when not needed for
patients with airborne infectious disease.
6. Windows shall not be operable without the
use of a key or tool controlled by the nursing staff.
7. Each room shall have a permanently
installed visual mechanism to constantly monitor the pressure status of the
room when occupied by patients with an airborne infectious disease.
D. Protective Isolation Rooms. In
facilities where procedures such as organ transplants, burn therapy, and
immunosuppressive treatments are performed, special design provisions,
including special ventilation, may be necessary to meet the needs of the
functional program. Refer to Table 4 of the Appendix for air pressure and
ventilation. Each protective isolation room shall be a single-bed room and
planned as required for a normal patient room except as follows:
1. Each protective isolation room shall have
an anteroom for handwashing, gowning, and storage of clean and soiled materials
located directly outside the entry door to the patient room.
2. Protective isolation room perimeter walls,
ceiling, and floors, including penetrations, shall be sealed tightly so that
air does not infiltrate the environment from the outside or from other
spaces.
3. Protective isolation
room(s) shall have self-closing devices on all room exit doors.
4. Separate toilet, bathtub (or shower), and
handwashing stations are required for each protective isolation room.
5. Protective isolation rooms may be used for
nonimmunosuppressed patients, except airborne infectious patients are
prohibited.
6. Windows shall not be
operable without the use of a key or tool controlled by the nursing
staff.
E. Seclusion
Rooms. Each hospital shall provide one or more single-bed rooms for patients
needing close supervision if suitable psychiatric facilities are not available
elsewhere in the community. Such rooms shall comply with the applicable
requirements in Section 48, Physical Facilities, Psychiatric Nursing
Unit.
F. Observation Rooms.
Patients in observation status may be accommodated within the facility:
1. In private, semi-private or multi-patient
rooms. Furniture shall be arranged to provide adequate room for patient care
procedures and to prevent the transmission of infection;
2. Cubicle curtains, privacy screens or an
approved equivalent shall be provided for patient privacy in all multi-patient
rooms. The utilization of such curtains or screens shall be such that each
patient shall have privacy;
3. Each
room or cubicle shall be provided with (a) oxygen; (b) vacuum; and (c) a nurse
call button unless direct observation is afforded and maintained;
4. Hand hygiene facilities shall be available
within the area;
5. Hospital grade
furniture shall be provided. Bed rails shall be provided on beds;
6. For each area in which a patient bed is
utilized, a reading light shall be provided for each bed. The location and
design shall be such that the light is not annoying to other
patients;
7. Patient toilets shall
be provided and accessible to all patients; and
8. Adequate space shall be provided for
medical supplies.
SECTION
45
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, CRITICAL CARE UNIT.
The Critical care units require special space and equipment
considerations for effective staff functions. In addition, space arrangement
shall include provisions for immediate access of emergency equipment from other
departments. Critical care units shall comply in size, number and type with
these standards and with the functional program. The following standards are
intended for the more common types of critical care services and shall be
appropriate to needs defined in functional programs. Where specialized services
are required, additions and/or modifications shall be made as necessary for
efficient, safe, and effective patient care.
A. Critical Care (General). The following
shall apply to all types of critical care units unless otherwise noted. Each
unit shall comply with the following provisions:
1. The location shall offer direct access by
the emergency, respiratory care, laboratory, radiology, surgery, and other
essential departments and services as defined by the functional program. It
shall be located so that the medical emergency resuscitation teams may be able
to respond promptly to emergency calls within minimum travel time. The location
shall be arranged to eliminate the need for through traffic.
2. In new construction, where elevator
transport is required for critically ill patients, the size of the cab and
mechanisms and controls shall meet the specialized needs.
3. In new construction, each patient room (or
multiple bed space for neonatal or pediatric units) shall have a minimum of 200
square feet of clear floor area with a minimum headwall width of 113 feet per
bed, exclusive of anterooms, vestibules, toilet rooms, closets, lockers,
wardrobes, and/or alcoves. In renovation of existing critical care units, every
effort shall be made to meet the above minimum standards. If it is not possible
to meet the above square foot standards, the Entity having jurisdiction may
grant approval to deviate from this requirement. In such cases, rooms shall be
no less than 130square feet.
4.
View panels to the corridor shall be required and shall have means to provide
visual privacy. Where only one door is provided to a bed space, it shall be at
least four feet wide and arranged to minimize interference with movement of
beds and large equipment. Sliding doors shall not have floor tracks and shall
have hardware that minimizes jamming possibilities. Where sliding doors are
used for access to cubicles within a suite, a three-foot-wide swinging door may
also be provided for personnel communication. The sliding doors shall swing
out.
5. Each patient bed area shall
have space at each bedside for visitors and provisions for visual privacy from
casual observation by other patients and visitors. For both adult and pediatric
units, there shall be a minimum of eight feet between beds.
6. Each patient bed shall have visual access,
other than skylights, to the outside environment with not less than one outside
window in each patient bed area. In renovation projects, clerestory windows
with windowsills above the heights of adjacent ceilings may be used, provided
they afford patients a view of the exterior and are equipped with appropriate
forms of glare and sun control.
Distance from the patient bed to the outside window shall not
exceed 50 feet. When partitioned cubicles are used, patients' view to outside
windows may be through no more than two separate clear vision panels.
7. Nurse/patient communication
shall be provided in accordance with item G. of Section72, Physical Facilities,
Electrical Standards. The communication station for the unit shall include
provisions for an emergency code resuscitation alarm to summon assistance from
outside the critical care unit.
8.
Handwashing fixtures shall be convenient to nurse stations and patient bed
areas. There shall be at least one handwashing fixture for every three beds in
open plan areas, and one in each patient room. The handwashing fixture or
sanitizing station shall be located near the entrance to the patient cubicle or
room, shall be sized to minimize splashing water onto the floor, and shall be
equipped with hands-free operable controls.
9. Nurses' station shall have space for
counters and storage. It may be combined with or include centers for reception
and communication. There shall be direct or remote visual observation between
the nurses' station and all patient beds in the critical care unit.
10. Each unit shall contain equipment for
continuous monitoring, with visual displays for each patient at the bedside and
at the nurses' station. Monitors shall be located to permit easy viewing and
access but not interfere with access to the patient.
11. Emergency equipment storage space that is
easily accessible to the staff shall be provided for emergency equipment such
as an emergency cart.
12.
Medication Station. Provisions shall be made for distribution of medications.
This may be done from a medicine preparation room or unit, from a self-
contained medicine dispensing unit, or by another approved system:
a. Medicine preparation room. This room shall
be designed to allow for visual supervision by the nursing staff. It shall
contain a work counter, a sink adequate for handwashing, refrigerator, and
locked storage for controlled drugs. When a medicine preparation room is to be
used to store one or more self-contained medicine dispensing units, the room
shall be designed with adequate space to prepare medicines with the
selfcontained medicine dispensing unit(s) present.
b. Self-contained medicine dispensing unit. A
self-contained medicine dispensing unit may be located at the nurses' station,
in the clean workroom, or in an alcove, provided the unit has adequate security
for controlled drugs and adequate lighting to easily identify drugs. Convenient
access to handwashing stations shall be provided. (Standard cup-sinks provided
in many self-contained units are not adequate for handwashing.)
13. At least one airborne
infection isolation room with anteroom shall be provided. The number of
airborne infection isolation rooms shall be determined based on an infection
control risk assessment; as per the primary catchment area by the facility.
Each room shall contain only one bed and shall comply with the requirements of
item C. of Section 44, Physical Facilities, Patient Accommodations (Adult
Medical, Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary Disease). However, the requirement
for the bathtub (or shower) may be eliminated. Compact, modular toilet/sink
combination units may replace the requirement for a "toilet room." Special
ventilation requirements are found in Table 4.
14. The following additional service spaces
shall be immediately available within each critical care area (Note: These
additional spaces may be shared by more than one critical care unit provided
that direct access is available from each unit.):
a. Securable closets or cabinet compartments
for the unit personnel;
b. Clean
workroom or clean supply room. If the room is used for preparing patient care
items, it shall contain a work counter, a handwashing fixture and storage
facilities for clean and sterile supplies. If the room is used only for storage
and holding as part of a system for distribution of clean and sterile supply
materials, the work counter and handwashing fixture may be omitted. Soiled and
clean workrooms or holding rooms shall be separated and have no direct
connection;
c. Clean linen storage.
There shall be a designated area for clean linen storage. This may be within
the clean workroom, a separate closet or an approved distribution system on
each floor. If a closed cart system is used, storage may be in an alcove. It
shall be out of the path of normal traffic and under staff control;
d. Soiled workroom or soiled holding room.
This room shall be separate from the clean workroom. The soiled workroom shall
contain a clinical sink or equivalent flushing-rim fixture. The room shall
contain a lavatory or handwashing fixture. The above fixtures shall have a hot
and cold mixing faucet. The room shall have a work counter and space for
separate covered containers for soiled linen and a variety of waste types.
Rooms used only for temporary holding of soiled material may omit the clinical
sink and work counter. If the flushing-rim clinical sink is eliminated,
facilities for cleaning bedpans shall be provided elsewhere;
e. Nourishment Station. There shall be a
nourishment station with sink, work counter, refrigerator, storage cabinets,
and equipment for hot and cold nourishments between scheduled meals. The
nourishment station shall include space for trays and dishes used for
nonscheduled meal service. Provisions and space shall be included for separate
temporary storage of unused and soiled dietary trays not picked up at meal
time. Handwashing stations shall be in or immediately accessible from the
nourishment station;
f. Ice
machine. There shall be available equipment to provide ice for treatments and
nourishment. Ice-making equipment may be in the clean work room or at the
nourishment station. Ice intended for human consumption shall be from
self-dispensing ice makers;
g.
Equipment storage room or alcove. Appropriate room(s) or alcove(s) shall be
provided for storage of large items of equipment necessary for patient care and
as required by the functional program. Its location shall not interfere with
the flow of traffic; and h. X-ray viewing equipment.
15. The following shall be provided and may
be located outside the unit if conveniently accessible.
a. A visitors' waiting room shall be provided
with access to telephones and toilets. One waiting room may serve several
critical care units.
b. Staff
lounge(s) and toilet(s) shall be located so that staff may be recalled quickly
to the patient area in emergencies. The lounge shall have telephone or intercom
and emergency code alarm connections to the critical care unit it serves. One
lounge may serve adjacent critical care areas.
c. A special procedures room shall be
provided if required by the functional program.
d. Multipurpose room(s) for staff, patients,
and patients' families for patient conferences, reports, education, training
sessions, and consultation shall be provided. These rooms shall be accessible
to each nursing unit.
e. A
housekeeping room shall be provided within or immediately adjacent to the
critical care unit. It shall not be shared with other nursing units or
departments. It shall contain a service sink or floor receptor and provisions
for storage of supplies and housekeeping equipment.
f. Storage space for stretchers and
wheelchairs shall be provided in a strategic location, without restricting
normal traffic.
g. Laboratory,
radiology, respiratory care, and pharmacy services shall be available. These
services may be provided from the central departments or from satellite
facilities as required by the functional program.
B. Coronary Critical Care Unit. In
addition to the standards set forth in Section 45, Physical Facilities,
Critical Care Unit, the following standards apply to the coronary critical care
unit:
1. Each coronary patient shall have a
separate room for acoustical and visual privacy.
2. Each coronary patient shall have access to
a toilet in the room. (Portable commodes may be used in lieu of individual
toilets, but provisions shall be made for their storage, servicing, and odor
control.)
C. Pediatric
Critical Care. If a facility has a specific pediatric critical care unit, the
functional program shall include consideration for staffing, isolation, and the
safe transportation of critically ill pediatric patients, along with life
support and environmental systems, from other areas. In addition to the
standards previously listed for critical care units, each pediatric critical
care unit shall include:
1. Space at each
bedside for family, visitors and nursing staff;
2. In new construction, each patient space
(whether separate rooms, cubicles, or multiple bed space) shall have a minimum
of 200 square feet of clear floor area with a minimum headwall width of 13 feet
per bed, exclusive of anterooms, vestibules, toilet rooms, closets, lockers,
wardrobes, and/or alcoves;
3.
Consultation/demonstration room within, or convenient to, the pediatric
critical care unit for private discussions;
4. Provisions for formula storage. These may
be outside the pediatric critical care unit but shall be available for use at
all times;
5. Separate storage
cabinets or closets for toys and games for use by the pediatric patients;
and
6. Examination and treatment
room(s).
D. Newborn
Intensive Care Units. Each Newborn Intensive Care Unit (NICU) shall include or
comply with the following:
1. The NICU shall
have a clearly identified entrance and reception area for families. The area
shall permit visual observation and contact with all traffic entering the unit.
A scrub area shall be provided at each public entrance to the patient care
area(s) of the NICU. All sinks shall be hands-free operable and large enough to
contain splashing;
2. At least one
door (44inches minimum) to each room in the unit to accommodate portable X-ray
equipment;
3. There shall be
controlled access systems to the unit from the Labor and Delivery area, the
Emergency Room or other referral entry points;
4. When viewing windows are provided,
provision shall be made to control casual viewing of infants;
5. Noise control shall be a design
factor;
6. Provisions shall be made
for indirect lighting in all nurseries. Provisions shall be made for multiple
lighting levels;
7. A central area
shall serve as a nurses' station, shall have space for counters and storage,
and shall have convenient access to handwashing stations. It may be combined
with or include centers for reception and communication and patient
monitoring;
8. Each patient care
space shall contain a minimum of 120 square feet per bassinette excluding sinks
and aisles. There shall be an aisle for circulation adjacent to each patient
care space with a minimum width of three feet;
9. An airborne infection isolation room is
required in at least one level of nursery care. The room shall be enclosed and
separated from the nursery unit with provisions for observation of the infant
from adjacent nurseries or control area(s);
10. Blood gas lab facilities shall be
immediately accessible;
11. A
respiratory care work area and storage room shall be provided;
12. A consultation/demonstration/breast
feeding room shall be provided convenient to the unit;
13. Charting and dictation space for
physicians shall be provided;
14.
Medication station shall be provided;
15. Clean workroom or clean supply room shall
be provided. See Section 44.B.8, Physical Facilities, Patient Accommodations
(Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary Disease);
16. Soiled workroom or soiled holding room
shall be provided. See Section 44.B.9, Physical Facilities, Patient
Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary
Disease);
17. A lounge, locker room
and staff toilet within or adjacent to the unit suite for staff use shall be
provided;
18. Space shall be
provided for emergency equipment that is under direct control of the nursing
staff, such as a emergency cart. This space shall be located in an area
appropriate to the functional program, but out of normal traffic;
19. One environmental services closet shall
be provided for the unit. It shall be directly accessible from the unit and be
dedicated for the exclusive use of the neonatal critical care unit. It shall
contain a service sink or floor receptor and provisions for storage of supplies
and housekeeping equipment; and
20.
Space shall be provided for the following:
a.
A visitors' waiting room;
b.
Nurses' station; and
c.
Multipurpose room(s) for staff, patients and patients' families for patient
conferences, reports, education, training sessions, and consultation. These
rooms shall be accessible to each nursing unit. They may be on other floors if
convenient for regular use. One such room may serve several nursing units
and/or departments.
SECTION 46
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
NURSERY UNITS.
Normal newborn infants shall be housed in nurseries that comply
with the standards below. All nurseries other than pediatric nurseries shall be
convenient to the postpartum nursing unit and obstetrical facilities. The
nurseries shall be located and arranged to preclude the need for nonrelated
pedestrian traffic. No nursery shall open directly into another nursery. There
should be one breastfeeding/pumping room readily available for mothers of NICU
babies to pump breastmilk.
A. General.
Each nursery shall contain the following:
1.
At least one lavatory, equipped with hands-free handwashing station, for each
eight infant stations;
2. Glazed
observation windows to permit the viewing of infants from public areas,
workrooms, and adjacent nurseries;
3. Convenient, accessible storage for linens
and infant supplies at each nursery room;
4. A consultation/demonstration/breast
feeding or pump room shall be provided convenient to the nursery. Provision
shall be made, either within the room or conveniently located nearby, for sink,
counter, refrigeration and freezing, storage for pump and attachments, and
educational materials. The area provided for the unit for these purposes, when
conveniently located, may be shared;
5. Enough space shall be provided for parents
to stay 24hours;
6. An airborne
infection isolation room is required in or near at least one level of nursery
care. The room shall be enclosed and separated from the nursery unit with
provisions for observation of the infant from adjacent nurseries or control
area(s). All airborne infection isolation rooms shall comply with the
requirements of Section 44.C, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical,
Communicable or Pulmonary Disease), except for separate toilet, bathtub, or
shower;
7. Workroom(s). Each
nursery room shall be served by a connecting workroom. The workroom shall
contain scrubbing and gowning facilities at the entrance for staff and
housekeeping personnel, work counter, refrigerator, storage for supplies and a
hands-free handwashing fixture. One workroom may serve more than one nursery
room provided that required services are convenient to each. The workroom
serving the full- term and continuing care nurseries may be omitted if
equivalent work and storage areas and facilities, including those for scrubbing
and gowning, are provided within that nursery. Space required for work areas
located within the nursery is in addition to the area required for infant care.
Adequate provision shall be made for storage of emergency cart(s) and equipment
out of traffic and for the sanitary storage and disposal of soiled waste.
a. When the functional program includes a
mother-baby couplet approach to nursing care, the workroom functions described
above may be incorporated in the nurse station that serves the postpartum
patient rooms.
b. Neonate
examination and treatment areas. Such areas, when required by the functional
program, shall contain a work counter, storage facilities and a hands-free
handwashing station.
c. Neonate
formula facilities. Where infant formula is prepared on-site, direct access
from the formula preparation room to any nursery room is prohibited. The room
may be located near the nursery or at other appropriate locations in the
hospital, but shall include
1) Cleanup
facilities for washing and sterilizing supplies. This area shall include a
handwashing station, facilities for bottle washing, a work counter and
sterilization equipment.
2)
Separate room for preparing infant formula. This room shall contain warming
facilities, refrigerator, work counter, formula sterilizer, storage facilities
and a handwashing station.
3)
Refrigerated storage and warming facilities for infant formula accessible for
use by nursery personnel at all times.
8. Commercial neonate formula. If a
commercial infant formula is used, the separate cleanup and preparation rooms
may be omitted. The storage and handling may be done in the nursery workroom or
in another appropriate room in the hospital that is conveniently accessible at
all hours. The preparation area shall have a work counter, a handwashing
station and storage facilities.
9.
Housekeeping/environmental services room. A housekeeping/environmental services
room shall be provided for the exclusive use of the nursery unit. It shall be
directly accessible from the unit and shall contain a service sink or floor
receptor and provide for storage of supplies and housekeeping
equipment.
10. Charting space.
Charting facilities shall have linear surface space to ensure that staff and
physicians may chart and have simultaneous access to information and
communication systems.
B.
Newborn Nursery
1. Each newborn nursery room
shall contain no more than 16stations. The minimum floor areas shall be 24
square feet per bassinet, exclusive of auxiliary work areas. When a rooming-in
program is used, the total number of bassinets provided in these units may be
appropriately reduced, but the newborn nursery shall not be omitted in its
entirety from any facility that includes delivery services. (When facilities
use a rooming-in program in which all infants are returned to the nursery at
night, a reduction in nursery size may not be practical.)
2. Baby holding nurseries may replace
traditional nurseries with baby holding nurseries in postpartum and
labor-delivery- recovery-postpartum (LDRP) units. The minimum floor area per
bassinet, ventilation, electrical, and medical vacuum and gases shall be the
same as that required for a full- term nursery. These holding nurseries should
be next to the nurse station on these units. The holding nursery shall be sized
to accommodate the percentage of newborns who do not remain with their mothers
during the postpartum stay.
C. Continuing Care Nursery For hospitals that
provide continuing care for infants requiring close observation (for example,
low birth-weight babies who are not ill but require more hours of nursing than
do normal neonates), the minimum floor space- shall be 50 square feet per
bassinet, exclusive of auxiliary work areas, with provisions for at least 4
feet between and at all sides of each bassinet.
D. Pediatric Nursery To minimize the
possibility of cross infection, each nursery room serving pediatric patients
shall contain no more than eight bassinets; each bassinet shall have a minimum
clear floor area of 40 square feet. Each room shall contain a lavatory equipped
for hands-free handwashing, a nurse's emergency calling system and a glazed
viewing window for observing infants from public areas and workrooms.
(Limitation on number of patients in a nursery room does not apply to the
pediatric critical care unit.)
SECTION
47
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, PEDIATRIC AND ADOLESCENT
UNIT.
The unit shall meet the following standards:
A. Patient Rooms. Each patient room shall
meet the following standards:
1. Maximum room
capacity shall be four patients.
2.
The space requirements for pediatric patient beds shall be the same as for
adult beds due to the size variation and the need to change from cribs to beds
and vice-versa. See Section 44, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical,
Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary Disease), for requirements. Additional
provisions for hygiene, toilets, sleeping, and personal belongings shall be
included where the program indicates that parents will be allowed to remain
with young children. See Sections 45, Physical Facilities, Critical Care Unit
and 46, Physical Facilities, Newborn Nursery Units for pediatric critical care
units and for newborn nurseries.
3.
Each patient room shall have a window in accordance with Section 44, Physical
Facilities, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or
Pulmonary Disease).
B.
Examination/Treatment Rooms. This room shall be provided for pediatric and
adolescent patients. A separate area for infant examination and treatment may
be provided within the pediatric nursery workroom. Examination/treatment rooms
shall have a minimum floor area of 120square feet. The room shall contain a
handwashing fixture; storage facilities; and a desk, counter, or shelf space
for writing. This room is not required if all rooms are private.
1. Multipurpose or individual room(s) shall
be provided within or adjacent to areas serving pediatric and adolescent
patients for dining, education and developmentally appropriate play and
recreation, with access and equipment for patients with physical restrictions.
If the functional program requires, an individual room shall be provided to
allow for confidential parent/family comfort, consultation, and teaching.
Insulation, isolation and structural provisions shall minimize the transmission
of impact noise through the floor, walls or ceiling of these multipurpose
room(s).
2. Space for preparation
and storage of infant formula shall be provided within the unit or other
convenient location. Provisions shall be made for continuation of special
formula that may have been prescribed for the infant prior to admission or
readmission.
3. Patient toilet
room(s) with handwashing stations in each room, in addition to those serving
bed areas, shall be conveniently located to multipurpose room(s) and to each
central bathing facility.
4.
Storage closets or cabinets for toys and educational and recreational equipment
shall be provided.
5. Storage space
shall be provided to permit exchange of cribs and adult beds. Provisions shall
also be made for storage of equipment and supplies (including cots or
recliners, extra linen, etc.) for parents who stay with the patient
overnight.
6. A least one airborne
infection isolation room shall be provided in each pediatric unit. The total
number of infection isolation rooms shall be determined by an infection
prevention and control risk assessment. Airborne infection isolation room(s)
shall comply with the requirements of item C. of Section 44, Physical
Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary
Disease).
7. Separate clean and
soiled workrooms or holding rooms shall be provided as described in Section 44
B.8 and B.9, Physical Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or
Pulmonary Disease).
SECTION
48
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, PSYCHIATRIC NURSING UNIT.
When part of a general hospital, these units shall be designed
for the care of inpatients. Nonambulatory inpatients may be treated in a
medical unit until their medical condition allows for transfer to the
psychiatric nursing unit. Provisions shall be made in the design for adapting
the area for various types of psychiatric therapies.
The environment of the unit should be characterized by a
feeling of openness with emphasis on natural light and exterior views. Various
functions should be accessible from common areas while not compromising
desirable levels of patient privacy. Interior finishes, lighting and
furnishings should suggest a residential rather than an institutional setting.
These should, however, conform with applicable fire safety codes. Security and
safety devices should not be presented in a manner to attract or challenge
tampering by patients.
Where glass fragments pose a hazard to certain patients, safety
glazing and/or other appropriate security features shall be used.
Details of such facilities should be as described in the
approved functional program. Each nursing unit shall provide the
following:
A. Patient Rooms. The
patient room requirements noted in Section 44, Physical Accommodations (Adult
Medical, Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary Disease), shall be applied to
patient rooms in psychiatric nursing units except as follows:
1. A nurses' call system is not required; but
if it is included, provisions shall be made for easy removal or for covering
call button outlets;
2.
Bedpan-flushing devices shall be omitted from patient room toilets;
3. Handwashing stations are not required in
patient rooms;
4. Visual privacy in
multibed rooms (e.g., cubicle curtains) is not required;
5. The ceiling and the air distribution
devices, lighting fixtures, sprinkler heads, and other appurtenances shall be
of a tamper-resistant type;
6. Each
patient room shall be provided with a private toilet that meets the following
requirements:
a. The door shall not be
lockable from within;
b. The door
shall be capable of swinging outward; and
c. The ceiling shall be of tamper-resistant
construction and the air distribution devices, lighting fixtures, sprinkler
heads and other appurtenances shall be of the tamper-resistant type.
7. Patient rooms, exclusive of
toilet rooms, closets, lockers, wardrobes, alcoves, or vestibules, shall be at
least 100 square feet for single-bed rooms and 80 square feet per bed for
multiple-beds rooms. The dimensions and room arrangement criteria of Section 44
does not apply.
B.
Service Areas. The standards noted in Section 44, Physical Accommodations
(Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or Pulmonary Disease), shall apply to
services areas for psychiatric nursing units with the following modifications:
1. A secured storage area shall be provided
for patients' belongings that are determined to be potentially harmful (e.g.,
razors, nail files, cigarette lighters); this area shall be controlled by
staff.;
2. Medication station shall
include provisions for security against unauthorized access;
3. Food service within the unit may be one,
or a combination, of the following:
a. A
nourishment station;
b. A
kitchenette designed for patient use with staff control of heating and cooking
devices; and
4. Storage
space for stretchers and wheelchairs may be outside the psychiatric unit,
provided that provisions are made for convenient access as needed for disabled
patients;
5. In psychiatric nursing
units, a bathtub or shower shall be provided for each six beds not otherwise
served by bathing facilities within the patient rooms. Bathing facilities shall
be designed and located for patient convenience and privacy;
6. A separate charting area shall be provided
with provisions for acoustical privacy. A viewing window to permit observation
of patient areas by the charting nurse or physician may be used if the
arrangement is such that patient files cannot be read from outside the charting
space;
7. At least two separate
social spaces, one appropriate for noisy activities and one for quiet
activities shall be provided. The combined area shall be a minimum of 40 square
feet per patient with a minimum of 120 square feet for each of the two spaces.
This space may be shared by dining activities;
8. Space for group therapy shall be provided.
This may be combined with the quiet space noted above in item 7 when the unit
accommodates not more than 12 patients, and when at least 225 square feet of
enclosed private space is available for group therapy activities;
9. Patient laundry facilities with an
automatic washer and dryer shall be provided. The following elements shall also
be provided, but may be either within the psychiatric unit or immediately
accessible to it unless otherwise dictated by the functional program;
10. Rooms (s) for examination and treatment
shall have a minimum floor area of 120 square feet. Examination and treatment
room(s) for medical-surgical patients may be shared by the psychiatric unit
patients. (These may be on a different floor if conveniently
accessible.)
11. Separate
consultation room(s) with minimum floor space of 100 square feet each, provided
at a room-to-bed ratio of one consultation room for each 12 psychiatric beds.
The room(s) shall be designed for acoustical and visual privacy and constructed
to achieve a noise reduction of at least 45 decibels. This room is not required
if all rooms are private;
12.
Psychiatric units each containing 15 square feet of separate space per patient
for patient therapy/multipurpose use, with a minimum total area of at least 200
square feet, whichever is greater. Space shall include provision for
handwashing, work counter(s), storage, and displays. This space may serve more
than one nursing unit. When psychiatric nursing unit(s) contain less than 12
beds, the therapy and other functions may be performed within the noisy
activities area, if at least an additional 10 square feet per patient served is
included; and
13. A conference and
treatment planning room for use by the psychiatric unit.
C. Seclusion Treatment Room. There shall be
at least one seclusion room for up to 24 beds or a major fraction thereof. If a
facility has more than one psychiatric nursing unit, the number of seclusion
rooms shall be a function of the total number of psychiatric beds in the
facility. Seclusion rooms may be grouped together.
1. The seclusion room is intended for
short-term occupancy by a violent or suicidal patient. The room(s) shall be
located for direct nursing staff supervision. Each room shall be for only one
patient. It shall have an area of at least 60 square feet and shall be
constructed to prevent patient hiding, escape, injury or suicide. Where
restraint beds are required by the functional program, 80 square feet shall be
required.
2. Room doors shall be
designed with hardware that will permit the doors to swing out. Outside corners
shall be omitted where possible. The ceiling shall be of tamperresistant
construction and the air distribution devices, lighting fixtures, sprinkler
heads, and other appurtenances shall be of the tamper-resistant type. The walls
shall be completely free of objects. Special fixtures and hardware for
electrical circuits shall be used. Minimum ceiling height shall be nine feet.
Doors shall be three feet eight inches wide and shall permit staff observation
of the patient while also maintaining provisions for patient privacy. Seclusion
treatment rooms shall be accessed by an anteroom or vestibule which also
provides direct access to a toilet room. The toilet room and anteroom shall
provide for safe management of the patient.
3. Where the interior of the seclusion room
is padded with combustible materials, these materials shall be of a type
acceptable to NFPA standards. The room area, including floor, walls, ceilings,
and all openings shall be protected with not less than one-hourrated
construction.
SECTION
49
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, SURGICAL FACILITIES
A. General Operating Room(s). At least one
general operating room shall be provided for each 50 beds or major fraction
thereof up to 200 beds. Over 200 beds, additional operating room needs shall be
based on the projected surgical workload. In new construction, each room shall
have a minimum clear area of 400 square feet exclusive of fixed or wall-mounted
cabinets and built-in shelves, with a minimum of 20 feet clear dimension
between fixed cabinets and built-in shelves, and a system for emergency
communication with the surgical suite control station. X-ray film illuminators
for handling at least four films simultaneously shall also be provided. In
renovation projects, every effort shall be made to meet the floor space
requirements indicated above. In no event shall the clear floor area be less
than 360 square feet with a minimum dimension of 18 feet.
B. Specialty Operating Rooms for
cardiovascular, orthopedic, neurological, and other procedures that require
additional personnel and/or large equipment. When included, this room shall
have, in addition to the above requirements for general operating rooms, a
minimum clear area of 600 square feet, with a minimum of 20 feet clear
dimension exclusive of fixed or wall-mounted cabinets and built-in shelves.
When open-heart surgery is performed, an additional room in the restricted area
of the surgical suite shall be designated as a pump room where extra corporeal
pump(s), supplies and accessories are stored and serviced. When complex
orthopedic and neurosurgical surgery is performed, additional rooms shall be in
the restricted area of the surgical suite which shall be designated as
equipment storage rooms for the large equipment used to support these
procedures. Appropriate plumbing, medical gases, and electrical connections
shall be provided in the pump storage room. When included, a room for
orthopedic surgery shall, in addition to the above, have enclosed storage space
for splints and traction equipment. Storage outside the operating room shall be
conveniently located. If a sink is used for the disposal of casting material,
an appropriate trap shall be provided. In renovation projects, every effort
shall be made to meet the floor space requirements indicated above. In no event
shall the clear floor area be less than 400 square feet (except for Orthopedic
procedures shall be 360 square feet) with a minimum dimension of 18
feet.
C. Room(s) for Surgical
Cystoscopic and Endo-Urologic Procedures. When provided and/or required by the
written functional program, the cystoscopic and endo-urologic procedures
room(s) shall follow these requirements. A scrub sink or large lavatory shall
be provided within or adjoining the cystoscopy room. In new construction, these
rooms shall have a minimum clear area of 350 square feet, exclusive of fixed or
wallmounted cabinets and built-in shelves with a minimum of 15 feet clear
dimension between fixed cabinets and built-in shelves.
Additional clear space may be required by the functional
program to accommodate special functions in one or more of these rooms. An
emergency communications system shall connect with the Surgical Suite control
station. Facilities for the disposal of liquid wastes shall be provided. If a
floor drain is installed to provide for disposal of liquid wastes, it shall be
completely insulated from ground by means of an insulating type floor drain and
nonconductive waste connections. The drain shall also be provided with a
flushing device. X-ray viewing capability to accommodate at least four films
simultaneously shall be provided. In renovation projects, every effort shall be
made to meet the clear floor space requirements indicted above for
construction. In no event shall the clear floor space be less than 250 square
feet.
D. Endoscopy
The endoscopy suite may be divided into three major functional
areas: the procedure room(s), instrument processing room(s), and patient
holding/preparation and recovery room or area.
NOTE: When invasive procedures are to be performed in this unit
on persons who are known or suspected of having airborne infectious diseases,
these procedures should not be performed in the operating suite. These
procedures shall be performed in a room meeting airborne infections isolation
ventilation requirements or in a space using local exhaust ventilation.
1. Procedures Room(s)
a. Each procedure room shall have a minimum
clear area of 200 square feet (15.58 square meters) exclusive of fixed cabinets
and built-in shelves.
b. A
freestanding handwashing fixture with hands-free controls shall be available in
the suite.
c. Refer to Table 11 for
medical gas station outlets.
d.
Floor covering shall be monolithic and joint free.
e. A system for emergency communication shall
be provided.
f. Procedure rooms
shall be designed for visual and acoustical privacy for the patient.
2. Instrument Processing Room(s)
a. Dedicated processing room(s) for cleaning
and disinfecting instrumentation shall be provided. In an optimal situation,
cleaning room(s) shall be located between two procedure rooms. However, one
processing room may serve multiple procedure rooms. Size of the cleaning
room(s) is dictated by the amount of equipment to be processed.
Cleaning rooms shall allow for flow of instrumentations from
the contaminated area to the clean area, and finally to storage. The clean
equipment rooms, including storage, should protect the equipment from
contamination.
b. The
decontamination room shall be equipped with the following:
1) Two utility sinks remote from each
other.
2) One freestanding
handwashing fixture.
3) Work
counter space(s).
4) Space and
plumbing fixtures for automatic endoscope cleaners, sonic processor, and flash
sterilizers (where required).
5)
Ventilation system. Negative pressure shall be maintained and minimum of 10 air
changes per hour shall be maintained. A hood is recommended over the work
counter. All air shall be exhausted to the outside to avoid recirculation
within the facility.
6) Outlets for
vacuum and compressed air.
7) Floor
covering shall be monolithic and joint free.
3. Patient Holding/Prep/Recovery Area. The
following elements shall be provided in this area:
a) Each patient cubicle shall be equipped
with oxygen and suction outlets.
b)
Cubicle curtains for patient privacy.
c) Medication preparation and storage with
handwashing stations.
d) Toilet
facilities (may be accessible from patient holding or directly from procedure
room(s) or both).
e) Change areas
and storage for patients' personal effects.
f) Nurses reception and charting area with
visualization of patients.
g) Clean
utility room or area.
h)
Environmental Services closet.
E. Service Areas. Individual rooms shall be
provided when so noted; otherwise alcoves or other open spaces which shall not
interfere with traffic may be used. Services, except the soiled workroom and
the janitor's closet, may be shared with and organized as part of the
obstetrical facilities if the approved functional program reflects this sharing
concept. Service areas shall be arranged to avoid direct traffic between the
Operating and Delivery Suites. The following areas shall be provided.
1. Control station located to permit visual
surveillance of all traffic which enters the Operating Suite.
2. A supervisor's office or station. The
number of offices, stations, and teaching areas in the surgical suite shall
depend upon the functional program.
3. Sterilizing facilities conveniently
located to serve all operating rooms. The sterilizing facility shall have work
counter space and a handwashing sink. When the functional program indicates
that adequate provisions have been made for replacement of sterile instruments
during surgery, sterilization facilities in the Surgical Suite shall not be
required.
4. Medication
Distribution. Provisions shall be made for storage and distribution of
medications. This may be done from a medication preparation room or unit, from
a self-contained medication dispensing unit, or by another system approved by
the Department. If used, a medication preparation room or unit shall be under
visual control of nursing staff. It shall contain a work counter, sink,
refrigerator, and double-locked storage for controlled substances with
convenient access to handwashing stations provided. Each blood bank
refrigerator shall be on an emergency power circuit.
5. Scrub Facilities. Two scrub stations shall
be provided near the entrance to each operating room; however, two scrub
stations may serve two operating rooms if the scrub stations are located
adjacent to the entrance of each operating room. Scrub facilities shall be
arranged to minimize any incidental splatter on nearby personnel or supply
carts. In new construction, view windows at scrub stations permitting
observation of room interiors shall be provided. The scrub sinks shall be
recessed into an alcove out of the main traffic areas. Equipment and supplies
for timed scrub technique shall be available at each scrub sink with manual
and/or automatic two way controls.
6. Soiled Workroom. An enclosed soiled
workroom (or soiled-holding room that is part of a system for the collection
and disposal of soiled material) for the exclusive use of the surgical suite
shall be provided. It shall be located in the restricted area. The soiled
workroom shall contain a flushing-rim clinical sink or equivalent flushing-rim
fixture, a work counter, a handwashing fixture, and space for waste
receptacles, and soiled linen receptacles. Rooms used only for temporary
holding of soiled material may omit the flushing-rim clinical sink and work
counters. However, if the flushing-rim clinical sink is omitted, other
provisions for disposal of liquid waste shall be provided. This room shall not
have direct connection with operating rooms or other sterile activity rooms.
Soiled and clean work or holding rooms shall be separated.
7. Clean Workroom or a Clean Supply Room. A
clean workroom is required when clean materials are assembled within the
surgical suite prior to use, or following the decontamination cycle. It shall
contain a work counter, a handwashing fixture, storage for clean supplies, and
space to package reusable items. The storage for sterile supplies shall be
separated from this space. If the room is used only for storage and holding as
part of a system for distribution of clean and sterile supply materials, the
work counter and handwashing fixture may be omitted. Storage space for sterile
and clean supplies shall be adequate for the functional plan. The space shall
be moisture and temperature controlled and free from cross traffic.
8. The location of sterilization for surgical
instruments and the direction of flow from the decontamination location to the
sterile location shall be addressed by the written functional program.
a. An operating room suite design with a
sterile core shall provide for no cross traffic of staff and supplies from the
decontaminated/soiled areas to the sterile/clean areas.
b. The use of facilities outside the
operating room for soiled/decontaminated processing and clean assembly and
sterile processing shall be designed to move the flow of goods and personnel
from dirty to clean/sterile without compromising standard precautions or
aseptic techniques in both departments. This room shall have no direct opening
into an operating room.
9. Anesthesia storage shall be provided in
accordance with NFPA 99.
10.
Medical gas storage facilities. Main storage of medical gases may be outside or
inside the facility in accordance with NFPA99. Provision shall be made for
additional separate storage of reserve gas cylinders necessary to complete at
least one day's procedures.
11 An
anesthesia workroom for testing and storing anesthesia equipment shall contain
a work counter, sink and racks for cylinders.
12. Equipment storage room(s) for equipment
and supplies used in the Surgical Suite. Each surgical suite shall provide
sufficient storage area to keep the exit access corridor free of equipment and
supplies, but not less than 150 square feet or 50 square feet per OR, whichever
is greater.
13. Staff Dressing
Room. Appropriate room(s) shall be provided for males and females working
within the Surgical Suite. The room(s) shall contain lockers, showers, toilets,
lavatories equipped for handwashing, and space for donning scrub suits and
boots. These room(s) shall be arranged to provide a one-way traffic pattern so
personnel entering from outside the Surgical Suite can change, shower, gown,
and move directly into the Surgical Suite.
14. Stretcher storage area out of direct line
of traffic.
15. Staff lounge and
toilet facilities. Separate or combined lounges for males and females shall be
provided. Lounge(s) shall be located to permit use without leaving the Surgical
Suite and to provide convenient access to the Recovery Room
16. Dictation and report preparation area.
This may be accessible from the lounge area.
17. Phase II recovery. Where outpatient
surgeries are to be part of the surgical suite, and where outpatients receive
Class B or Class C sedation, a second Phase II or step-down recovery room shall
be provided. The room shall contain handwashing stations, a nurse station with
charting facilities, clinical sink, provision for bedpan cleaning, and storage
space for supplies and equipment. In addition, the design shall provide a
minimum of 50 square feet for each patient in a lounge chair with space for
additional equipment described in the functional program and for clearance of 4
feet between the sides of the lounge chairs and the foot of the lounge chairs.
Provisions shall be made for the isolation of infectious patients. Provisions
for patient privacy such as cubicle curtains shall be made. In new
construction, at least one door shall access the PACU without crossing
unrestricted corridors of the hospital. A patient toilet shall be provided with
direct access to the Phase II recovery unit for the exclusive use of patients.
A staff toilet shall be provided with direct access to the working area to
maintain staff availability to patients. Handwashing stations with hands-free
operable controls shall be available with at least one for every four lounge
chairs uniformly distributed to provide equal access from each patient
bed.
18. Change areas for
outpatients and same-day admissions. If the functional program defines
outpatient surgery as part of the surgical suite, a separate area shall be
provided where outpatients may change from street clothing into hospital gowns
and be prepared for surgery. This would include a waiting room, locker(s),
toilet(s), and clothing change or gowning area. Changing may also be
accommodated in a private holding room or cubicle
19. Provisions shall be made for patient
examination, interviews, preparation, testing, and obtaining vital signs of
patients for outpatient surgery.
20. Patient holding area. In facilities with
two or more operating rooms, an area shall be provided to accommodate stretcher
patients waiting for surgery. This holding area shall be under the visual
control of the nursing staff.
21.
Storage areas for portable X-ray equipment, stretchers, fracture tables,
warming devices, auxiliary lamps, etc. These areas shall be out of corridors
and traffic.
22. Emergency
equipment storage under direct control of the nursing staff and not obstructing
the corridor.
23. Environmental
Services closet. See Section 65, Physical Facilities, Cleaning and Sanitizing
Carts and Environmental Services, for detailed requirements.
24. Area for preparation and examination of
frozen sections. This may be part of the general laboratory if immediate
results are obtainable without unnecessary delay in the completion of
surgery.
25. Ice machine. An ice
machine shall be provided to provide ice for treatments and patient use. Ice
intended for human consumption shall be from self- dispensing ice
makers.
26. A waiting room, with
toilets, telephones, and drinking fountains conveniently located. The toilet
room shall contain handwashing stations. If outpatients, as defined by the
written functional program, are required to wait in this area, then a separate
area shall be provided. Provisions shall be made for examinations, interviews,
testing, and obtaining vital signs.
A separate area shall be provided where outpatients may change
from street clothing into hospital gowns.
27. Ethylene Oxide Sterilization Facilities.
Where ethylene oxide is used for sterilization, provisions shall be made for
complete exhaust of gases to the exterior. When the door is opened, arrangement
shall ensure that gases are pulled away from the operator. Provisions shall be
made for appropriate aeration of supplies. Aeration cabinets shall be vented to
the outside. Where aeration cabinets are not used in ethylene oxide processing,
provision for isolated area mechanically vented to the outside for aeration,
OSHA standards shall be met.
F. Preoperative Patient Holding Area.
1. Preoperative Patient Holding Area(s). In
facilities with two or more operating rooms, areas shall be provided to
accommodate stretcher patients as well as sitting space for ambulatory patients
not requiring stretchers. These areas shall be under the direct visual control
of the nursing staff and may be part of the recovery suite to achieve maximum
flexibility in managing surgical case loads. Each stretcher station shall be a
minimum of 80 square feet and shall have a minimum clearance of 4 feet on the
sides of the stretchers and the foot of the stretcher. Provisions shall be made
for the isolation of infectious patients. Provisions for patient privacy such
as cubicle curtains shall be made.
G. Post-anesthetic care units (PACUs):
1. Each PACU shall contain a medication
station; handwashing stations; nurse station with charting facilities; clinical
sink; provisions for bedpan cleaning; and storage space for stretchers,
supplies, and equipment. Additionally, the design shall provide a minimum of 80
square feet for each patient bed with a space for additional equipment
described in the functional program, and for clearance of at least 5 feet
between patient beds and 4 feet between patient bedsides and adjacent walls.
Provisions shall be made for the isolation of infectious patients. Provisions
for patient privacy such as cubicle curtains shall be made. In new
construction, at least one door to the recovery room shall access directly from
the surgical suite without crossing public hospital corridors.
2. An airborne infection isolation room is
not required in a PACU. Provision for the recovery of a potentially infectious
patient with an airborne infection shall be determined by the Infection
Prevention and Control Risk Assessment.
3. A staff toilet shall be located within the
working area to maintain staff availability to patients.
4. Handwashing stations with hands-free
operable controls shall be available with at least one for every four beds
uniformly distributed to provide equal access from each patient bed.
SECTION 50
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, OBSTETRICAL FACILITIES.
General obstetrical unit shall be located and designated to
prohibit non-related traffic through the unit. When delivery and operating
rooms are in the same suite, access and service arrangements shall be such that
neither staff nor patients need to travel through one area to reach the other.
Except as permitted otherwise herein, existing facilities being renovated
shall, as far as practicable, provide all the required support services.
A. Postpartum Unit.
1. Postpartum Room.
a. A postpartum room shall have a minimum of
100square feet of clear floor area per bed in multi-bedded rooms and 120square
feet of clear floor area in single-bed rooms. These areas shall be exclusive of
toilet rooms, closets, alcoves, or vestibules. Where renovation work is
undertaken, every effort shall be made to meet the above minimum standards. If
it is not possible to meet the above square -foot standards, the authorities
having jurisdiction may grant approval to deviate from this requirement. In
such cases, existing postpartum patient rooms shall have no less than 80 square
feet of clear floor area per bed in multiplebed rooms and 100 square feet in
single-bed rooms.
b. In
multi-bedded rooms there shall be a minimum clear distance of four feet between
the foot of the bed and the opposite wall, three feet between the side of the
bed and nearest wall, and four feet between beds.
c. The maximum number of beds per room shall
be two.
2. The following
support services for this unit shall be provided.
a. Nurses' station.
b. Nurse office.
c. Charting facilities.
d. Toilet room for staff.
e. Staff lounge.
f. Lockable closets or cabinets for personal
articles of staff.
g.
Consultation/conference room(s).
h.
Patients' lounge. The patients' lounge may be omitted if all rooms are
single-bedded rooms
i. Clean
workroom or clean supply room. A clean workroom is required if clean materials
are assembled within the obstetrical suite prior to use. It shall contain a
work counter, a handwashing fixture, and storage facilities for clean and
sterile supplies. If the room is used only for storage and holding as part of a
system for distribution of clean and sterile supply materials, the work counter
and handwashing fixtures may be omitted. Soiled and clean workrooms or holding
rooms shall be separated and have no direct connection.
j. Soiled workroom or soiled holding room for
the exclusive use of the obstetrical suite. This room shall be separate from
the clean workroom. The soiled workroom shall contain a clinical sink (or
equivalent flushingrim fixture) and a handwashing fixture. The above fixtures
shall have a hot and cold mixing faucet. The room shall have work counter and
space for separate covered containers for soiled linen and waste. Rooms used
only for temporary holding of soiled material may omit the clinical sink and
work counter. If the flushing-rim clinical sink is omitted, facilities for
cleaning bedpans shall be provided elsewhere.
k. Medication station. Provision shall be
made for storage and distribution of drugs and routine medications. This may be
done from a medicine preparation room or unit, from a self-contained medicine
dispensing unit, or by another approved system. If used, a medicine preparation
room or unit shall be under visual control of nursing staff. It shall contain a
work counter, sink, refrigerator, and double-locked storage for controlled
substances. Convenient access to handwashing stations shall be provided.
(Standard cup- sinks provided in many self-contained units are not adequate for
handwashing.)
l. Clean linen
storage may be part of a clean workroom or a separate closet. When a closed
cart system is used, the cart shall be stored out of the path of normal
traffic.
m. Nourishment station
shall contain sink, work counter, ice dispenser, refrigerator, cabinets, and
equipment for serving hot or cold food. Space shall be included for temporary
holding of unused or soiled dietary trays.
n. Equipment storage room. Each unit shall
provide sufficient storage area(s) located on the patient floor to keep its
required corridor width free of equipment and supplies, but not less than 10
square feet per postpartum room and 20 square feet per each LDR or LDRP outside
of the patient room.
o. Storage
space for stretchers and wheelchairs shall be provided in a strategic location,
out of corridors and away from normal traffic.
p. When bathing facilities are not provided
in patient rooms, there shall be at least one shower and/or bathtub for each
six beds or fraction thereof.
q. A
housekeeping room shall be provided for the exclusive use of the obstetrical
suite. It shall be directly accessible from the suite and shall contain a
service sink or floor receptor and provisions for storage of supplies and
housekeeping equipment.
r.
Examination/treatment room and/or multipurpose diagnostic testing room shall
have a minimum clear floor area of 120square feet. When utilized as a
multipatient diagnostic testing room, a minimum clear floor area of 80square
feet per patient shall be provided. An adjoining toilet room shall be provided
for patient use.
s. Emergency
equipment storage shall be located in close proximity to the nurses'
station.
4. Airborne
infection isolation room(s). An airborne infection isolation room is not
required for the obstetrical unit. Provisions for the care of the perinatal
patient with an airborne infection shall be determined by the Infection
Prevention and Control Risk Assessment.
B. Cesarean/Delivery Suite.
1. Caesarean/delivery room(s) shall have a
minimum clear floor area of 360 square feet with a minimum dimension of 16 feet
exclusive of built-in shelves or cabinets. There shall be a minimum of one such
room in every obstetrical unit.
2.
Delivery room(s) shall have minimum clear area of 300 square feet exclusive of
fixed cabinets and built-in shelves. An emergency communication system shall be
connected with the obstetrical suite control station.
3. Infant resuscitation shall be provided
within the cesarean/delivery room(s) and delivery rooms with a minimum clear
floor are of 40 square feet in addition to the required area of each room or
may be provided in a separate but immediately accessible room with a clear
floor area of 150 square feet. Six single or three duplex electrical outlets
shall be provided for the infant in addition to the facilities required for the
mother.
4. Labor room(s) (LDR or
LDRP rooms may be substituted). In renovation projects, existing labor rooms
may have a minimum clear area of 100 square feet per bed.
Where LDRs or LDRPs are not provided, a minimum of two labor
beds shall be provided for each Caesarean room and/or delivery room. In
facilities that have only one Caesarean delivery room, two labor rooms shall be
provided. Each room shall be designed for either one or two beds with a minimum
clear area of 120square feet per bed. Each labor room shall contain a
handwashing fixture and have access to a private toilet room. One toilet room
may serve two labor rooms.
Labor rooms shall have controlled access with doors that are
arranged for observation from a nurses' station. At least one shower (which may
be separate from the labor room if under staff control) for use of patients in
labor shall be provided. Windows in labor rooms, if provided, shall be located,
draped, or otherwise arranged to preserve patient privacy from causal
observation from outside the labor room.
5. Recovery room(s). (LDR or LDRP rooms may
be substituted.) Each recovery room shall contain at least two beds and have a
nurses' station with charting facilities located to permit visual control of
all beds. Each room shall include stations for handwashing and dispensing
medicine. A clinical sink with bedpan flushing device shall be available, as
shall storage for supplies and equipment. There shall be enough space for baby
and crib and a chair for the support person. There shall be the ability to
maintain visual privacy of the new family.
6. Service Areas.
a. Individual rooms shall be provided as
indicated in the following standards; otherwise, alcoves or other open spaces
that do not interfere with traffic may be used.
b. The following services shall be provided:
1) A control/nurse station located to
restrict unauthorized traffic into the suite.
2) Soiled workroom or soiled holding room.
This room shall be separate from the clean workroom. The soiled workroom shall
contain a clinical sink (or equivalent flushing-rim fixture). The room shall
contain a handwashing fixture. The above fixtures shall have a hot and cold
mixing faucet. The room shall have a work counter and space for separate
covered containers for soiled linen and waste. Rooms used only for temporary
holding of soiled material may omit the clinical sink and work counter. If the
flushing-rim clinical sink is eliminated, facilities for cleaning bedpans shall
be provided elsewhere.
3) Fluid
waste disposal.
c. The
following services may be shared with the surgical facilities if the functional
program reflects this concern. Where shared, areas shall be arranged to avoid
direct traffic between the delivery and operating rooms.
1) A supervisor's office or
station.
2) A waiting room, with
toilets, telephones, and drinking fountains conveniently located. The toilet
room shall contain handwashing stations.
3) Sterilizing facilities with high-speed
sterilizers convenient to all Caesarean/delivery rooms. Sterilization
facilities shall be separate from the delivery area and adjacent to clean
assembly. High-speed autoclaves shall only be used in an emergency situation
(i.e., a dropped instrument and no sterile replacement readily available).
Sterilization facilities would not be necessary if the flow of materials were
handled from a central service department based on the usage of the delivery
room (DR).
4) A drug distribution
station with handwashing stations and provisions for controlled storage,
preparation, and distribution of medication.
5) Scrub facilities for Caesarean and
delivery rooms. Two scrub stations shall be provided adjacent to entrance to
each Caesarean/delivery room. Scrub facilities should be arranged to minimize
any splatter on nearby personnel or supply carts. In new construction, view
windows at scrub stations to permit the observation of room
interiors.
6) Clean workroom or
clean supply room. A clean workroom shall be provided if clean materials are
assembled within the obstetrical suite prior to use. If a clean workroom is
provided it shall contain a work counter, sink equipped for handwashing and
space for storage of supplies. A clean supply room may be provided when the
narrative program defines a system for the storage and distribution of clean
and sterile supplies.
7) Medical
gas storage facilities. Main storage of medical gases may be outside or inside
the facility in accordance with NFPA99. Provision shall be made for additional
separate storage of reserve gas cylinders necessary to complete at least one
day's procedures.
8) A clean
sterile storage area readily available to the delivery room: size to be
determined on level of usage, functions provided, and supplies from the
hospital central distribution area.
9) An anesthesia workroom for cleaning,
testing, and storing anesthesia equipment. It shall contain a work counter,
sink, and provisions for separation of clean and soiled items.
10) Equipment storage room(s) for equipment
and supplies used in the obstetrical suite.
11) Staff clothing change areas. The clothing
change area shall be designed to encourage one-way traffic and cross-traffic
between clean and contaminated personnel. The area shall contain lockers,
showers, toilets, handwashing stations, and space for donning and disposing
scrub suits and booties.
12) Male
and female support persons change area (designed as described above).
13) Lounge and toilet facilities for
obstetrical staff convenient to delivery, labor, and recovery areas. The toilet
room shall contain handwashing stations.
14) An on-call room(s) for physician and/or
staff may be located elsewhere in the facility.
15) Environmental Services Closet. See
Section 65, Physical Facilities, Cleaning Sanitizing Carts and Environmental
Services for detailed requirements.
16) An area for storing stretchers out of the
path of normal traffic.
C. LDR and LDRP Facilities. When provided by
the narrative program, delivery procedures in accordance with birthing concepts
may be performed in the LDR or LDRP rooms. LDR room(s) may be located in a
separate LDR suite or as part of the Caesarean/Delivery suite. The postpartum
unit may contain LDRP rooms. These rooms shall have a minimum of 250square feet
of clear floor area with a minimum dimension of 13feet, exclusive of toilet
room, closet, alcove, or vestibules. There should be enough space for crib and
reclining chair for support person. An area within the room but distinct from
the mothers area shall be provided for infant stabilization and resuscitation.
See Table 4 of the Appendix for medical gas outlets. These outlets shall be
located in the room so that they are accessible to the mother's delivery area
and infant resuscitation area. When renovation work is undertaken, every effort
shall be made to meet the above minimum standards. If it is not possible to
meet the above square-foot standards, the authorities having jurisdiction may
grant approval to deviate from this requirement. In such cases, existing LDR or
LDRP rooms may have a minimum clear area of 200 square feet.
Each LDR or LDRP room shall be for single occupancy and have
direct access to a private toilet with shower or tub. Each room shall be
equipped with handwashing facilities (handwashing stations with hands-free
operation area acceptable for scrubbing). Examination lights may be portable,
but shall be immediately accessible.
Finishes shall be selected to facilitate cleaning and with
resistance to strong detergents. Window(s) shall be provided for LDRP room(s).
Windows or doors within a normal sightline that would permit observation into
the room shall be arranged or draped as necessary for patient privacy.
Additional requirements for windows are provided above in A2.a.
SECTION 51
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, EMERGENCY SUITE.
A. General. The following shall be provided:
1. Grade-level well-marked, illuminated, and
covered entrance with direct access from public roads for ambulance and vehicle
traffic. Entrance and driveway shall be clearly marked. If a raised platform is
used for ambulance discharge, a ramp shall be provided for pedestrian and
wheelchair access. The emergency vehicle entry cover shall provide shelter for
both the patient and the emergency medical crew during transfer from an
emergency vehicle into the building.
2. Paved emergency access to permit discharge
of patients from automobiles and ambulances, and temporary parking convenient
to the entrance.
3. Reception,
triage, and nurses' station shall be located to permit staff observation and
control of access to treatment area, pedestrian and ambulance entrances, and
public waiting area. The triage area requires special consideration. As the
point of entry and assessment for patients with undiagnosed and untreated
airborne infections, the triage area shall be designed and ventilated to reduce
exposure of staff, patients and families to airborne infectious diseases. If
determined by the infection prevention and control risk assessment, one or more
separate, enclosed spaces designed and ventilated as airborne infection
isolation rooms shall be required.
4. Wheelchair and stretcher storage shall be
provided for arriving patients. This shall be out of traffic with convenient
access from emergency entrances.
5.
Public waiting area with toilet facilities, drinking fountains, and telephones
shall be provided. The hospital shall conduct infection prevention and control
risk assessment to determine if the emergency department waiting area shall
require special measures to reduce the risk of airborne infection transmission.
These measures may include enhanced general ventilation and air disinfection
similar to inpatient requirements for airborne infection isolation
rooms.
6. Communication center
shall be convenient to nurses' station and have radio, telephone, and
intercommunication systems.
7.
Examination and Treatment Room(s). Examination and treatment room(s) shall have
minimum floor area of 120 square feet. The room shall contain work counter(s);
cabinets; handwashing stations; supply storage facilities; examination lights;
a desk, counter, or shelf space for writing; and a vision panel adjacent to
and/or in the door. When treatment cubicles are in open multiple-bed areas,
each cubicle shall have a minimum of 80square feet of clear floor space and
shall be separated from adjoining cubicles by curtains. Handwashing stations
shall be provided for each four treatment cubicles or major fraction thereof in
multiplebed areas. For oxygen and vacuum requirements, see Table 4 of the
Appendix.
Treatment/exam rooms used for pelvic exams should allow for the
foot of the examination table to face away from the door.
8. Trauma/cardiac rooms for emergency
procedures, including emergency surgery, shall have at least 250 square feet of
clear floor space. Each room shall have cabinets and emergency supply shelves,
X-ray film illuminators, examination lights, and counter space for writing.
Additional space with cubicle curtains for privacy may be provided to
accommodate more than one patient at a time in the trauma room. Provisions
shall be made for monitoring the patient. There shall be storage provided for
immediate access to attire used for universal precautions. Doorways leading
from the ambulance entrance to the cardiac trauma room shall be a minimum of
five feet wide to simultaneously accommodate stretchers, equipment, and
personnel. In renovation projects, every effort shall be made to have existing
cardiac/trauma rooms meet the above minimum standards.
9. Orthopedic and cast work. These may be in
separate room(s) or in the trauma room. They shall include storage for splints
and other orthopedic supplies, traction hooks, X-ray film illuminators, and
examination lights. If a sink is used for the disposal of plaster of paris, a
plaster trap shall be provided. The clear floor space for this area shall
depend on the functions program and the procedures and equipment accommodated
here.
10. Scrub stations located in
or adjacent and convenient to each trauma and/or orthopedic room.
11. Convenient access to radiology and
laboratory services.
12. Poison
Control Center and EMS Communications Center may be part of the work and
charting area.
13. Provisions for
disposal of solid and liquid waste. This may be a clinical sink with bedpan
flushing device within the soiled workroom.
14. Storage area out of line of traffic for
stretchers, wheelchairs and emergency equipment;
15. A toilet room for patients. Where there
are more than eight treatment areas, a minimum of two toilet facilities, with
handwashing stations(s) in each toilet room, will be required.;
16. Soiled workroom for the exclusive use of
the emergency suite. This room shall be separate from the clean workroom. The
soiled workroom shall contain a clinical sink or equivalent flushing type
fixture, work counter, sink equipped for handwashing, waste receptacle and
linen receptacle. This room shall be separate from the clean workroom and shall
have separate access doors.
17.
Clean workroom or clean supply room. A clean work room is required if clean
materials are assembled within the emergency suite prior to use. It shall
contain a work counter, a handwashing fixture, and storage facilities for clean
and sterile supplies. If the room is used only for storage and holding as part
of a system for distribution of clean and sterile supply materials, the work
counter and handwashing fixtures may be omitted. Soiled and clean workrooms or
holding rooms shall be separated and have no direct connection.
18. Nurses' Station(s). Facilities for
charting, clinical records, work counter, communication system, space for
supplies and convenient access to handwashing stations shall be provided.
Visual observation of all traffic into the suite, where feasible.
19. Securable closets or cabinet compartments
for personnel.
20. Staff lounge.
Convenient and private access to staff toilets, lounge, and lockers shall be
provided.
21. Housekeeping room. A
housekeeping room shall be directly accessible from the unit and shall contain
a service sink or floor receptor and provisions for storage of supplies and
housekeeping equipment.
22.
Security station. A security system should be located near the emergency
entrances and triage/reception area. The non-selective 24-hour accessibility of
the emergency dictates that a security system reflecting local community needs
be provided.
23. At least one
airborne infection isolation room shall be provided. The need for additional
airborne infection isolation rooms or for protective environment room shall be
as determined by the Infection Prevention and Control Risk Assessment. See
Section 44.C for requirements.
24.
Bereavement Room shall be located within or adjacent to the emergency suite. A
telephone shall be provided.
25.
Secured holding room in accordance with the functional program. At least one
holding/seclusion room of 80 square feet shall be provided. This room shall
allow for security, patient and staff safety, patient observations, and
soundproofing.
26. Decontamination
area. A decontamination area shall be provided. The functional program shall
define the location of the area and the types of exposure (i.e., nuclear,
biological, chemical) to be considered. The location of the area shall be
permitted to be on the exterior perimeter of the facility adjacent to the
ambulance entrance or built within the walls of the facility.
SECTION 52
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, IMAGING SUITE.
A.
General.
1. Equipment and space shall be as
required by the functional program.
2. A certified physicist or other qualified
expert shall specify the type, location, and amount of radiation protection to
be installed in accordance with the final approved department layout and
equipment selections. Where protected alcoves with view windows are required, a
minimum of one foot six inches between the view window and the outside
partition edge shall be provided. Radiation protection requirements shall be
incorporated into the specifications and the building plans.
3. Radiation Control and Emergency Management
shall be notified when any existing and/or new equipment has been relocated or
introduced into the facility. Radiation Control approval for the equipment(s)
and space(s) shall be obtained prior to use.
B. Angiography.
1. Space shall be provided as required by the
functional program.
2. A control
room shall be provided as necessary to meet the needs of the functional
program. A view window in the control room shall be provided to permit full
view of the patient.
3. A viewing
area shall be provided.
4. A scrub
sink located outside the staff entry to the procedure room shall be provided
for use by staff.
5. A patient
holding area shall be provided.
6.
Storage for portable equipment and supplies shall be provided.
7. Provision shall be made within the
facility for extended post-procedure observation of outpatients.
C. Computerized Tomography (CT)
Scanning.
1. A control room shall be provided
which is designed to accommodate the computer and other controls for the
equipment. A view window shall be provided to permit full view of the patient.
The angle between the control and equipment centroid shall permit the control
operator to see the patient's head.
2. The control room shall be located to allow
convenient film processing.
3. A
patient toilet room shall be convenient to the procedure room, and if directly
accessible to the scan room, arranged so that a patient may leave the toilet
without having to reenter the scan room.
D. Diagnostic X-ray (e.g., Tomography,
Radiography/Fluoroscopy Rooms, Mammography). Radiology rooms shall be of a size
to accommodate the functional program. Each X-ray room shall include a shielded
control alcove. This area shall be provided with a view window designed to
provide full view of the examination table and the patient at all times,
including full view of the patient when the table is in the tilt position or
the chest X-ray is being utilized. For mammography machines with built-in
shielding for the operator, the alcove may be omitted when approved by the
certified physicist or state radiation protection agency.
E. Magnetic Resonance Imaging (MRI).
1. Space shall be provided as required by the
functional program.
2. A control
room shall be provided with full view of the MRI.
3. A computer room shall be
provided.
4. A patient holding area
should be located near the MRI unit.
5. Cryogen venting shall comply with
manufacturer's recommendations.
F. Ultrasound.
1. Space shall be provided as required by the
functional program.
2. A patient
toilet room, accessible from the procedure room, shall be provided.
G. Support Spaces. The following
spaces are common to the imaging department and are minimum requirements unless
stated otherwise.
1. Patient Waiting Area. The
area shall have a seating capacity in accordance with the functional
program.
2. Control Desk and
Reception Area.
3. Holding Area. A
convenient holding area under staff control shall be provided to accommodate
patients on stretchers or beds.
4.
Patient Toilet Rooms. Toilet rooms shall be provided convenient to the waiting
rooms and shall be equipped with an emergency call system. Separate toilets
with handwashing stations shall be provided with direct access from each
radiography/fluoroscopy room so that a patient may leave the toilet without
having to reenter the radiography/fluoroscopy room. Rooms used only
occasionally for fluoroscopy procedures may utilize nearby patient toilets if
they are located for immediate access.
5. Patient Dressing Rooms. Dressing rooms
shall be provided convenient to the waiting areas and X-ray rooms. Each room
shall include a seat or bench, mirror, and provisions for hanging patients'
clothing.
6. Staff Facilities.
Toilets may be outside the suite but shall be convenient for staff use. In
larger suites of three or more procedure rooms, toilets internal to the suite
shall be provided.
7. Image
Storage. Provisions shall be provided by the facility for the active and
inactive image storage. A room with cabinet or shelves for filing patient image
for immediate retrieval shall be provided. A room or area for inactive image
storage shall be provided. It may be outside the imaging suite, but shall be
under imaging's administrative control and properly secured to protect films
against loss or damage.
8. Storage
for Unexposed Image. Storage facilities for unexposed images shall include
protection of film against exposure or damage and shall not be warmer than the
air of adjacent occupied spaces.
9.
Provisions for image viewing, individual consultation, clerical spaces and
charting shall be provided.
10.
Contrast Media Preparation. This area shall be provided with sink, counter, and
storage to allow for mixing of contrast media. One preparation area, if
conveniently located, may serve any number of rooms. When prepared media is
used, this area may be omitted, but storage shall be provided for the
media.
11. Image Processing Room. A
darkroom shall be provided for image processing unless the processing equipment
normally used does not require a darkroom for loading and transfer. When
daylight processing is used, the darkroom may be minimal for emergency and
special uses. Image processing shall be located convenient to the procedure
rooms and to the quality control area.
12. Quality Control Area. An area shall be
provided near the processor for viewing film immediately after it is processed.
All view boxes shall be illuminated to provide light of the same color value
and intensity for appropriate comparison of several adjacent images.
13. Cleanup Facilities. Provisions for
cleanup shall be located within the suite for convenient access and use and
shall include service sink or floor receptacle as well as storage space for
equipment and supplies. If automatic film processors are used, a receptacle of
adequate size with hot and cold water for cleaning the processor racks shall be
provided.
14. Handwashing Stations.
Handwashing stations shall be provided within each procedure room unless the
room is used only for routine screening such as chest X-rays where the patient
is not physically handled by the staff. Handwashing stations shall be provided
convenient to the MRI room, but need not be within the room.
15. Clean Storage. Provisions shall be made
for the storage of clean supplies and linens. If conveniently located, storage
may be shared with another department.
16. Soiled Holding. Provisions shall be made
for soiled holding. Separate provisions for contaminated handling and holding
shall be made. Handwashing stations shall be provided.
17. Provision shall be made for locked
storage of medications and drugs.
H. Cardiac Catheterization Lab.
Note: The number of procedure rooms and the size of the prep,
holding, and recovery areas shall be based on expected utilization.
1. The cardiac catheterization lab is
normally a separate suite, but may be within the imaging suite when the
appropriate sterile environment is provided. It may be combined with
angiography in low usage situations.
2. The procedure room shall be a minimum of
400square feet exclusive of fixed and movable cabinets and shelves.
3. A control room or area for the efficient
functioning of the X-ray and image recording equipment. A view window
permitting full view of the patient from the control console shall be
provided.
4. An equipment room or
enclosure large enough to contain x-ray transformers, power modules, and
associated electronics and electrical gear shall be provided.
5. Scrub facilities with hands free operable
controls shall be provided adjacent to the entrance of procedure rooms, and
shall be arranged to minimize incidental splatter on nearby personnel, medical
equipment, or supplies.
6. The
following shall be available for use by the cardiac catheterization suite:
a. A viewing room;
b. A film file room.
7. Staff change area(s) shall be provided and
arranged to ensure a traffic pattern so that personnel entering from outside
the suite can enter, change their clothing, and move directly into the cardiac
catheterization suite.
8. A patient
preparation, holding, and recovery area or room shall be provided and arranged
to provide visual observation before and after the procedure.
9. A clean workroom or clean supply room
shall be provided. If the room is used for preparing patient care items, it
shall contain a work counter and handwashing sink. If the room is used only for
storage and holding of clean and sterile supply materials, the work counter and
handwashing stations may be omitted.
10. A soiled workroom shall be provided which
shall contain a handwashing and a clinical sink (or equivalent flushing rim
fixtures). When the room is used for temporary holding of soiled materials, the
clinical sink may be omitted.
11. A
housekeeping closet containing a floor receptor or service sink and provisions
for storage of supplies and housekeeping equipment shall be provided.
SECTION 53
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, NUCLEAR MEDICINE.
A. Equipment and space shall be provided to
accommodate the functional program.
B. A certified physicist or other qualified
expert representing the owner shall specify the type, location, and amount of
radiation protection to be installed in accordance with final approved
department layout and equipment selection. These specifications shall be
incorporated into the plans.
C.
Floors and walls shall be constructed of materials that are easily
decontaminated in case of radioactive spills.
D. If radiopharmaceutical preparation is
performed onsite, an area adequate to house a radiopharmacy shall be provided
with appropriate shielding. This area should include adequate space for storage
of radionuclides, chemicals for preparation, dose calibrators, and record
keeping. Floors and walls should be constructed of easily decontaminated
materials. Vents and traps for radioactive gases should be provided if such are
used. Hoods for pharmaceutical preparation shall meet applicable standards. If
pre-prepared materials are used, storage and calculation area may be
considerable smaller than that for on-site preparation. Space shall provide
adequately for dose calibration, quality assurance, and record keeping. This
area may still require shielding from other portions of the
facilities.
E. Nuclear medicine
area when operated separately from the imaging department shall include the
following as required to accommodate the functional program:
1. Space adequate to permit entry of
stretchers, beds, and able to accommodate imaging equipment, electronic
consoles, and if present, computer terminals;
2. A darkroom onsite available for film
processing. The darkroom should contain protective storage facilities for
unexposed film that guard the film against exposure or damage;
3. When the functional program requires a
centralized computer area, it should be a separate room with access terminals
available within the imaging rooms.
4. Provisions for cleanup located within the
suite for convenient access and use. It shall include service sink or floor
receptacle as well as storage space for equipment and supplies;
5. Film storage with cabinets or shelves for
filing patient film for immediate retrieval;
6. Inactive film storage under the
departmental administrative control and properly secured to protect film
against loss or damage;
7. A
consultation area with view boxes illuminated to provide light of the same
color value and intensity for appropriate comparison of several adjacent
films;
8. Provisions for
physicians, assistants and clerical office space, individual consultation,
viewing, and charting of film;
9.
Waiting areas out of traffic, under staff control, with seating capacity in
accordance with the functional program. If the department is routinely used for
outpatients and inpatients at the same time, separate waiting areas with
screening or visual privacy between the waiting areas;
10. A private area for dose administration
located near the preparation area;
11. A holding area for patients on stretchers
or beds which may be provided and may be combined with the dose administration
area with visual privacy between the areas;
12. Patient dressing rooms convenient to the
waiting area and procedure rooms. Each dressing room shall include a seat or
bench, a mirror, and provisions for hanging patient's clothing;
13. Toilet rooms convenient to waiting and
procedure rooms;
14. Staff
toilet(s) convenient to the nuclear medicine laboratory;
15. Handwashing stations within each
procedure room;
16. Control desk
and reception area;
17. Storage
area for clean linen with a handwashing station;
18. Provisions shall be made for holding
soiled material. Such provision shall include a handwashing station.
19. Separate provision shall be made for
holding contaminated material (exposed to radiation).
F. Positron Emission Tomography (PET).
1. Space should be provided as necessary to
accommodate the functional program.
2. PET scanning is generally used in
experimental settings and requires space for a scanner and for a cyclotron. The
scanner room should be a minimum of 300 square feet.
3. Where a cyclotron room is required, it
should he a minimum of 225 square feet with a 16 square foot space safe for
storage of parts, which may need to cool down for a year or more.
4. Both a hot (radioactive) lab and a cold
(nonradioactive) lab may be required, each a minimum of 250 square
feet.
5. A blood lab of a minimum
of 80 square feet should be provided.
6. A patient holding area to accommodate two
stretchers should be provided.
7. A
gas storage area large enough to accommodate bottles of gas should he provided.
Each gas will be piped individually and may go to the cyclotron or to the lab.
Ventilation adequate for the occupancy is required. Compressed air may be
required to pressurize a water circulation system.
8. Significant radiation protection may be
required since the cyclotron may generate high radiation.
9. Special ventilation systems together with
monitors, sensors, and alarm systems may be required to vent gases and
chemicals.
10. The heating,
ventilating, and air conditioning system will require particular attention;
highest pressures should be in coldest (radiation) areas and exhaust should be
in hottest (radiation) areas. Redundancy may be important.
11. The cyclotron is water cooled with
de-ionized water. A heat exchanger and connection to a compressor or connection
to chilled water may be required. A redundant plumbing system connected to a
holding tank may be required to prevent accidental leakage of contaminated
water into the regular plumbing system.
G. Radiotherapy.
1. Rooms and spaces shall be provided as
required by the functional program. Equipment manufacturers recommendations
should be sought and followed, since space requirements may vary from one
machine to another and one manufacturer to another. The radiotherapy suite may
contain one or both electron beam therapy and radiation therapy.
2. Cobalt, linear accelerators, and
simulation rooms require radiation protection. A certified physicist
representing the owner or appropriate state agency shall specify the type,
location, and amount of protection to be installed in accordance with final
approved department layout and equipment selection. This information shall be
Incorporate into the floor plans.
3. Cobalt rooms and linear accelerators shall
be sized in accordance with equipment requirements and shall accommodate a
stretcher for litter-borne patients. Layouts shall provide for preventing the
escape of radioactive particles. Openings into the room, including doors,
ductwork, vents, and electrical raceways and conduits, shall be baffled to
prevent direct exposure to other areas of the facility.
4. Simulator, accelerator, and cobalt rooms
shall be sized to accommodate the equipment with patient access on a stretcher,
medical staff access to the equipment and patient, and service
access.
5. Flooring shall be
adequate to meet load requirements for equipment, patients, and personnel.
Provision for wiring raceways, ducts, or conduit should be made in floors and
ceilings. Ceiling mounted equipment should have properly designed rigid support
structures located above the finished ceiling. The ceiling height is normally
higher than 8'-0" (2.44 meters). A lay-in type of ceiling should be considered
for ease of installation, service, and remodeling.
6. Additional Support Areas for Linear
Accelerator:
a. Mold room with exhaust hood
and handwashing facility.
b. Block
room with storage. The block room may be combined with the mold room.
7. Additional Support Areas for
Cobalt Room:
H. General
Support Areas. The following areas shall be provided unless they are accessible
from other areas such as imaging:
1. A
stretcher holding area adjacent to the treatment rooms, screened for privacy
which may be combined with a seating area for outpatients;
2. Exam rooms as specified by the functional
program. Each shall be a minimum of 120square feet and equipped with a
handwashing station;
3. Darkroom
convenient to the treatment room(s) and the quality control area. Where
daylight processing is used, the darkroom may be minimal for emergency use. If
automatic film processors are used, a receptacle of adequate size with hot and
cold water for cleaning the processor racks shall be provided either in the
darkroom or nearby;
4. Patient
gowning area with provision for safe storage of valuables and clothing. At
least one space should be large enough for staff- assisted dressing;
5. Business office and/or reception/control
area;
6. Housekeeping room equipped
with service sink or floor receptor and large enough for equipment or supplies
storage;
7. Image file area;
and
8. A storage area for
unprocessed media.
I.
Optional Support Area. The following areas may be required by the functional
program:
1. Quality control area with view
boxes illuminated to provide light of the same color value and
intensity;
2. Computer control area
normally located just outside the entry to the treatment room(s);
3. Dosimetry equipment area;
4. Hypothermia room (may be combined with an
exam room);
5. Consultation
room;
6. Oncologist's office (may
be combined with consultation room);
7. Physicist's office (may be combined with
treatment planning);
8. Treatment
planning and record room; and
9.
Work station/nutrition station.
SECTION 54
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
MOBILE, TRANSPORTABLE, AND RELOCATABLE UNITS.
A. General. This section applies to mobile,
transportable, and relocatable structures.
B. Definitions.
1. Mobile Unit - Any premanufactured
structure, trailer, or self-propelled unit equipped with a chassis on wheels
and intended to provide medical services on a temporary basis.
2. Transportable Unit - Any premanufactured
structure or trailer, equipped with a chassis on wheels, intended to provide
medical services on an extended basis.
3. Relocatable Unit - Any structure, not on
wheels, built to be relocated at any time and provide medical
services.
C. General
Considerations.
1. Classifications. These
facilities shall be classified as either a small outpatient facility, large
outpatient facility, ambulatory surgery center, or a hospital based upon the
definitions provided in the Rules, the program functional and construction
type.
2. Applicable Requirements.
Facilities classified as a small outpatient clinic shall be designed in
accordance with the requirements stipulated in Section 75, Physical Facilities,
Outpatient Care Facilities. Facilities classified as a large outpatient
facility shall be designed in accordance with the requirements stipulated in
item F. of Section 75, Physical Facilities, Outpatient Care Facilities.
Facilities classified as a hospital shall be designed in accordance with the
requirements stipulated in Section 43, Physical Facilities.
3. These requirements shall be applicable to
mobile, transportable, and relocatable structures, when such structures are
used to provide shared medical services on an extended or a temporary
basis.
4. When any mobile unit,
transportable and relocatable unit(s) are situated in a fixed location and
rendered immobile they shall be classified and designed as a health care
facility.
D. Common
Elements for Mobile, Transportable, and Relocatable Units.
1. Site Conditions.
a. Access for the unit to arrive shall be
taken into consideration for space planning. Turning radius of the vehicles,
slopes of the approach (six (6) percent maximum), and existing conditions shall
be addressed.
b. Gauss fields of
various strengths of magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) units shall be considered
for the environmental effect on the field homogeneity and vice versa. Radio
frequency interference shall be considered when planning the site.
c. Sites shall be provided with properly
sized power, including emergency power, water, waste, telephone, and fire alarm
connections.
d. Site shall have
level concrete pads or piers and be designed for the structural loads of the
facility.
e. Site utilizing MRI
systems shall consider providing adequate access for cryogen-servicing of the
magnet. Storage of dewars also shall be included in space planning.
f. It is recommended that each site provide a
covered walkway or enclosure to ensure patient safety from the outside
elements.
g. Diesel exhaust of the
tractor and/or unit generator shall be 25feet away from the fresh air intake of
the facility.
h. Each facility
shall provide a means of preventing unit movement, either by blocking the
wheels or by providing pad anchors.
i. Sites shall provide hazard-free patient
drop-off zones and adequate parking.
j. The facility shall provide waiting space
for patient privacy and patient and staff toilets as close to the unit docking
area as possible.
k. Each site
shall provide access to the unit for wheelchair/stretcher patients.
l. Mobile units shall be provided with
handwashing stations unless each site can provide handwashing stations within a
25foot proximity to the unit. Transportable and relocatable units shall be
provided with handwashing stations.
E. General Standards for Details and Finishes
for Unit Construction.
1. Horizontal sliding
doors and power-operated doors shall comply with NFPA 101.
2. Units shall be permitted a single means of
egress as permitted by NFPA 101.
3.
All glazing in doors shall be safety or wire glass.
4. Units shall be equipped with fire
detection and alarm systems. In relocatable and transportable units these
systems shall be connected to the central fire alarm system.
5. Radiation protection for X-ray and gamma
ray installations shall be in accordance with Arkansas Rules and Regulations
for Control of Sources of Ionizing Radiation.
6. Interior finish materials shall be class A
as defined in NFPA 101.
7. Textile
materials having a napped, tufted, looped, woven, nonwoven, or similar surface
shall be permitted on walls and ceilings provided such materials have a class A
rating and rooms or areas are protected by an automatic extinguishment or
sprinkler system.
8. Fire retardant
coatings shall be permitted in accordance with NFPA 101.
9. Curtains and draperies shall be
noncombustible or flame retardant and shall pass both the large and small scale
tests required by NFPA 101. Fire retardant coatings shall be permitted in
accordance with NFPA 101.
F. Mechanical Standards.
1. Air conditioning, heating, ventilating,
ductwork, and related equipment shall be installed in accordance with NFPA 90A,
Standard for the Installation of Air Conditioning and Ventilation
systems.
2. Plumbing Standards.
a. Plumbing and other piping systems shall be
installed in accordance with the Arkansas State Plumbing Code.
b. Mobile units, requiring sinks, shall not
be required to be vented through the roof. Ventilation of waste lines shall be
permitted to be vented through the sidewalls or other acceptable locations.
Transportable and relocatable units shall be vented through the roof per model
plumbing codes.
c. Backflow
prevention shall be installed at the point of water connection on the
unit.
d. Medical gases and suction
systems, if installed, shall be in accordance with NFPA
99.
G.
Electrical Standards
1. All electrical
material and equipment, including conductors, controls, and signaling devices,
shall be installed in compliance with applicable section of NFPA 70 and NFPA 99
and shall be listed as complying with available standards of listing agencies
or other similar established standards where such standards are
required.
2. The electrical
installations, including alarm, nurse call, and communication systems, shall be
tested to demonstrate that equipment installation and operation is appropriate
and functional. A written record of performance tests on special electrical
systems and equipment shall show compliance with applicable codes and
standards.
3. Data processing
and/or automated laboratory or diagnostic equipment, if provided, may require
safeguards from power line disturbances.
4. Main switchboards shall be located in an
area separate from plumbing and mechanical equipment and shall be accessible to
authorized persons only. Switchboards shall be convenient for use, readily
accessible for maintenance, away from traffic lanes, and located in dry,
ventilated spaces free of corrosive or explosive fumes, gases, or any flammable
material. Overload protective devices shall operate properly in ambient room
temperatures.
5. Panelboards
serving normal lighting and appliance circuits shall be located on the same
level as the circuits they serve.
6. Lighting shall be engineered to the
specific application.
7. The
Illuminating Engineering Society of North America (IES) has developed
recommended lighting levels for health care facilities. The reader should refer
to the IES Handbook (1993).
8.
Approaches to buildings and parking lots and all occupied spaces shall have
fixtures for lighting that can be illuminated as necessary.
9. Consideration should be given to the
special needs the elderly. Excessive contrast in lighting levels that make
effective sight adaptation difficult should be minimized.
10. A portable or fixed examination light
shall be provided for examination, treatment, and trauma rooms.
11. Duplex grounded-type receptacles
(convenience outlets) shall be installed in all areas in sufficient quantities
for tasks to be performed as needed. Each examination and work table shall have
access to a minimum of two duplex receptacles.
12. At inhalation anesthetizing locations,
all electrical equipment and devices, receptacles, and wiring shall comply with
applicable sections of NFPA 99 and NFPA 70.
13. Fixed and mobile x-ray equipment
installations shall conform to articles 517 and 660 of NPFA 70.
14. Emergency lighting and power shall be
provided for in accordance with NFPA 99, NFPA 101, AND NFPA 110.
15. The fire alarm system shall be as
described in NFPA 101 AND WHERE APPLICABLE NFPA 72.
16. Terminating devices for
telecommunications and information systems wiring shall be located on the unit
that the terminating devices serve. These terminating devices shall be
accessible to authorized personnel only.
17. Special air conditioning and voltage
regulation shall be provided when recommended by the manufacturer.
SECTION 55
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, LABORATORY SERVICES.
A. Facilities necessary for providing
laboratory services described in the narrative program shall be provided. The
laboratory shall be constructed, arranged and maintained to ensure adequate
space, ventilation and utilities necessary for conducting all phases required
of testing in accordance with current CLIA regulations refer to Section
19.
B. Specimen collection
facilities shall be provided. These facilities may be located outside the
laboratory suite. The blood collection area shall have a work counter, space
for patient seating, and handwashing facilities. Urine and feces collection
room(s) shall be equipped with a water closet and a lavatory.
C. Provisions shall be made for safety from
physical, chemical and biological hazards.
There shall be eye flushing devices, appropriate storage of
flammable liquids, emergency spill kit(s) and fire extinguishers as required by
NFPA 99.
E. Locker and
toilet facilities for laboratory staff shall be located convenient to the
laboratory area.
SECTION
56
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, REHABILITATION THERAPY
DEPARTMENT.
A. Common Elements. Each
rehabilitative therapy department shall include the following, which may be
shared or provided as separate units for each service:
1. Office and clerical space with provisions
for filing and retrieval of patient records.
2. Reception and control station(s) with
visual control of waiting and activities area. (This may be combined with
office and clerical space.)
3.
Patient waiting area(s) out of traffic with provision for wheelchair
patients.
4. Patient toilets with
handwashing stations accessible to wheelchair patients.
5. Space(s) for storing wheelchairs and
stretchers out of traffic while patients are using the services. These spaces
may be separate from the service area but shall be conveniently
located.
6. A conveniently
accessible housekeeping room and service sink for housekeeping use.
7. Locking closets or cabinets within the
vicinity of each work area for securing staff personal effects.
8. Convenient access to toilets and
lockers.
9. Access to a
demonstration/conference room.
10.
Lockable storage for medications.
B. Physical Therapy. If physical therapy is
part of the service, the following at least, shall be included:
1. Individual treatment area(s) with privacy
screens or curtains. Each such space shall have not less than 70 square feet of
clear floor area.
2. Handwashing
stations for staff either within or at each treatment space (one handwashing
station may serve several stations).
3. Exercise area and facilities.
4. Clean linen and towel storage.
5. Storage for equipment and
supplies.
6. Separate storage for
soiled items.
7. Patient change
area. (If required by the functional program.)
C. Occupational Therapy. If this service is
provided, at least the following shall be included:
1. Work areas and counters suitable for
wheelchair access.
2. Handwashing
stations.
3. Storage for supplies
and equipment.
4. An area for daily
living activities shall be provided. It shall contain an area for a bed,
kitchen counter with appliances and sink, bathroom, and a
table/chair.
D.
Prosthetics and Orthotics. If this service is provided, at least, the following
shall be included:
1. Work space for
technicians;
2. Space for
evaluating and fitting, with provisions for privacy;
3. Space for equipment, supplies and
storage.
E. Recreation
Therapy. NOTE: Recreation therapy assists patients in the development and
maintenance of community living skills through the use of leisure-time activity
tasks. These activities may occur in a recreation therapy department, in
specialized facilities (e.g., gymnasium), multipurpose space in other areas
(e.g., the nursing unit), or outdoors. If this service is provided, at least,
the following shall be included:
1. Activity
areas suitable for wheelchair access;
2. Handwashing stations if required by the
program;
3. Storage for supplies
and equipment;
4. Secured storage
for supplies and equipment potentially harmful;
5. Remote electrical switching for equipment
potentially harmful.
F.
Speech, Hearing, and Audio Therapy. If this service is provided, at least, the
following shall be included:
1. Space for
evaluation and treatment of patients. The space shall be protected with
acoustical treatment of walls and finishes.
2. Space for equipment storage and
supplies.
G. Respiratory
Care. If respiratory care is part of the service, the following, at least,
shall be included as a minimum:
1. Storage of
equipment and supplies.
a. Space and utilities
for cleaning and sanitizing equipment. Provide physical separation of the space
for receiving and cleaning soiled materials from the space for storage of clean
equipment and supplies. Appropriate local exhaust ventilation shall be provided
if glutaraldehyde or other noxious disinfectants are used in the
cleaning.
b. If respiratory
services, such as testing and demonstration for outpatients are part of the
program, additional facilities and equipment shall be provided as necessary for
the appropriate function of the service, including but not limited to:
1) Patient waiting area with provision for
wheelchairs;
2) Reception and
control station;
3) Patient toilets
and handwashing facilities;
4)
Room(s) for patient education and demonstration;
2. Cough-Inducing and Aerosol-Generating
Procedures. All cough-inducing procedures performed on patients who may have
suspected or active infectious Mycobacterium tuberculosis shall be performed in
rooms that meets the requirements for airborne infection
control.
SECTION
57
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, MORGUE AND NECROPSY.
These facilities shall be directly accessible to an outside
entrance and shall be located to avoid movement of bodies through public areas.
The following elements shall be provided when autopsies are performed within
the hospital:
A. Refrigerated
facilities for body-holding;
B.
Autopsy Room. This room shall contain:
1. Work
counter with sink equipped for handwashing;
2. Storage space for supplies, equipment, and
specimens;
3. Autopsy
table;
4. A deep sink for washing
of specimens;
5. A housekeeping
service sink or receptor for cleanup and housekeeping.
NOTE: If autopsies are performed outside the facility, only a
well ventilated, temperature- controlled, body-holding room need be
provided.
SECTION
58
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, PHARMACY.
The size and type of services to be provided in the pharmacy
can largely depend upon the type of medication distribution system used, number
of patients to be served, and extent of shared or purchased services. This
shall be described in the functional program. The pharmacy room or suite shall
be located for convenient access, staff control, and security. Facilities and
equipment shall be as necessary to commodate the functions of the program. See
Section 16, Pharmacy, for additional requirements. (Satellite facilities, if
provided, shall include those items required by the program.) As a minimum, the
following elements shall be included:
A. Dispensing.
1. A pickup and receiving area.
2. An area for reviewing and
recording.
3. An extemporaneous
compounding area that includes a sink and sufficient counter space for
medication preparation.
4. Work
counters and space for automated and manual dispensing activities.
5. An area for temporary storage, exchange,
and restocking of carts.
6.
Security provisions for medications and personnel in the dispensing counter
area.
B. Manufacturing.
1. A bulk compounding area.
2. Provisions for packaging and
labeling.
3. A quality control
area.
C. Storage (may be
cabinets, shelves, and/or separate rooms or closets).
1. Bulk storage.
2. Active storage.
3. Refrigerated storage.
4. Volatile fluids and alcohol storage
constructed according to applicable fire safety codes for the substances
involved.
5. Double-locked storage
for controlled substances.
6.
Storage for general supplies and equipment not in use.
D. Administration.
1. An area for education and training (may be
in a multipurpose room shared with other departments).
2. An area for patient counseling and
instruction (may be in a room separate from the pharmacy).
3. A separate area for office
functions.
E. Other.
1. Handwashing stations shall be provided
within each separate room where open medication is handled and readily
accessible.
2. Provide for
convenient access to toilet and locker.
3. If unit dose procedure is used, provide
additional space and equipment for supplies, packaging, labeling, and storage,
as well as for the carts.
4. If IV
solutions are prepared in the pharmacy, provide a sterile work area with a
laminar-flow work station designed for product protection. The laminar-flow
system shall include a nonhydroscopic filter (HEPA) rated at 99.97 percent, as
tested by DOP tests and have a visible pressure gauge for detection of filter
leaks or defects.
5. Hoods used for
chemotherapy shall be 100percent exhausted to the exterior.
6. As a minimum the partitions enclosing the
pharmacy shall extend from the floor to the deck above, with gypsum board on
both sides of metal studs.
SECTION 59
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
DIETARY FACILITIES.
Construction, equipment, and installation shall comply with the
standards specified in FDA
U.S. Public Health Service Food Code. Food service facilities
shall be designed and equipped to meet the requirements of the functional
program. These may consist of an onsite conventional food preparing system, a
convenience food service system, or an appropriate combination of the two. The
following shall be provided:
A.
Receiving/Control Areas. Provide an area for the receiving and control of
incoming dietary supplies. This area shall be separated from the general
receiving area and shall contain the following: a control station, and a
breakout for loading, uncrating, and weighing supplies;
B. Storage Spaces. A minimum of four days'
supplies shall be stocked. (In remote areas, this number may be increased to
accommodate length of delivery in emergencies). All food shall be stored clear
of the floor. Lowest shelf shall not be less than 12 inches above the floor or
shall be closed in and sealed tight for ease of cleaning;
C. Cleaning supplies storage. Provide a
separate storage room for the storage of non- food items such as cleaning
supplies that might contaminate edibles.
D. Food Preparation Facilities. Conventional
food preparation systems shall have adequate space and equipment for preparing,
cooking, and baking. Convenience food preparation systems shall have adequate
space for equipment for thawing, portioning, cooking, and/or baking. These
areas shall be as close as possible to the user (i.e., tray assembly and
dining);
E. Assembly and
Distribution Areas. A patient tray assembly area shall be located within close
proximity to the food preparation and distribution areas;
F. Food Service Carts. A cart distribution
area shall provide space for storage, loading, distribution, receiving, and
sanitizing of food service carts. The cart traffic shall be designed to
eliminate any danger of cross circulation between outgoing food carts and
incoming, soiled carts, and the cleaning and sanitizing process. Cart
circulation shall not traffic through food processing areas;
G. Handwashing Stations. These shall be
operable without the use of hands and be readily accessible at locations
throughout the dietary department;
H. Dining Area. There shall be dining space
for ambulatory patients, staff, and visitors which is separate from the food
preparation and distribution areas;
I. Area for Receiving, Scraping, and Sorting
Soiled Tableware. Area shall be adjacent to ware washing and separate from food
preparation areas. A handwashing fixture shall be conveniently
available;
J. Dishwashing Space. An
area shall be located in a room separate from food preparation and serving
areas. Commercial-type dishwashing equipment shall be provided. Clean and
soiled dish areas shall be separated with an opening in the partition between
the clean and soiled dish area large enough for the dishwasher and ventilation
of the area. The clean dish area may be either a separate room or a portion of
the kitchen. A lavatory shall be conveniently available. The soiled dish area
shall be so located as to prevent soiled dishes from being carried through the
food preparation area;
K. Ware
Washing Facilities. They shall be designed to prevent contamination of clean
wares with soiled wares through cross-traffic. The clean wares should be
transferred for storage or use in the dining area without having to pass
through food preparation areas;
L.
Pot Washing Facilities including multi-compartmented sinks of adequate size for
intended use shall be provided convenient to using service. Supplemental heat
for hot water to clean pots and pans may be by booster heater or by steam
jet.
M. Waste Storage Room. A food
waste storage room shall be conveniently located to the food preparation and
ware washing areas but not within the food preparation area.
It shall have direct access to the hospital's waste collection
and disposal facilities.
N.
Storage Rooms and Areas. A room for cans, carts, mobile tray conveyors, and
cleaning and sanitizing carts shall be provided. There shall be a separate
storage room for the storage of non-food items that might contaminate edibles
(i.e., cleaning supplies). A separate space or room for the storage of cooking
wares, extra trays, flatware, plastic and paper products, and portable
equipment is required;
O. Toilets
and Locker Spaces. Lockers, if provided in the dietary facility, shall be for
the exclusive use of the dietary staff. Toilets and lockers shall not open
directly into the food preparation areas, but shall be in close proximity to
them;
P. Office(s). Dietary service
manager/supervisor offices shall be conveniently located for visual control of
receiving area and food preparation areas;
Q. Environmental Closet. A closet shall be
provided for the exclusive use of the dietary department to contain a floor
sink and space for mops, pails, and supplies. Where hot water or steam is used
for general cleaning, additional space within the room shall be provided for
the storage of hoses and nozzles;
R. Ice Making Equipment. Equipment shall be
convenient for service and easily cleaned. It shall be provided for both drinks
(self-dispensing equipment), and for general use (storage bin type
equipment);
S. Commissary or
Contract Services from Other Areas. If a service is used, above items may be
reduced as appropriate. The process of food delivery shall insure freshness,
retention of hot and cold, and avoidance of contamination. If delivery is from
outside sources, protection against weather shall be provided. Provisions shall
be made for thorough cleaning and sanitizing of equipment to avoid mix of
soiled and clean equipment;
T.
Equipment. Mechanical devices shall be heavy duty, suitable for intended use
and easily cleaned. Movable equipment shall have heavy duty locking casters. If
equipment is to have fixed utility connections, it shall not be equipped with
casters. Walk-in coolers, refrigerators, and freezers shall be insulated at
floor, walls and top. Coolers and refrigerators shall be capable of maintaining
a temperature down to freezing. Freezers shall be capable of maintaining a
temperature of 20°below zero Fahrenheit. Coolers, refrigerators, and
freezers shall be thermostatically controlled to maintain desired temperature
settings in increments of two degrees or less. Interior temperatures shall be
visible from the exterior. Controls may include audible and visible high and
low temperature alarm. Time of alarm shall be automatically recorded. Walk-in
units may be lockable from outside but shall have release mechanism for exit
from inside at all times. Interior shall be lighted. All shelving shall be
corrosion resistant, easily cleaned, and constructed and anchored to support a
loading of at least 100pounds per linear foot. All cooking equipment shall be
equipped with automatic shut off devices to prevent excessive heat buildup.
Under counter conduits, piping, and drains shall be arranged to not interfere
with cleaning of floor below or of the equipment;
SECTION 60
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
ADMINISTRATION AND PUBLIC AREAS.
The following areas shall be provided:
A. Facility entrance, at grade level,
sheltered from the weather, and able to accommodate wheelchairs;
B. Lobby, which shall include:
1. Reception and information counter or
desk;
2. Waiting
space(s);
3. Public toilet
facilities (one for each sex);
4.
Public telephone(s);
5. Drinking
fountain(s);
C. Interview
space(s) for private interviews relating to social service, credit, and
admissions;
D. General or
individual office(s) for business transactions, medical and financial records,
and administrative and professional staffs;
E. Multipurpose room(s) with provisions for
the use of visual aids for conferences, meetings, and health education. One
multipurpose room may be shared by several services;
F. Storage for office equipment and supplies;
and
G. Staff toilet
facilities.
SECTION 61
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, HEALTH INFORMATION UNIT.
The following rooms and areas shall be provided:
A. Health Information Director's office or
space;
B. Review and dictating
room(s) or spaces;
C. Work area for
sorting, recording, or microfilming records;
D. Medical record storage (Refer to Section
61A.26); and
Rooms for patient medical records and archived patient medical
records that remain onsite shall be kept in a one hour fire rated enclosure or
protected by a sprinkler system; protected by a security system and a smoke
detection system. Circulating records at the nurses' station or in active
working areas are excluded from this requirement. The records shall be
protected against undue destruction from dust, vermin, water, etc.
SECTION 62
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, CENTRAL MEDICAL AND SURGICAL SUPPLY DEPARTMENT.
The following areas shall be provided:
A. Separate Soiled and Clean Work Areas
1. Soiled Workroom. This room shall be
physically separated from all other areas of the department. Work space shall
be provided to handle the cleaning and initial sterilization/disinfection of
all medical/surgical instruments and equipment, work tables, sinks, flush-type
devices, and washer/sterilizer decontaminators. Passthrough doors and
washer/sterilizer decontaminators shall deliver into clean processing
area/workrooms.
2. Clean
Assembly/Workroom. This workroom shall contain handwashing stations, workspace,
and equipment for terminal sterilizing of medical and surgical equipment and
supplies. Clean and soiled work areas shall be physically separated.
B. Storage Areas
Clean/Sterile Medical/Surgical Supplies. A room shall be
provided for the breakdown of clean/sterile bulk supplies. Storage for packs
etc., shall include provisions for ventilation, humidity, and temperature
control.
C.
Administrative/Changing Room
If required by the functional program, this room shall be
separate from all other areas and provide for staff to change from street
clothes into work attire. Lockers, sink, and showers shall be made available
within the immediate vicinity of the department.
D. Storage Room for Patient Care and
Distribution Carts
This area shall be adjacent, easily available to clean and
sterile storage, and close to main distribution point to keep traffic to a
minimum and to ease work flow.
SECTION 63
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
CENTRAL SUPPLY AND RECEIVING.
In addition to supply facilities in individual departments, a
central storage area shall also be provided. General stores may be located in a
separate building onsite with provisions for protection against inclement
weather during transfer of supplies. The following shall be provided:
A. Off-street unloading facilities;
B. Receiving area;
C. General Storage Room(s). General storage
rooms(s) with a total area of not less than 20 feet per inpatient bed shall be
provided. Storage may be in separate, concentrated areas within the institution
or in one or more individual buildings onsite. A portion of this storage may be
provided offsite; and
D. Additional
Storage Room(s). Additional storage areas for outpatient facilities shall be
provided in an amount not less than five percent of the total area of the
outpatient facilities. This may be combined with and in addition to the general
stores or be located in a central area within the outpatient department. A
portion of this storage may be provided offsite.
SECTION 64
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, LINEN
SERVICES.
Each facility shall have provisions for storing and processing
of clean and soiled linen for appropriate patient care. Processing may be done
within the facility, in a separate building on- or off-site, or in a commercial
or shared laundry.
A. Facility
Processing. Facilities and equipment shall be as required for cost effective
operation as described in the functional program. At a minimum, the following
elements shall be included:
1. A separate room
for receiving and holding soiled linen until ready for pickup or
processing.
2. A central, clean
linen storage and issuing room(s), in addition to the linen storage required at
individual patient units.
3. Cart
storage area(s) for separate parking of clean- and soiled-linen carts out of
traffic.
4. A clean linen
inspection and mending room or area. If not provided elsewhere, a clean linen
inspection, delinting, folding, assembly and packaging area should be provided
as part of the linen services. Mending should be provided for in the linen
services department. A space for tables, shelving, and storage should be
provided.
5. Handwashing stations
in each area where unbagged, soiled linen is handled.
B. If linen is processed in a laundry
facility that is not part of the licensed facility provisions shall also be
made for:
1. A service entrance, protected
from inclement weather, for loading and unloading of linen.
2. Control station for pickup and
receiving.
3. The hospital is
responsible to insure the commercial laundry does comply with Section 42,
Physical Environment.
C.
If linen is processed in a laundry facility that is part of the licensed
facility, the following shall be provided in addition to that of Section 64 A:
1. A receiving, holding, and sorting room for
control and distribution of soiled linen. Discharge from soiled linen chutes
may be received within this room or in a separate room.
2. Laundry processing room with commercial
type equipment that can process at least a seven-day supply within the regular
scheduled workweek. This may require a capacity for processing a seven-day
supply in a 40-hour week.
3.
Storage for laundry supplies.
4.
Employee handwashing stations in each room where clean or soiled linen is
processed and handled.
5.
Arrangement of equipment that will permit an orderly workflow and minimize
cross-traffic that might mix clean and soiled operations.
6. Conveniently accessible staff lockers,
showers, and lounge.
SECTION
65
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, CLEANING AND SANITIZING CARTS,
EMPLOYEE FACILITIES AND ENVIRONMENTAL CLOSETS.
A. Facilities shall be provided to clean and
sanitize carts serving the central medical and surgical supply department,
dietary facilities, and linen services. These may be centralized or
departmentalized or offsite as required by the written narrative.
B. Lockers, lounges, toilets, etc. should be
provided for employees and volunteers. These should be in addition to, and
separate from, those required for medical staff and public.
C. Each environmental services closet shall
contain a floor receptor and/or services sink and storage space for
environmental services equipment (cart, bucket, etc.) and supplies. There shall
be at least one environmental services closet for each
floor.
SECTION 66
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, ENGINEERING SERVICE AND EQUIPMENT AREAS.
Space shall be included in all mechanical and electrical
equipment rooms for proper maintenance of equipment. Provisions shall also be
made to provide for equipment removal and replacement. The following shall be
provided:
A. Boilers, mechanical
equipment, and electrical equipment shall be located in ventilated rooms or
buildings except as noted below:
1. Rooftop
air conditioning and ventilation equipment installed in weatherproof
housings;
2. Standby generators
where the engine and appropriate accessories (i.e., batteries) are properly
heated and enclosed in a weatherproof housing as recommended by the
manufacturer;
3. Cooling towers and
heat rejection equipment;
4.
Electrical transformers and switchgear where required to serve the facility and
where installed in a weatherproof housing;
5. Medical gas parks and equipment;
6. Air cooled chillers where installed in a
weatherproof housing;
7. Waste
processing equipment. Site lighting, post indicator valves, and other equipment
normally installed on the exterior of the building;
8. Site lighting, post indicator valves, and
other equipment normally installed on the exterior of the building;
and
9. Exhaust fans.
B. Engineer's office with file
space and provisions for secured storage of facility drawings, records,
manuals, etc. The engineer's office shall be a separate and distinct space
dedicated for the purpose;
C.
General maintenance shop(s) for repair and maintenance as required by the
functional program;
D. Storage room
for building maintenance supplies. Storage for solvents and flammable liquids
shall comply with applicable NFPA codes;
E. Yard equipment and supply storage shall be
located so equipment may be moved directly to exterior without interfering with
other work;
F. Separate area or
room specifically for storage, repair, and testing of electronic and other
medical equipment. The amount of space and type of utilities will vary with the
type of equipment involved and types of outside contracts used.
SECTION 67
: PHYSICAL
FACILITIES, WASTE PROCESSING SERVICES.
A. Hazardous Waste and Antineoplastic Agent
Disposal. The facility shall have policies and procedures for the
identification, segregation, labeling, storage, transport and disposal of
hazardous waste. The policies and procedures shall conform with the latest
edition of Hazardous Waste Management Regulation 23, Arkansas Department of
Environmental Quality, Little Rock, Arkansas. Within the facility, hazardous
waste, especially antineoplastic agents, shall be labeled in a manner that it
shall be easily recognized from all other waste. The facility shall compile a
list of all antineoplastic agents used in the facility. The facility shall have
policies and procedures for the cleanup of spills, decontamination and
treatment of personnel exposed to hazardous waste and antineoplastic
agents.
B. Radioactive Waste
Disposal. The facility shall have policies and procedures for the
identification, segregation, labeling, storage, transport and disposal of
radioactive waste and materials. All policies and procedures shall conform to
the most current Rules and Regulations for Control of Sources of Ionizing
Radiation, Arkansas Department of Health, Little Rock, Arkansas. The facility
shall maintain records of all radioactive waste and materials which have been
disposed.
C. Regulated Medical
Waste (Infectious Waste) Disposal. The facility shall have policies and
procedures for the identification, segregation, labeling, storage, transport
and disposal of Regulated Medical Waste. All policies and procedures shall
conform to the latest edition of the. The facility shall have policies and
procedures for the cleanup of spills, and for decontamination and treatment of
personnel exposed to regulated medical waste.
D. Solid Waste Disposal (Non-Infectious
Waste). The facility shall have policies and procedures for the identification,
segregation, labeling, storage, transport and disposal of solid waste. Policies
and procedures shall conform with the latest edition of the Solid Waste
Management Regulation 22, Arkansas Department of Environmental Quality, Little
Rock, Arkansas.
E. Nuclear Waste
Disposal: The facility shall have policies and procedures for the
identification, segregation, labeling, storage, transport and disposal of
nuclear waste. All policies and procedures shall conform to the Code of Federal
Regulations; title X, parts 20 and 35, concerning the handling and disposal of
nuclear materials in health care facilities.
F. Containers of hazardous and antineoplastic
agent waste, radioactive waste, and regulated medical waste shall be closed
except when receiving waste. Containers have swinging lids or lids that are
easily contaminated are prohibited. Open containers shall be emptied between
patients and the container disinfected. Containers shall be kept closed except
when receiving waste.
G. Other
Waste. The facility shall have policies and procedures for the identification,
segregation, labeling, storage, transport, and disposal of any waste not
specifically mentioned in this section.
SECTION 68
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
DETAILS AND FINISHES.
All details for alteration or expansion projects as well as for
new construction shall comply with the following.
A. Details.
1. Compartmentation, exits, automatic
extinguishing systems, and other details relating to fire prevention and fire
protection shall comply with requirements listed in the NFPA referenced codes
and be shown on the Fire Protection Plan. The Fire Safety Evaluation System
(FSES) is an acceptable means of determining Life Safety Code
compliance.
2. Minimum corridor
width shall be eight feet clear without projections. Increased width shall be
provided at elevator lobbies and other places where conditions may demand more
clearance. All service or administrative corridors shall not be less than
44inches in width. Doors to patient rooms shall be a minimum door size of three
feet eight inches wide and seven feet high to provide clearance for movement of
beds and other equipment. Alternatively, NFPA 101 shall be deemed to meet
requirements.
3. Items such as
drinking fountains, telephone booths, and vending machines, shall be located so
as not to project into exit access corridors. Incidental items shall be
determined by the licensing agency.
4. Rooms containing bathtubs, sitz baths,
showers, and water closets, subject to occupancy by patients, shall be equipped
with doors and hardware which shall permit access from the outside in any
emergency.
5. All doors between
corridors, rooms, or spaces subject to occupancy, except elevator doors, shall
be of the swing type. Openings to showers, baths, patient toilets, ICU patient
compartments with the breakaway feature, and other such areas not leading to
fire exits shall be exempt from this standard.
6. All patient room doors located on exit
access corridors shall have positive latching hardware.
7. Doors to patients' toilet rooms and other
rooms needing access for wheelchairs shall have a minimum width of 36inches for
new facilities.
Alcoves and similar spaces which generally do not require doors
are excluded from this requirement.
8 Windows shall be designed so that persons cannot accidentally
fall out of them when they are open or shall be provided with security screens.
Operation of windows shall be restricted to inhibit possible escape or suicide.
Where the operation of windows or vents require the use of tools or keys, tools
or keys shall be on the same floor and easily accessible to staff.
9. Glass doors, lights,
sidelights, borrowed lights, and windows located within 12inches of a door jamb
(with a bottom frame height of less than 60inches above the finished floor)
shall be constructed of safety glass, wired glass, or plastic, break resistant
material that creates no dangerous cutting edges when broken. Similar materials
shall be used for wall openings in active areas such as recreation rooms and
exercise rooms, unless otherwise required for fire safety. Safety
glass-tempered or plastic glazing materials shall be used for shower doors and
bath enclosures. Plastic and similar materials used for glazing shall comply
with the flame- spread ratings of NFPA 101. Safety glass or plastic glazing
materials, as noted above, shall also be used for interior windows and doors,
including those in pediatric and psychiatric unit corridors. In renovation
projects, only glazing within 18inches of the floor shall be changed to safety
glass, wire glass, or plastic, breakresistant material. NFPA 101 contains
additional requirements for glazing in exit corridors, etc., especially in
buildings without sprinkler systems.
10. Where labeled fire doors are required,
these shall be certified by an independent test laboratory as meeting the
construction requirements equal to those for fire in NFPA Standard 80.
Reference to a labeled door shall be construed to include labeled frame and
hardware.
11 Trash chutes shall be in accordance with NFPA standard 82.
In addition, linen and refuse chutes shall meet or exceed the following
requirements:
a. Service openings to
chutes shall not be located in corridors or passageways but shall be located in
a room which complies with NFPA 101;
b. Service openings to chutes shall have
approved self-closing Class B one and one-half hour labeled fire
doors;
c. Minimum cross-sectional
dimensions of gravity chutes shall not be less than two feet;
d. Chutes shall discharge directly into
collection rooms separate from incinerator, laundry, or other services.
Separate collection rooms shall be provided for trash and for linen. Chute
discharge into collection rooms shall comply with NFPA 101;
e. Gravity chutes shall extend through the
roof with provisions for continuous ventilation as well as for fire and smoke
ventilation. Openings for fire and smoke ventilation shall have an effective
area of not less than that of the chute cross-section and shall be not less
than four (4) feet above the roof and not less than six (6) feet clear of other
vertical surfaces. Fire and smoke ventilating openings may be covered with
single strength sheet glass.
11. Dumbwaiters, conveyors, and material
handling systems shall comply with NFPA 101.
12. Thresholds and expansion joint covers
shall be installed flush with the floor surface to facilitate use of
wheelchairs and carts. Expansion and seismic joints shall be constructed to
restrict the passage of smoke.
13.
Grab bars shall be provided in all patients' toilets, showers, tubs, and sitz
baths. The bars shall have one and one-half inch clearance to walls and shall
have sufficient strength and anchorage to sustain a concentrated load of
250pounds.
14. Soap dishes, soap
dispensers and/or other devices shall be provided at showers, bath tubs, and
all handwashing stations except scrub sinks.
15. Location and arrangement of handwashing
stations shall permit proper use and operation. All sinks, except public
toilets, janitor closets, and sinks used by patients only, shall have foot,
knee, or wrist blade faucets. Particular care shall be given to the clearances
required for blade-type operating handles.
16. Mirrors shall not be installed at
handwashing fixtures in food preparation areas, nurseries, clean and sterile
supply areas, scrub sinks, or other areas where asepsis is essential.
Provisions for hand drying shall be included at all handwashing stations except
scrub sinks. Paper units shall be enclosed to protect against dust or soil and
to insure single unit dispensing.
17. Lavatories and handwashing stations shall
be securely anchored to withstand an applied downward vertical load of not less
than 250pounds on the front of the fixture.
18. Radiation protection requirements of
X-ray and gamma ray installations shall conform with Rules and Regulations for
Control of Sources of Ionizing Radiation, Arkansas Department of
Health.
19. The minimum ceiling
height shall be seven feet ten inches with the following exceptions:
a. Boiler rooms shall have ceiling clearances
not less than two feet six inches above the main boiler header and connecting
piping.
b. Ceilings in
radiographic, operating and delivery rooms, and other rooms containing
ceiling-mounted equipment or ceiling-mounted surgical light fixtures shall be
of sufficient height to accommodate the equipment or fixtures and their normal
movement.
c. Ceilings in corridors,
storage rooms, and toilet rooms shall be not less then seven feet eight inches
in height. Ceiling heights in small, normally unoccupied spaces may be
reduced.
d. Seclusion treatment
rooms shall have a minimum ceiling height of nine feet.
20. Recreation rooms, exercise rooms, and
similar spaces where impact noises may be generated shall not be located
directly over patient bed area, delivery or operating suites, unless special
provisions are made to minimize such noise.
21. Rooms containing heat-producing equipment
(such as boiler or heater rooms and laundries) shall be insulated and
ventilated to prevent any floor or partition surface from exceeding a
temperature of 10°Fahrenheit above ambient room temperature.
22. Noise reduction criteria shown in Table 2
of the Appendix shall apply to partition, floor, and ceiling construction in
patient areas. (Careful attention shall be given to penetrations.)
23. Approved fire extinguishers shall be
provided in locations throughout the building in accordance with NFPA Standard
No. 10. Extinguishers located in exit corridors shall be recessed.
24. Offsite buildings or freestanding
buildings used for storage of archived patient medical records shall be built
of noncombustible materials and provide security and smoke detection systems
for the records. Records shall be arranged in an accessible manner and stored
at least six inches above the floor. Records shall be protected against undue
destruction from dust, vermin, water, etc. X-ray film storage are not required
to meet the above requirements.
25.
Light fixtures shall be provided with protective covers in food preparation,
serving areas, and patient care and treatment spaces. Protective light fixture
covers are not required in corridors.
26. Minimum distance between patient room
windows and adjacent structures shall be 30 feet (new construction
only).
27. A panic bar releasing
device shall be provided for all required exit doors subject to patient traffic
(new construction only).
28. Doors
in smoke barrier partitions shall comply with NFPA 101.
29. Fire rated roof-ceiling assemblies shall
be listed with a nationally recognized laboratory.
30. Mechanical smoke door coordinators shall
not be used. Adjustable hydraulic closures or the full length header type shall
be used.
31. Corridor partitions,
smokestop partitions, horizontal exit partitions, exit enclosures, and fire
rated walls required to have protected openings shall be effectively and
permanently identified with signs or stenciling in a manner acceptable to
Health Facility Services. Such identification shall be above any decorative
ceiling and in concealed spaces.
B. Finishes.
1. Cubicle curtains and draperies shall be
noncombustible or rendered flame retardant and shall pass both the large and
small scale tests of NFPA Standard 701 and the requirements of NFPA 13 when
applicable.
2. Flame spread, fuel
contributed, smoke density, and critical radiant flux of finishes shall comply
with NFPA 101.
3. Floors in areas
and rooms in which anesthetic agents are stored or administered to patients
shall comply with NFPA Standard 99. Conductive flooring may be omitted in
anesthetizing areas where a written resolution is signed by the hospital board
stating that no flammable anesthetic agents shall be used and appropriate
notices are permanently and conspicuously affixed to the wall in each such area
and room.
4. Floor materials shall
be easily cleanable and have wear resistance appropriate for the location
involved. Floors in areas used for food preparation or food assembly shall be
water resistant and grease-proof. Joints in tile and similar material in such
areas shall be resistant to food acids. In all areas frequently subject to wet
cleaning methods, floor-materials shall not be physically affected by
germicidal and cleaning solutions. Floors that are subject to traffic while wet
(such as shower and bath areas, kitchens, and similar work areas) shall have a
non-slip surface. Any facility designed to install carpet shall have prior
approval from the Arkansas Department of Health. The prior approval in part
shall be contingent upon submission of a laboratory test report from an
approved independent laboratory indicating that the proposed carpet meets or
exceeds the requirements listed in NFPA 101 and agreement by the Department as
to the specific areas in which carpet is to be used. In all carpet
installations no rubber backings or rubber padding shall be permitted except in
cases where the carpet and backing are tested as an integral component and the
integral component meets the requirements listed in NFPA 101. Carpet shall not
be allowed in the following areas or rooms: operating rooms, delivery rooms,
emergency rooms, intensive care units, nursery, recovery, kitchens,
laboratories, LDR and LDRP rooms, clean and soiled holding/workrooms, and
isolation rooms. Operating rooms shall have a seamless floor.
5. Wall bases in kitchens, operating rooms,
soiled workrooms, and other areas which are frequently subject to wet cleaning
methods shall be made integral and coved with the floor, tightly sealed within
the wall, and constructed without voids that can harbor insects.
6. Wall finishes shall be washable. In the
vicinity of plumbing fixtures, shall be smooth and water resistant.
7. Floors and walls penetrated by pipes,
ducts, and conduits shall be tightly sealed to minimize entry of rodents and
insects.
8. Ceilings in
food-preparation and storage areas, shall be cleanable with routine
housekeeping equipment.
9.
Operating rooms, trauma rooms, delivery rooms for Caesarean sections, and
protective isolation rooms shall have ceilings with a smooth finish plaster or
gypsum board surface with a minimum of fissures equipped with access panels
where needed.
10. In psychiatric
patient rooms, toilets, and seclusion rooms, ceiling construction shall be
smooth finish plaster or gypsum board surface with a minimum of fissures.
Ceiling-mounted air and lighting devices shall be security type. Ceilingmounted
sprinkler heads shall be of the concealed type.
11. Ceilings shall be cleanable and in the
following areas shall be washable, waterproof, smooth finish plaster or gypsum
board or vinyl faced acoustic panels: cardiac cath labs, surgical suite
corridors, delivery suite corridors, central sterilization suite, autopsy
rooms, bacteriology, mycology, media preparation rooms, glass washing rooms
located in the labs, soiled holding rooms, soiled and clean utility rooms,
emergency suite-treatment rooms and trauma rooms.
12. Finished ceilings may be omitted in
mechanical, electrical, equipment spaces and shops.
13. Finished ceilings shall be provided for
corridors in patient areas.
14.
Sound sensitive areas such as neonatal intensive care may have special floor
and ceiling treatments.
SECTION 69
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
CONSTRUCTION, INCLUDING FIRE RESISTIVE REQUIREMENTS.
A. Design. Every building and every portion
thereof shall be designed and constructed to sustain all dead and live loads in
accordance with American Society of Civil Engineers, (ASCE), "Minimum Design
Loads for Buildings and Other Structures."
B. Foundations. Foundations shall rest on
natural solid bearing if a satisfactory bearing is available at reasonable
depths. Proper soil-bearing values shall be established in accordance with
recognized standards. If solid bearing is not encountered at practical depths,
the structure shall be supported on drive piles or drilled piers designed to
support the intended load without detrimental settlement, except that one story
buildings may rest on a fill designed by a soils engineer. When engineered fill
is used, site preparation and placement of fill shall be performed under the
direct full-time supervision of the soils engineer. The soils engineer shall
issue a final report on the compacted fill operation and certification of
compliance with the job specifications. All footings shall extend to a depth
not less than one foot below the estimated maximum frost line.
C. Construction.
1. Construction shall comply with the
applicable requirements of NFPA 101, and the Arkansas Fire Protection Code
Volumes I and II and Arkansas State Building Services, Minimum Standards and
Criteria - Accessibility for the Physically Disabled Standards.
NOTE: NFPA 101 generally covers fire/safety requirements only,
whereas most model codes also apply to structural elements. The fire/safety
items of NFPA 101 would take precedence over other codes in case of conflict.
In the event NFPA 101 does not specifically address a life safety requirement
found only in the Arkansas Fire Prevention Code, compliance with the
requirement is not mandatory. Appropriate application of each would minimize
problems. For example, some model codes require closers on all patient doors.
NFPA 101 recognizes the potential fire/safety problems of this requirement and
stipulates that if closers are used for patient room doors, smoke detectors
shall also be provided within each affected patient room.
2. For renovation projects, the extent of new
construction shall be determined by the licensing agency. Construction shall
comply with applicable requirements of NFPA 101.
D. Free-standing Buildings (For Patient Use).
Buildings of this element category are considered to be greater than 30feet
from the hospital or separated from the hospital by two-hour fire resistance
rated construction. Buildings housing non-sleeping patient areas shall comply
with NFPA 101.
E. Free-standing
Buildings. Separate free-standing buildings over 30 feet from an inpatient
facility housing the boiler plant, laundry, shops, or general storage shall be
built in accordance with applicable building codes for such
occupancy.
F. Interior Finishes.
Interior finish materials shall comply with the limitations as indicated in
NFPA 101. If a separate underlayment is used with any floor finish materials,
the underlayment and the finish material shall be tested as a unit. Tests shall
be performed by an approved independent testing laboratory.
G. Insulation Materials. Building insulation
materials, unless sealed on all sides and edges, shall have a flame spread
rating of 25or less and a smoke developed rating of 150 or less when tested in
accordance with NFPA 255.
H. Flood
Protection. Executive Order No 11296 was issued to minimize financial loss from
flood damage to facilities constructed with federal assistance. In accordance
with that order, possible flood effects shall be considered when selecting and
developing the site. Insofar as possible, new facilities shall not be located
on designated flood plains. Where this is unavoidable, consult with the Corps
of Engineers regional office for the latest applicable regulations pertaining
to flood insurance and protection measures that may be required.
I. Elevators. All hospitals having patient
facilities (such as bedrooms, dining rooms, or recreation areas) or critical
services (such as operating, delivery, diagnostic, or therapeutic) located on
other than the grade-level entrance floor shall have electric or hydraulic
elevators. Installation and testing of elevators shall comply with ANSI/ASME
A17.1 for new construction and ANSI/ASME A17.3 for existing facilities. (See
ASCE 793 for seismic design and control systems requirements for elevators.)
1. In the absence of an engineered traffic
study the following guidelines for number of elevators shall apply:
a. At least one hospital-type elevator shall
be installed when one to 59 patient beds are located on any floor other than
the main entrance floor.
b. At
least two hospital-type elevators shall be installed when 60 to 200 patient
beds are located on floors other than the main entrance floor, or where the
major inpatient serves are located on a floor other than those containing
patient beds. (Elevator service may be reduced for those floors providing only
partial inpatient services.)
c. At
least three hospital-type elevators shall be installed where 201to 350patent
beds are located on floors other than the main entrance floor, or where the
major inpatient services are located on a floor other than those containing
patient beds. (Elevator service may be reduced for those floors which provide
only partial inpatient services.)
d. For hospitals with more than 350 beds, the
number of elevators shall be determined from a study of the hospital plan and
the expected vertical transportation requirements.
2. Hospital-type elevator cars shall have
inside dimensions that accommodate a patient bed with attendants. Cars shall be
at least five feet eight inches wide by nine feet deep. Car doors shall have a
clear opening of not less than four feet wide and seven feet high. In
renovations, existing elevators that can accommodate patient beds used in the
facility will not be required to be increased in size.
NOTE: Additional elevators installed for visitors and material
handling may be smaller than noted above, within restrictions set by standards
for disabled access.
3.
Elevators shall be equipped with a two-way automatic level- maintaining device
with an accuracy of one-fourth inch.
4. Each elevator, except those for material
handling, shall be equipped with an independent keyed switch for staff use for
bypassing all landing button calls and responding to car button calls
only.
5. Elevator call buttons and
controls shall not be activated by heat or smoke. Light beams, if used for
operating door reopening devices without touch, shall be used in combination
with door-edge safety devices and shall be interconnected with a system of
smoke detectors. This is so the light control feature will be overridden or
disengaged should it encounter smoke at any landing.
6. Field inspections and tests shall be made
and the owner shall be furnished with written certification stating the
installation meets the requirements set forth in this section as well as all
applicable safety regulations and codes.
SECTION 70
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
MECHANICAL REQUIREMENTS.
A. General.
1. Prior to acceptance of the facility, all
mechanical systems shall be tested and operated to demonstrate to the owner or
his designated representative that the installation and performance of these
systems conform to design intent. Test results shall be documented for
maintenance files.
2. Upon
completion of the special systems equipment installation contract, the owner
shall be furnished with a complete set of manufacturers' operating,
maintenance, and preventive instructions, parts list, and complete procurement
numbers and descriptions. Operating staff shall be provided with instructions
for proper operation of systems and equipment.
3. Rotating mechanical equipment, shall be
mounted on vibration isolators as required to prevent unacceptable
structure-borne vibration.
4.
Supply and return mains and risers for cooling, heating, and steam systems
shall be equipped with valves to isolate the various sections of each system
and each piece of equipment.
B. Thermal and Acoustical Insulation.
1. Insulation within the building shall be
provided to conserve energy, protect personnel, prevent vapor condensation, and
reduce noise.
2. Insulation on cold
surfaces shall include an exterior vapor barrier. Material that will not absorb
or transmit moisture will not require a separate vapor barrier.
3. Insulation, including finishes and
adhesives on the exterior surfaces of ducts, piping, and equipment, shall have
a flame-spread rating of 25 or less and a smoke-developed rating of 50 or less
as determined by an independent testing laboratory in accordance with NFPA
255.
4. Interior duct linings shall
not be used. This requirement shall not apply to air terminals and sound
attenuation devices that have special coverings over such linings.
5. Existing accessible insulation within
areas that are renovated shall be inspected and addressed, as
appropriate.
C. Steam and
Hot Water Systems and Pressure Vessels.
1. All
pressure vessels shall meet the requirements of the Arkansas Boiler Inspector,
Arkansas Department of Labor.
D. Air Conditioning, Heating and Ventilating
Systems.
1. The systems shall be designed to
provide the dry bulb temperatures noted in Table 3 of the appendix. The systems
shall be designed and operated to provide the relative humidity noted in Table
3 of the appendix.
2. All rooms and
areas in the facility used for patient care shall have provisions for
ventilation. The ventilation rates shown in Table 4 shall be used only as
minimum standards; they do not preclude the use of higher, more appropriate
rates. Fans serving exhaust systems shall be located at the discharge end and
shall be readily serviceable. Air supply and exhaust in rooms for which no
minimum total air change rate is noted may vary down to zero in response to
room load. For rooms listed in Table 4 where VAV systems are used, minimum
total air change shall be within limits noted. Temperature control shall also
comply with these standards. To maintain asepsis control, airflow supply and
exhaust should generally be controlled to ensure movement of air from "clean"
to: less clean" areas, especially in critical areas. The ventilation systems
shall be designed and balanced according to the requirements shown in Table 4
and in the applicable notes.
3.
Exhaust systems may be combined to enhance the efficiency of recovery devices
required for energy conservation. Local exhaust systems shall be used whenever
possible in place of dilution ventilation to reduce exposure to hazardous
gases, vapors, fumes, or mists. Airborne infection isolation rooms shall not be
served by exhaust systems incorporating energy recovery devices that permit
crosscontamination.
4. Fresh air
intakes shall be located at least 25feet from exhaust outlets of ventilating
systems, combustion equipment stacks, medical-surgical vacuum systems, plumbing
vents, or areas that may collect vehicular exhaust or other noxious fumes.
(Prevailing winds and/or proximity to other structures may require greater
clearances.) Plumbing and vacuum vents that terminate at a level above the top
of the air intake may be located as close as 10feet. The bottom of outdoor air
intakes serving central systems shall be as high as practical, but at least six
feet above ground level, or, if installed above the roof, three feet above roof
level. Exhaust outlets from areas that may be contaminated shall be above roof
level and arranged to minimize recirculation of exhaust air into the
building.
5. In new construction
and major renovation work, air supply for operating and delivery rooms
(excluding LDR/LDRP rooms) shall be from ceiling outlets near the center of the
work area. Return air shall be near the floor level. Each operating and
delivery room shall have at least two return-air inlets located as remotely
from each other as practical. (Design should consider turbulence and other
factors of air movement to minimize fall of particulates onto sterile
surfaces.) Where extraordinary procedures, such as organ transplants, justify
special designs, installation shall properly meet performance needs as
determined by applicable standards. These special designs should be reviewed on
a case-by-case basis. Temperature shall be individually controlled for each
operating and cesarean section room.
6. The operating and delivery room (excluding
LDR/LDRP rooms) room ventilation systems should operate at all times to
maintain the "air movement relationship to adjacent areas." The cleanliness of
the spaces is compromised when the ventilation system is shut down, e.g.,
airflow from a less clean space such as the corridor can occur, and standing
water can accumulate in the ventilation system (near humidifiers or cooling
coils).
7. In new construction and
major renovation work, air supply for rooms used for invasive procedures such
as autopsy rooms, cardiac cath labs, cystoscopic rooms, trauma rooms, endoscopy
rooms, bronchoscopy rooms, and/or rooms where anesthesia gases are used shall
be from ceiling outlets near the center of the room and/or work area. Return or
exhaust air inlets shall be near the floor level. Exhaust inlets for anesthesia
evacuation and other special applications shall be permitted to be installed in
the ceiling.
8. Each space
routinely used for administering inhalation anesthesia and inhalation analgesia
shall be served by a scavenging system to vent waste gases. If a vacuum system
is used, the gas-collecting system shall be arranged so that it does not
disturb patients' respiratory systems. Gases from the scavenging system shall
be exhausted directly to the outside. The anesthesia evacuation system may be
combined with the room exhaust system, provided the part used for anesthesia
gas scavenging exhausts directly to the outside and is not part of the
recirculation system. Scavenging systems are not required for areas where gases
are used only occasionally, such as the emergency room, offices for routine
dental work, etc.
9. The bottoms of
ventilation openings shall be at least three inches above the floor.
10. The space above ceilings in new
construction shall not be used as plenum space to supply to, return air from,
or to exhaust air from any patient room, operating room, trauma room, critical
care room, delivery room, endoscopy room, cardiac cath lab, bronchoscopy room,
autopsy room, exam room, treatment room, airborne infection isolation room,
protective environment room, radiology suite, laboratory suite, soiled
workroom, soiled holding, physical therapy and hydrotherapy, ETO-sterilizer
room, sterilizer equipment room, and central medical and surgical supply areas
or rooms. Plenum return air space conforming to NFPA 90A requirements shall be
acceptable in areas where it is not listed above.
11. All central ventilation or air
conditioning systems shall be equipped with filters with efficiencies equal to,
or greater than, those specified in Table 1 of the Appendix. Where two filter
beds are required, filter bed number one shall be located upstream of the air
conditioning equipment and filter bed number two shall be downstream of any fan
or blowers. Filter efficiencies, tested in accordance with ASHRAE 52-92, shall
be average. Filter frames shall be durable and proportioned to provide an
airtight fit with the enclosing ductwork. All joints between filter segments
and enclosing ductwork shall have gaskets or seals to provide a positive seal
against air leakage. A manometer or equal equivalent method of monitoring high
and low pressure drop shall be installed across each filter bed having a
required efficiency of 90 percent or more including hoods requiring HEPA
filters.
12. If duct humidifiers
are located upstream of the final filters, they shall be located in a manner to
prevent condensation on the surface of the filters. Ductwork with ductmounted
humidifiers shall have a means of water removal. An adjustable high-limit
humidistat shall be located downstream of the humidifier to reduce the
potential of condensation inside the duct. All duct take-offs should be
sufficiently downstream of the humidifier to ensure complete moisture
absorption. Steam humidifiers shall be used. Reservoir-type water spray or
evaporative pan humidifiers shall not be used.
13. Air-handling duct systems shall be
designed with accessibility for duct cleaning, and shall meet the requirements
of NFPA 90A.
14. Ducts that
penetrate construction intended to protect against X-ray, magnetic, RFI, or
other radiation shall not impair the effectiveness of the protection.
15. Fire and smoke dampers shall be
constructed, located, and installed in accordance with the requirements of NFPA
101, 90A, and the specific damper's listing requirements. Fans, dampers, and
detectors shall be interconnected so that damper activation will not damage
ducts. Maintenance access shall be provided at all dampers. All damper
locations shall be indicated on design drawings. Dampers should be activated by
fire or smoke sensors, not by fan cutoff alone. Switching systems for
restarting fans may be installed for fire department use in venting smoke after
a fire has been controlled. However, provisions should be made to avoid
possible damage to the system due to closed dampers. When smoke partitions are
required, heating, ventilation, and air conditioning zones shall be coordinated
with compartmentation insofar as practical to minimize need to penetrate fire
and smoke partitions.
16. Hoods and
safety cabinets may be used for normal exhaust of a space provided that minimum
air change rates are maintained. If air change standards in Table 4 of the
Appendix do not provide sufficient air for proper operation of exhaust hoods
and safety cabinets (when in use), supplementary makeup air (filtered and
preheated) shall be provided around these units to maintain the required
airflow direction and exhaust velocity. Use of makeup air will avoid dependence
upon infiltration from outdoor and/or from contaminated areas. Makeup systems
for hoods shall be arranged to minimize "short circuiting" of air and to avoid
reduction in air velocity at the point of contaminant capture.
17. Laboratory hoods shall meet the following
general standards:
a. Have an average face
velocity of at least 75 feet per minute.
b. Have an exhaust fan located at the
discharge end of the system.
c.
Have an exhaust duct system of noncombustible corrosion- resistant material as
needed to meet the planned usage of the hood.
18. Laboratory exhaust and ventilation
systems shall comply with NFPA 45.
19. Laboratory hoods shall meet the following
special standards:
a. Fume hoods, and their
associated equipment in the air stream, intended for use with perchloric acid
and other strong oxidants, shall be constructed of stainless steel or other
material consistent with special exposures, and be provided with a water wash
and drain system to permit periodic flushing of duct and hood. Electrical
equipment intended for installation within such ducts shall be designed and
constructed to resist penetration by water. Lubricants and seals shall not
contain organic materials. When perchloric acid or other strong oxidants are
only transferred from one container to another, standard laboratory fume hoods
and the associated equipment may be used in lieu of stainless steel
construction.
b. In new
construction and major renovation work, each hood used to process infectious or
radioactive materials shall have a minimum face velocity of 90 feet per minute
with suitable pressure-independent air modulating devices and alarms to alert
staff of fan shutdown or loss of airflow. Each shall also have filters with
99.97 percent efficiency (based on dioctyl- phthalate (DOP) test method) in the
exhaust stream, and be designed and equipped to permit the safe removal,
disposal, and replacement of contaminated filters. Filters shall be as close to
the hood as practical to minimize duct contamination. Fume hoods intended for
use with radioactive isotopes shall be constructed of stainless steel or other
material suitable for the particular exposure and shall comply with NFPA 801,
Facilities for Handling Radioactive Materials. Radioactive isotopes used for
injections, etc. without probability of airborne particulates or gases may be
processed in a clean-workbench-type hood where acceptable to the Nuclear
Regulatory Commission.
20. Exhaust hoods handling grease-laden
vapors in food preparation centers shall comply with NFPA 96. All hoods over
cooking ranges shall be equipped with grease filters, fire extinguishing
systems, and heat-actuated fan controls. Cleanout openings shall be provided
every 20feet and at changes in direction in the horizontal exhaust duct systems
serving these hoods. (Horizontal runs of ducts serving range hoods should be
kept to a minimum.
21. The
ventilation system for anesthesia storage rooms shall conform to the
requirements of NFPA 99.
22. The
ventilation system for the space that houses ethylene oxide (ETO) sterilizers
should be designed to:
a. Provide a dedicated
(not connected to a return air or other exhaust system) exhaust system. Refer
to 29 CFR Part 1910.1047.
b. All
source areas shall be exhausted, including the sterilizer equipment room,
service/aeration areas, over the sterilizer door, and the aerator. If the ETO
cylinders are not located in a well-ventilated, unoccupied equipment space, an
exhaust hood shall be provided over the cylinders. The relief valve shall be
terminated in a well-ventilated, unoccupied equipment space, or outside the
building. If the floor drain which the sterilizer(s) discharges to is not
located in a well-ventilated, unoccupied equipment space, an exhaust drain cap
shall be provided (coordinate with local codes).
c. Ensure that general airflow is away from
sterilizer operator(s).
d. Provide
a dedicated exhaust duct system for ETO. The exhaust outlet to the atmosphere
should be at least 25feet away from any air intake.
23. An audible and visual alarm shall
activate in the sterilizer work area, and a 24hour staffed location, upon loss
of airflow in the exhaust system.
24. Rooms with fuel-fired equipment shall be
provided with sufficient outdoor air to maintain equipment combustion
rates.
25. Gravity exhaust may be
used, where conditions permit, for nonpatient areas such as boiler rooms,
central storage, etc.
26. The
energy-saving potential of variable air volume systems is recognized and these
standard herein are intended to maximize appropriate use of that system. Any
system utilized for occupied areas shall include provisions to avoid air
stagnation in interior spaces where thermostat demands are met by temperatures
of surrounding areas.
27. Special
consideration shall be given to the type of heating and cooling units,
ventilation outlets, and appurtenances installed in patient-occupied areas of
psychiatric units. The following shall apply:
a. All air grilles and diffusers shall be of
a type that prohibits the insertion of foreign objects. All exposed fasteners
shall be tamper-resistant.
b. All
convector or HVAC enclosures exposed in the room shall be constructed with
round corners and shall have enclosures fastened with tamper-resistant
screws.
c. HVAC equipment shall be
of a type that minimizes the need for maintenance with the room.
28. Rooms or booths used for
sputum induction, aerosolized pentamidine treatments, and other high-risk
cough-inducing procedures shall be provided with local exhaust ventilation. See
Table 4 of the Appendix for ventilation requirements.
29. Non-central air handling systems, i.e.,
individual room units that are used for heating and cooling purposes (fan-coil
units, heat pump units, etc.) in areas permitted by Table 4 to utilize air
recirculated by means of a room unit shall be equipped with permanent
(cleanable) or replaceable filters. The filters shall have a minimum efficiency
of 68 percent weight arrestance. These units may be used as recirculating units
only. All outdoor air requirements shall be met by a separate central air
handling system with the proper filtration, as noted in Table 1 of the
Appendix.
30. For special needs
pharmacy work area and equipment requirements refer to Laws and Regulations -
Arkansas State Board of Pharmacy.
SECTION 71
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
PLUMBING AND OTHER PIPING SYSTEMS.
All plumbing systems shall be designed and installed in
accordance with the requirements of the latest edition of the Arkansas State
Plumbing Code and the latest edition of the Laws, Rules, and Regulations
Governing Boiler Inspection, Arkansas Department of Labor.
A. Plumbing Fixtures.
1. The material used for plumbing fixtures
shall be nonabsorbent acid- resistant material.
2. The water supply spout for lavatories and
sinks required in patient care areas (except patient rooms) shall be mounted so
that the discharge point is a minimum distance of five inches above the rim of
the fixture.
3. All fixtures used
by medical and nursing staff and all lavatories used by patients and food
handlers shall be trimmed with valves which can be operated without the use of
hands. Where blade handles are used for this purpose, they shall not exceed
four and one-half inches in length, except that handles on clinical sinks shall
be not less than six inches long. (Automatic controls are acceptable.) Scrub
sinks shall be trimmed with foot, knee or ultrasonic controls.
4. Clinical sinks shall have an integral trap
in which the upper portion of the water trap provides a visible seal.
5. Shower bases and tubs shall provide
non-slip walking surfaces.
B. Potable Water Supply Systems.
1. Systems shall be designed to supply water
at sufficient pressure to operate all fixtures and equipment during maximum
demand periods.
2. Each water
service main, branch main, riser, and branch to a group of fixtures shall be
valved. Stop valves shall be provided at each fixture. Appropriate panels for
access shall be provided at all valves where required.
3. Backflow preventers (vacuum breakers)
shall be installed on hose bibs, laboratory sinks, janitors' sinks, bedpan
flushing attachments, autopsy tables, and on all other fixtures to which hoses
or tubing can be attached.
4.
Bedpan flushing devices shall be provided in each inpatient toilet room.
Installation is optional in psychiatric and alcohol-abuse units where patients
are ambulatory.
5. The following
standards shall apply to hot water systems:
a.
The water-heating system shall have sufficient supply capacity at the
temperatures and amounts indicated in Table 9 of the Appendix. Water
temperature is measured at the point of use or inlet to the
equipment.
b. Hot-water
distribution systems serving patient care areas shall be under constant
recirculation to provide continuous hot water at each hot water outlet. The
temperature of hot water for showers and bathing shall be appropriate for safe
and comfortable use. (See table 9 of the Appendix).
6. Water distribution systems shall be
arranged to provide hot water at each hot water outlet at all times. (See table
9 of the Appendix).
C.
Drainage Systems. The following standards shall apply to drainage systems:
1. Drain lines used for acid waste disposal
shall be made of acid-resistant material.
2. Drain lines serving some types of
automatic blood-cell counters shall be of carefully selected material that will
eliminate potential for undesirable chemical reactions
3. Drainage piping should not be installed
within the ceiling or exposed in operating and delivery rooms, nurseries, food
preparation centers, food serving facilities, food storage areas, central
services, electronic data processing areas, electric closets, and other
sensitive areas. Where exposed overhead drain piping in these areas is
unavoidable, special provisions shall be made to protect the space below from
leakage, condensation, or dust particles.
4. Floor drains shall not be installed in
operating and delivery rooms.
5. If
a floor drain is installed in cystoscopy, it shall contain a nonsplash,
horizontal flow flushing bowl beneath the drain plate. Note: Floor drains in
cystoscopy operating rooms have been shown to disseminate heavily contaminated
spray during flushing. Unless regularly with large amounts of fluid, the trap
tends to dry out and permit passage of gases, vapors, odors, insects and vermin
directly into the operating room. For new construction, if a floor drain is
insisted upon by the users, the drain plate should be located away from the
operative preferably with a closed system of drainage. Alternative methods
include (a) an aspirator/trap installed in a wall connected to the collecting
trough of the operating table by a closed, disposable tube system, or (b) a
closed system using portable collecting vessels. (See NFPA 99.)
6. Drain systems for autopsy tables shall be
designed to positively avoid splatter or overflow onto floors or back siphonage
and for easy cleaning and trap flushing.
7. Building sewers shall discharge into
community sewage. Where such a system is not available, the facility shall
treat sewage in accordance with local and state regulations.
8. Kitchen grease traps shall be located and
arranged to permit easy access without the need to enter food preparation or
storage areas. Grease traps shall be of capacity required and shall be
accessible from outside of the building without need to interrupt any
services.
9. Where plaster traps
are used, provisions shall be made for appropriate access and
cleaning.
10. In dietary areas,
floor drains and/or floor sinks shall be of a type that can be easily cleaned
by removal of cover. Provide floor drains or floor sinks at all "wet equipment"
(i.e., ice machines) and as required for wet cleaning of floors. Provide
removable stainless steel mesh in addition to grilled drain cover to prevent
entry of large particles of waste which might cause stoppages. Location of
floor drains and floor sinks shall be coordinated to avoid conditions where
locations of equipment make removal of covers for cleaning difficult.
D. The installation, testing, and
certification of nonflammable medical gas and air systems shall comply with the
requirements of NFPA 99. (See Table 11 of the Appendix for rooms that require
station outlets.)
E. Clinical
vacuum system installations shall be in accordance with NPFA 99. (See Table 11
of the Appendix for rooms that require station outlets.)
F. All piping, except control-line tubing,
shall be identified. All valves shall be tagged, and a valve schedule shall be
provided to the facility owner for permanent record and reference.
G. When the functional program includes
hemodialysis, continuously circulated filtered cold water shall be
provided.
H. Provide condensate
drains for cooling coils of a type that may be cleaned as needed without
disassembly. Provide air gap where condensate drains empty into floor drains.
Provide heater elements for condensate lines in freezer or other areas where
freezing may be a problem.
I. No
plumbing lines may be exposed overhead or on walls where possible accumulation
of dust or soil may create a cleaning problem or where leaks would create a
potential for food contamination.
SECTION 72
: PHYSICAL ENVIRONMENT,
ELECTRICAL STANDARDS.
A. General.
1. All electrical material and equipment,
including conductors, controls, and signaling devices, shall be installed in
compliance with and maintained per applicable sections of NFPA 70 and NFPA 99
and shall be listed as complying with available standards of listing agencies,
or other similar established standards where such standards are required.
Maintenance and testing of receptacles in patient care areas shall be performed
at initial installation, replacement or servicing of devices. Records shall be
maintained of all tests, rooms or areas tested, with itemized pass/fail
indicators.
2. The electrical
installations, including alarm, nurse call, and communication systems, shall be
tested to demonstrate that equipment installation and operation is appropriate
and functional. A written record of performance tests on special electrical
systems and equipment shall demonstrate compliance with applicable codes and
standards.
3. Shielded isolation
transformers, voltage regulators, filters, surge suppressors, and other
safeguards shall be provided as required where power line disturbances are
likely to affect data processing and/or automated laboratory or diagnostic
equipment.
B. Main
switchboards shall be located in an area separate from plumbing and mechanical
equipment and shall be accessible to authorized persons only. Switchboards
shall be convenient for use, readily accessible for maintenance, away from
traffic lanes, and located in dry, ventilated spaces free of corrosive or
explosive fumes, gases, or any flammable material. Overload protective devices
shall operate properly in ambient room temperatures.
C. Lighting.
1. The Illuminating Engineering Society of
North America (IES) has developed recommended lighting levels for health care
facilities. The reader should refer to the IES Handbook.
2. Approaches to buildings and parking lots,
and all occupied spaces within buildings shall have fixtures that can be
illuminated as necessary.
3.
Patient rooms shall have general lighting and night lighting. A reading light
shall be provided for each patient. Reading light controls shall be readily
accessible to the patient(s). Incandescent and halogen light sources which
produce heat shall be avoided to prevent burns to the patient and/or bed linen.
The light source should be covered by a diffuser or lens. Flexible light arms,
if used, shall be mechanically controlled to prevent the lamp from contacting
the bed linen. At least one night light fixture in each patient room shall be
controlled at the room entrance. Lighting for coronary and intensive care bed
areas shall permit staff observation of the patient while minimizing
glare.
4. Operating and delivery
rooms shall have general lighting in addition to special lighting units
provided at surgical and obstetrical tables. General lighting and special
lighting shall be on separate circuits.
5. Nursing unit corridors shall have general
illumination with provisions for reducing light levels at night.
6. Light intensity for staff and patient
needs should generally comply with health care guidelines set forth in the IES
publication. Consideration should be given to controlling intensity and/or
wavelength to prevent harm to the patient's eyes (i.e., retina damage to
premature infants and cataracts due to ultraviolet light). Many procedures are
available to satisfy lighting requirements, but the design should consider
light quality as well as quantity for effectiveness and efficiency.
7. An examination light shall be provided for
examination, treatment, and trauma rooms.
8. Light intensity of required emergency
lighting shall follow IES guidelines. Egress and exit lighting shall comply
with NFPA 101.
D.
Receptacles.
1. Each operating and delivery
room shall have at least six receptacles convenient to the head of the
procedure table. Each operating room shall have at least 16simplex or eight
duplex receptacles. Where mobile X-ray, laser, or other equipment requiring
special electrical configurations is used, additional receptacles distinctively
marked for X-ray or laser use shall be provided.
2. Each patient room shall have
duplex-grounded receptacles. There shall be one at each side of the head of
each bed; one for television, if used; and one on every other wall. Receptacles
may be omitted from exterior walls where construction or room configuration
makes installation impractical. Nurseries shall have at least two
duplex-grounded receptacles for each bassinet. Outlets for general care areas
and critical care areas shall be provided for as defined by NFPA 99 and NFPA
70.
3. Duplex-grounded receptacles
for general use shall be installed approximately 50feet apart in all corridors
and within 25feet of corridor ends. Receptacles in pediatric and psychiatric
unit corridors shall be of the tamper resistant type. Special receptacles
marked for X-ray use shall be installed in corridors of patient areas so that
mobile equipment may be used anywhere within a patient room using a cord length
of 50feet or less. If the same mobile X-ray unit is used in operating rooms and
in nursing areas, receptacles for X-ray use shall permit the use of one plug in
all locations.
Where capacitive discharge or battery-powered X-ray units are
used, special X-ray receptacles are not required.
4. Electrical receptacle cover plates or
electrical receptacles supplied from the emergency systems shall be
distinctively colored or marked for identification. If color is used for
identification purposes, the same color shall be used throughout the
facility.
5. For renal dialysis
units, two duplex receptacles shall be on each side of a patient bed or lounge
chair. One duplex receptacle on each side of the bed shall be connected to
emergency power.
E.
Equipment.
1. At inhalation anesthetizing
locations, all electrical equipment and devices, receptacles, and wiring shall
comply with applicable sections of NFPA 99 and NFPA 70.
2. Fixed and mobile X-ray equipment
installations shall conform to articles 517 and 660 of NFPA 70.
3. The X-ray film illuminator unit or units
for displaying at least two films simultaneously shall be installed in each
operating room, specified emergency treatment rooms, and X-ray viewing room of
the radiology department. All illuminator units within one space or room shall
have lighting of uniform intensity and color value.
4. Ground-fault circuit interrupters (GFCI)
shall comply with NFPA 70. When ground-fault circuit interrupters are used in
critical areas, provisions shall be made to ensure the other essential
equipment is not affected by activation of one interrupter.
5. In areas such as critical care units and
special nurseries where a patient may be treated with an internal probe or
catheter connected to the heart, the ground system shall comply with applicable
sections of NFPA 99 and NFPA 70.
F. Nurse/Patient Communication Station.
1. In patient areas, each patient room shall
be served by at least one nurse/patient communication station for two-way voice
communication. All primary nurse call systems shall be of the
electrical/electronic nature. The signal shall activate an annunciator panel at
the nurse station, a visible signal in the corridor at the patient's door, and
at other areas defined by the functional program. Each bed shall be provided
with a call device. Two call devices serving adjacent beds may be served on one
calling station.
Calls shall activate a visible signal in the corridor at the
patient's door, in the clean workroom, in the soiled workroom, medication,
charting, nourishment, and examination/treatment room(s) and at the nurses'
station. In multi-corridor nursing units, additional visible signals shall be
installed at corridor intersections. In rooms containing two or more
nurse/patient communication stations, indicating lights shall be provided at
each station. Nurse/patient communication stations at each calling station
shall be equipped with an indicating light which remains lighted as long as the
voice circuit is operating.
2. An emergency call system shall be provided
at each inpatient/outpatient toilet, bath and shower room. An emergency call
shall be accessible to a collapsed patient on the floor. Inclusion of a pull
cord within four to six inches from the floor will satisfy this standard. The
emergency call shall be designed so that a signal activated at a patient's
calling station will initiate a visible and audible signal distinct from the
regular nurse/patient communication station that can be turned off only at the
patient calling station. The signal shall activate an annunciator panel at the
nurse station, a visible signal in the corridor at the patient's door, and at
other areas defined by the narrative program. Provisions for emergency calls
will also be provided in outpatient and treatment areas where patients are
subject to incapacitation.
3. In
areas such as critical care, recovery and pre-op, where patients are under
constant visual surveillance, the nurse/patient communication call may be
limited to a bedside button or station that activates a signal readily seen at
the control station.
4. A staff
emergency assistance system for staff to summon additional assistance shall be
provided in each operating, delivery, recovery, emergency examination and/or
treatment area, and in critical care units, nurseries, special procedure rooms,
cardiac catheterization rooms, stress-test areas, triage, outpatient surgery
admission and discharge areas, and areas for psychiatric patients including
seclusion and security rooms, anterooms and toilet rooms serving them, communal
toilet and bathing facility rooms, and dining, activity, therapy, exam and
treatment rooms. This system shall annunciate audibly or visually in the clean
work room, in the soiled work room, medication, charting, nourishment, and
examination/treatment room(s) if provided and at the administrative center of
the nursing unit with back up to another staffed area from which assistance can
be summoned.
5. A nurse/patient
communication station is not required in psychiatric nursing units, but if it
is included, provisions shall be made for easy removal, or for covering call
button outlets. In psychiatric nursing units all hardware shall have tamper-
resistant fasteners.
G.
Emergency power shall be provided in accordance with NFPA 99, NFPA 101, and
NFPA 110.
H. Emergency electrical
generators shall have a minimum 48hours of on-site fuel.
I. All health care occupancies shall be
provided with a fire alarm system in accordance with NFPA 101 and NFPA
72.
J. Telecommunications and
Information Systems.
1. Locations for
terminating telecommunications and information system devices shall be
provided.
2. A room shall be
provided for telecommunications and information systems. Special air
conditioning and voltage regulations shall be provided when recommended by the
manufacturer.
K.
Annuciator alarm panels for Emergency Systems including but not limited to such
as the fire alarms, medical gas and emergency generators shall be located
according to the functional program and shall be located in prominent locations
easily observed and accessible by staff at all times.
SECTION 73
: HYPERBARIC SUITE
A. General
1. The number of treatment stations should be
based upon the expected workload and may include several work shifts per
day.
2. The location should offer
convenient access for outpatients. Accessibility to the unit from parking and
public transportation should be a consideration.
B. Treatment Areas
1. Hyperbaric chambers for multiple occupancy
(Class A) should be installed in accordance with NFPA 99.
2. Hyperbaric chambers for individual
patients (Class B) should be installed in accordance with NFPA 99 in a room or
suite adequately sized to provide the following clearances: chamber and side
wall, 5 feet; between chambers, 6 feet; and between the chamber headboard and
the wall, 3 feet. A minimum passage space of 4 feet shall be provided at the
foot of each chamber in addition to the required clearances for sliding
patients' platforms in end-loading chambers.
C. Functional Elements. The following support
spaces should be provided and may be shared with adjacent departments.
1. Patient waiting area. The area should be
out of traffic, under staff control, and should have seating capacity in
accordance with the functional program. When the hyperbaric suite is routinely
used for outpatients and inpatients at the same lime, separate waiting areas
should be provided with screening for visual privacy between the waiting
areas.
2. A control desk and
reception area should be provided.
3. A holding area under staff control should
accommodate inpatients on stretchers or beds. Stretcher patients should be out
of the direct line of normal traffic. The patient holding area may be omitted
for two or fewer individual hyperbaric chamber units.
4. Toilet rooms for the use of patients
should be provided with direct access from the hyperbaric suite.
5. Dressing rooms for outpatients should be
provided and should include a seat or bench, mirror, and provisions for hanging
patients' clothing and for securing valuables. At least one dressing room
should be provided to accommodate wheelchair patients.
6. An appropriate room for individual and
family consultation with referring physicians should be provided for
outpatients.
7. A clean storage
space should be provided for clean supplies and linens. Handwashing stations
should be provided with hands-free operable controls. When a separate storage
room is provided, it may be shared with another department when conveniently
located.
8. A soiled holding room
should be provided with waste receptacles and soiled linen receptacles Storage
for patients' belongings should be provided.
9. A housekeeping room should be provided and
should contain a floor receptor or service sink and storage space for
housekeeping supplies and equipment; it should be located nearby.
10. Appropriate areas should be available for
male and female personnel for staff clothing change area and lounge. The areas
should contain lockers, shower, toilet, and handwashing stations.
11. A waiting room, toilet with handwashing
stations, drinking fountain, public telephone, and seating accommodations for
waiting periods should be available or accessible to the unit.
D. Electrical Requirements
1. Grounding of hyperbaric chambers should be
connected only to the equipment ground in accordance with NFPA 99 and NFPA
70.
2. Additional grounds such as
earth or driven grounds should not be permitted.
SECTION 74
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES,
HELICOPTER LANDING AREA.
Helicopter landing area (if provided) shall be
documented.
A. Safe planning for the
helicopter service shall include the following:
1. Plot plan showing the heliport for
Department of Health files and inspection; and
2. More than one approach/departure
route.
B. Service shall
be as close to the emergency service at the hospital as can be accomplished
safely. The Department of Health will consider that a helicopter landing area
does exist upon repeated or regular use of a location.
C. See NFPA 418 for roof top heliports.
NOTE: If there are wire obstacles, wire markers are available
at no charge. They shall be picked up at the Arkansas Department of
Aeronautics.
SECTION
75
: PHYSICAL FACILITIES, OUTPATIENT CARE FACILITIES.
A. General Considerations. See Section 43.A,
Physical Facilities.
1. This section applies
to the outpatient care unit licensed under the facility as a department and
under the rule of the Governing Body. An outpatient care unit can be a part of
the facility or a separate freestanding facility. An outpatient unit within the
main facility building shall be located so outpatients do not traverse
inpatient areas.
2. The general
standards set forth in the following sections shall apply to each of the items
below:
a. Outpatient psychiatric
centers;
b. Primary care outpatient
centers; and
c. Diagnosis and/or
treatment centers.
3.
Each element provided in the outpatient care facility shall be described in the
written functional program and meet the requirements outlined herein as a
minimum.
B. General
Construction Considerations. See Section 43.A, Physical Facilities.
C. Site Location, Inspection, Approval and
Subsoil Investigation. See Section 43.D-M, Physical Facilities.
D. Construction Documents. See Section 43.K,
Physical Facilities.
E. Codes and
Standards. New/existing Outpatient Care Facilities which do not meet the
criteria of the NFPA, Life Safety Code Volume 101 for healthcare and/or
ambulatory healthcare occupancies may be classified as a Business Occupancy as
defined in LSC 101, Chapter 26 (new)/27 (existing) with exceptions noted within
these regulations.
F. General
Requirements for Outpatient Care Facilities. As needed the following elements
shall be provided to satisfy the functional program.
1. Functional Program. See Section 43,
Physical Facilities.
2. Parking.
Each facility should provide adequate parking for staff and patients.
3. Patient Privacy. Each facility design
shall ensure patient audible and visual privacy and dignity during interview,
examination, treatment and recovery.
4. Administration and Public Areas. The
following shall apply to each outpatient care facility described herein with
additions and/or modification as noted for each specific type.
a. Entrance. Located at grade level and able
to accommodate wheelchairs.
b.
Public services shall include:
1) Conveniently
accessible wheelchair storage;
2) A
reception and information counter or desk;
3) Waiting space(s). Where an organized
pediatric service is part of the outpatient care facility, provisions shall be
made for separating pediatric and adult patients;
4) Public toilets;
5) Drinking fountain; and
6) Public telephones.
c. Interview space(s). Private interviews
related to social services, credit, etc. shall be provided.
d. General or individual offices for business
transactions, records, administrative and professional staffs shall be
provided.
e. Clerical space or
rooms for typing, clerical work, and filing, separated from public areas for
confidentiality, shall be provided.
f. Multipurpose room(s) equipped for visual
aids shall be provided for conferences, meetings and health education
purposes.
g. Special storage for
staff personal effects with locking drawers or cabinets (may be individual
desks or cabinets) shall be provided. Such storage shall be near individual
work stations and staff controlled.
h. General storage facilities for supplies
and equipment shall be provided as needed for continuing operation.
i. In new construction and renovation where
hemodialysis or hemoperfusion are routinely performed, there shall be a
separate water supply and a drainage facility that do not interfere with
handwashing.
5. General
purpose examination rooms. For medical, and similar examinations, rooms shall
have a minimum floor area of 80square feet, excluding vestibules, toilets, and
closets. Room arrangement shall permit at least two feet eight inches clearance
at each side and at the foot of the examination table. A handwashing fixture
and a counter or shelf space for writing shall be provided.
6. Special- purpose examination rooms. Rooms
for special clinics such as eye, ear, nose, and throat examinations, if
provided, shall be designed and outfitted to accommodate procedures and
equipment used. A handwashing stations and a counter or shelf space for writing
shall be provided.
7. Treatment
Room(s). Rooms for diagnosis and/or treatment if provided, shall have a minimum
floor area of 120square feet, excluding vestibule, toilet, and closets. The
minimum room dimension shall be 10feet. A handwashing fixture and counter or
shelf for writing shall be provided.
8. Observation room(s). Observation rooms for
the isolation of suspect or disturbed patients shall have a minimum floor area
of 80 square feet and shall be convenient to a nurse or control station. This
is to permit close observation of patients and to minimize possibilities of
patients' hiding, escape, injury, or suicide. An examination room may be
modified to accommodate this function. A toilet room with lavatory should be
immediately accessible.
9. Control
Station. A work counter, communication system, space for supplies, and
provisions for charting shall be provided.
10. Medication Distribution Station. This may
be a part of the control station and shall include a work counter, sink,
refrigerator, and locked storage for biologicals and medications.
11. Clean Holding. A separate room or closet
for storing clean and sterile supplies shall be provided. This storage shall be
in addition to that of cabinets and shelves.
12. Soiled Holding. Provisions shall be made
for separate collection, storage, and disposal of soiled materials.
13. Sterilizing Facilities. A system for
sterilizing equipment and supplies shall be provided, if required by the
narrative program.
14. Wheelchair
Storage Space. Such storage shall be out of the direct line of
traffic.
15. The need for and
number of required airborne infection isolation rooms shall be determined by an
infection control risk assessment. When required, the airborne infection
isolation room(s) shall comply with the general requirements of Section
44.C.
16. Imaging Suite. See
Section 52, Physical Facilities, Imaging Suite.
17. Laboratory. See Section 55, Physical
Facilities, Laboratory Services.
18. Rehabilitation Services. See Section 76,
Physical Facilities, Rehabilitation Facilities.
19. Environmental Services, Safety Services,
Physical Environment. See Section 43, Physical Facilities.
20. Staff Facilities. See Section 66,
Physical Facilities, Engineering Service and Equipment Areas
21. Waste Processing Services. See Section
67, Physical Facilities, Waste Processing Services.
22. Social Spaces/Group Therapy. See Rules
for Hospitals and Related Institutions in Arkansas, Section, Physical
Facilities for Psychiatric Hospitals - F.3 Service Areas
23. Details shall comply with the following
standards:
a. Minimum patient corridor width
shall be five feet. Staff only corridors may be 44 inches wide.
b. Each building shall have two exits that
are remote from each other. Other details relating to exits and fire safety
shall comply with NFPA 101 and the standards outlined herein.
c. Items such as drinking fountains,
telephone booths, vending machines, etc., shall not restrict corridor traffic
or reduce corridor width below the minimum. Out of traffic storage space for
portable equipment shall be provided.
d. The minimum nominal door width for patient
use shall be three feet. If the outpatient facility services hospital
inpatients, the minimum nominal width of doors to rooms used by hospital
inpatients transported in beds shall be three feet eight inches.
e. Doors, sidelights, borrowed lights, and
windows glazed to within 18 inches of the floor shall be constructed with
safety glass, wired glass, or similar materials. Glazing materials used for
shower doors and bath enclosures shall be safety glass or plastic.
f. Threshold and expansion joints covers
shall be flush with the floor surface.
g. Handwashing stations shall be located and
arranged to permit proper use and operation.
h. Provisions for hand drying shall be
included at all handwashing facilities.
i. Radiation protection for X-ray and gamma
ray installations shall be in accordance with the rules and regulations of the
Arkansas Department of Health.
j.
The minimum ceiling height shall be seven feet eight inches.
24. Finishes shall comply with the
following:
a. Cubicle curtains and draperies
shall be noncombustible or flame-retardant and shall pass both the large- and
small-scale tests required by NFPA 701.
b. The flame spread and smoke development
ratings of finishes shall comply with NFPA 101, Chapter 38.
c. Floor materials shall be readily cleanable
and appropriately wear- resistant. In all areas subject to wet cleaning, floor
materials shall not be physically affected by liquid germicidal and cleaning
solutions. Floors subject to traffic while wet, including showers and bath
areas, shall have a nonslip surface.
d. Wall finishes shall be washable, and in
the proximity of plumbing fixtures, shall be smooth and water
resistant.
e. Wall bases in areas
frequently subject to wet cleaning methods shall be monolithic and coved with
the floor, tightly sealed to the wall, and constructed without voids.
f. Floor and wall areas penetrated by pipes,
ducts, and conduits shall be tightly sealed to minimize entry of rodents and
insects. Joints of structural elements shall be similarly sealed.
25. Provision for Disasters. See
Section 42, Physical Environment.
26. Mechanical, Plumbing and Electrical.
a. Small Outpatient Clinics that provide
space and equipment serving four or fewer direct patient care workers at one
time shall comply with the following minimum requirements:
1) Emergency lighting shall be connected to
rechargeable back-up batteries as a means of emergency illumination.
2) A protected premises fire alarm system as
defined in Chapter 3, NFPA 72 is required.
b. Large Outpatient Facilities that provide
space and equipment for more than four direct patient care workers at one time
shall comply with the following minimum requirements:
1) Emergency lighting and power shall be
provided in accordance with NFPA 99, NFPA 101, and NFPA 110.
2) Any fire alarm system shall be as required
by NFPA 101 and installed per NFPA 72.
3) The installation, testing, and
certification of nonflammable medical gas and air systems shall comply with the
requirements of NFPA 99.
4)
Clinical vacuum system installed shall be in accordance with NFPA 99.
5) All electrical material and equipment
shall be installed, tested and certificated in accordance with NFPA 70 and NFPA
99.
6) The mechanical system shall
comply with Section 70, Physical Facilities, Mechanical Requirements, with the
following exceptions:
a) Redundant space
heating and water heating capability are not required, unless required by the
written functional program;
b)
Ducted return air systems are not required, unless required by the written
narrative.
c) Stand-by fuel for
space and water heating is not required.
7) A nurses emergency call system shall be
provided for all patient use at each patient toilet, bath, sitz bath and shower
room. This system shall be accessible to a patient lying on the floor.
Inclusion of a pull cord shall satisfy this standard.
8) Fire extinguisher(s) shall be provided and
be easily accessible per NFPA requirements.
SECTION 76
:
PHYSICAL FACILITIES, REHABILITATION FACILITIES.
A. General Considerations. Rehabilitation
facilities may be organized under hospitals (organized departments of
rehabilitation), outpatient clinics, rehabilitation centers, and other
facilities designed to serve either single- or multiple-disability categories
including but not limited to: cerebrovascular, head trauma, spinal cord injury,
amputees, complicated fractures, arthritis, neurological degeneration, genetic,
and cardiac. In general, rehabilitation hospitals shall have larger space
requirements than general hospitals, have longer lengths of stay and have less
institutional and more residential environments.
B. General Construction Considerations. See
Section 43.A, Physical Facilities.
C. Site Location, Inspection, Approval and
Subsoil Investigation. See Section 43.D-M, Physical Facilities.
D. Construction Documents. See Section 43.K,
Physical Facilities.
E. Codes and
Standards. See Section 43.A and O, Physical Facilities.
F. Functional Units and Service Areas.
1. Required units. Each rehabilitation
facility shall contain a medical evaluation unit and shall provide the
following service areas, if the services are not otherwise conveniently
accessible to the facility and appropriate to program functions:
a. Psychological services;
b. Social services;
c. Vocational services;
d. Patient dining, recreation and day
spaces;
e. Dietary;
f. Personal care facilities;
g. Space for teaching activities of daily
living;
h. Administration
Department;
i. Medical
Records;
j. Engineering service and
equipment areas;
k. Laundry
Services;
l. Housekeeping
Rooms;
m. Employees'
facilities;
n. Nursing unit;
76-2
o. Physical therapy;
p. Occupational therapy; and
q. Speech and hearing.
2. Optional Units. The following special
services areas, if required by the functional program, shall be provided as
outlined in these sections. The sizes of the various departments will depend
upon the services to be provided:
a.
Sterilizing facilities;
b.
Prosthetics and orthotics;
c.
Dental;
d. Radiology;
e. Pharmacy;
f. Laboratory;
g. Home health;
h. Outpatient services; and
i. Therapeutic pool.
G. Evaluation Unit.
1. Office(s) for Personnel.
2. Examination Rooms. The rooms shall have a
minimum floor area of 140 square feet excluding such spaces as the vestibule,
toilet, closet, and work counter (whether fixed or movable). The minimum room
dimension shall be ten feet. The room shall contain a lavatory or sink equipped
for handwashing, a work counter and storage facilities, and a desk, counter, or
shelf space for writing.
3.
Evaluation Rooms. The room areas shall be arranged to permit appropriate
evaluation of patient needs and progress and to determine specific programs of
rehabilitation. Rooms shall include a desk and work area for the evaluators,
writing and work space for patients, and storage for supplies. Where the
facility is small and workload light, evaluation may be done in the examination
room.
4. Laboratory Facilities.
Facilities shall be provided within the rehabilitation department or through
contract arrangement with a nearby hospital or laboratory service for
hematology, clinical chemistry, urinalysis, cytology, pathology, and
bacteriology. If these facilities are provided through contract, the following
minimum laboratory services shall be provided in the rehabilitation facility:
a. Laboratory work counter(s) with a sink,
and gas and electric service;
b.
Handwashing stations;
c. Storage
cabinet(s) or closet(s); and
d.
Specimen collection facilities. Urine collection rooms shall be equipped with a
water closet and lavatory. Blood collection facilities shall have space for a
chair and work counter.
5. Imaging Facilities. Imaging facilities, if
required by the functional program, shall be in accordance with Section 52,
Physical Facilities, Imaging Suite.
H. Psychological Service. Office(s) and work
space for testing, evaluation, and counseling shall be provided.
I. Social Service. Office space(s) for
private interviewing and counseling shall be provided.
J. Vocational Services. Office(s) and work
space for vocational training, counseling, and placement shall be
provided.
K. Dining, Recreation,
and Day Spaces.
The following standards shall be met for patient dining,
recreation, and day spaces (areas may be in separate or adjoining
spaces):
1. Inpatient and residents
shall have a total of 55 square feet per bed.
2. Outpatients, if dining is part of the day
care program, a total of 55 square feet per person shall be provided. If dining
is not part of the program, at least 35 square feet per person shall be
provided for recreation and day spaces.
3. Storage spaces shall be provided for
recreation equipment and supplies.
L. Dietary Department. See Section 59,
Physical Facilities, Dietary Facilities.
M. Personal Care Unit for Inpatients. A
separate room with appropriate fixtures and utilities shall be provided for
patient grooming. The activities for daily living unit may serve this
purpose.
N. Activities for Daily
Living Unit. An area for teaching daily living activities shall be provided. It
shall include a bedroom, bath, kitchen, and space for training stairs.
Equipment shall be functional. The bathroom shall be in addition to other
toilet and bathing requirements. The daily living area shall be similar to a
residential environment for the purpose of facilitating the patient's skill for
daily living.
O. Administration
Department and Medical Records. See Sections 60, Physical Facilities,
Administration and Public Areas.
P.
Engineering Service and Equipment Areas. See Section 66, Physical Facilities,
Engineering Service and Equipment Areas.
Q. Laundry Services. See Section 64, Physical
Facilities, Linen Service.
R.
Housekeeping Rooms. See Section 65, Physical Facilities, Cleaning and
Sanitizing Carts and Environmental Services.
S. Employee Facilities. See Section 66,
Physical Facilities, Engineering Service and Equipment Areas.
T. Nursing.
1. The nursing units for rehabilitation
facilities shall follow the standards as described in Section 44, Physical
Facilities, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or
Pulmonary Disease), with the following exceptions:
a. Patient Rooms. Minimum areas exclusive of
toilet rooms, closets, lockers, wardrobes, alcoves, or vestibules shall be 140
square feet in single-bed rooms and 125 square feet per bed in semi-private
rooms.
b. Each patient shall have
access to a toilet room without having to enter the general corridor area. One
toilet room shall serve no more than four beds and no more than two patient
rooms. The toilet room shall contain a water closet, a handwashing fixture and
a tub and/or shower. The handwashing fixture may be omitted from a toilet room
that serves single-bed and two bed rooms if each such patient's room contains a
handwashing fixture. Each toilet room shall be of sufficient size to ensure
that wheelchair users and staff shall have access.
c. Each patient shall have access to a
wardrobe, closet, or locker with minimum clearance of one foot ten inches by
one foot eight inches. A clothes rod and adjustable shelf shall be
provided.
2. Nursing Unit
Service Areas shall follow the standards described in Section 44, Physical
Facilities, Patient Accommodations (Adult Medical, Surgical, Communicable or
Pulmonary Disease), with the following exceptions:
a. Patient Bathing Facilities. At least one
island-type bathtub and/or gurney shower shall be provided in each nursing
unit. Each tub and/or shower shall be in an individual room or privacy
enclosure that provides space for the private use of bathing fixtures, for
drying and dressing, and for a wheelchair and an assistant. Showers in central
bathing facilities shall be at least four feet square, curb-free and designed
for use by a wheelchair patient;
b.
At least one room on each floor containing a nursing unit shall be provided for
toilet training. It shall be accessible from the nursing corridor. A minimum
clearance of three feet shall be provided at the front and at each side of the
water closet. The room shall also contain a lavatory; and
c. Handrails shall be provided on both sides
of corridors used by patients. A clear distance of one and one-half inches
shall be provided between the handrail and the wall, and the top of the rail
shall be 34 inches minimum and 36 inches maximum above the floor. Exceptions
for height shall be for special care areas such as those serving
children.
U.
Sterilizing Facilities. See Section 65, Physical Facilities, Cleaning and
Sanitizing Carts and Environmental Services.
V. Rehabilitation Therapy. See Section 56,
Physical Facilities, Rehabilitation Therapy Department.
W. Pharmacy Unit. See Section 58, Physical
Facilities, Pharmacy.
X. Details
and Finishes. See Section 68, Physical Facilities, Details and
Finishes.
Y. Design and
Construction, Including Fire-Resistant Standards. See Section 69, Physical
Facilities, Construction, Including Fire Resistive Requirements.
Z. Waste Processing Services. See Section 67,
Physical Facilities, Waste Processing Services.
AA. Elevators. See Section 72, Physical
Facilities, Electrical Standards.
BB. Mechanical, Plumbing and Electrical
Standards. See Sections 71, 72 and 75.F.22.
SECTION 77
: SEVERABILITY
If any provision of these Rules, or the application thereof to
any person or circumstances is held invalid, such provisions or applications of
these Rules that can give effect without the invalid provisions or applications
will be enforced, and to this end the provisions hereto are declared to be
severable.
APPENDIX
Appendix A "No Patient Left Alone Act"
Table 1 Filter Efficiencies for Central Ventilation and Air
Conditioning Systems in Health Care Facilities
Table 2 Sound Transmission Limitations in Health Care
Facilities Table 3 Temperature and Relative
Humidity Requirements
Table 4 Ventilation, Medical Gas, and Air Flow Requirements in
Health Care Facilities Table 5 Final Occupancy Inspection Check List
Table 6 Dog Behavioral Screening Exam Table 7 Dog
History
Table 8 RECORD RETENTION
TIME FRAMES Table 9 REQUIRED
TEMPERATURES
Table 10 Outlets for Oxygen, Vacuum (Suction), and
Medical Air Systems Table 11 VERBAL ORDERS
Table 12 THIRD PARTY REPROCESSING OF SINGLE USE ITEMS
CERTIFICATION
SECTION 78
: Appendix A
"No Patient Left Alone Act*"
20-6-401.
Title.
This subchapter shall be known and may be cited as the "No
Patient Left Alone Act".
20-6-402.
Legislative findings.
The General Assembly finds that:
(1) The coronavirus 2019 (COVID-19) pandemic
has caused great uncertainty and anxiety across the state and has significantly
affected the medical community, including hospitals;
(2) Healthcare facilities have made many
efforts to maintain a safe environment for patients and employees and have
worked to minimize, to the extent possible, the risk of spread of coronavirus
2019 (COVID-19);
(3) There have
been unintended consequences of these preventative measures for patients who
have not been diagnosed with coronavirus 2019 (COVID-19);
(4) Across the state, patients who have not
been diagnosed with coronavirus 2019 (COVID-19) have been prohibited from
having any visitors;
(5) As a
result, many patients who were not diagnosed with coronavirus 2019 (COVID-19)
have been required to be alone during their treatment for serious conditions,
traumas, illnesses, and routine and emergency surgeries;
(6) Some of these patients have been required
to be alone for the entire course of their treatment and in some cases have
died alone;
(7) Many families have
been unable to be physically present with their loved ones who are being
treated in a healthcare facility and have been limited to electronic video
communications, if any, with their loved ones; and
(8) It is in the interest of the state and
its citizens that a patient be allowed at least one (1) support person who is
permitted to be physically present with the patient on a daily basis at
reasonable times throughout his or her hospitalization, visit to the office of
a healthcare professional, or institutionalization.
20-6-403.
Definitions.
As used in this subchapter:
(1)
(A)
"Compassionate care visitation" means a visit with a friend or family member
that is necessary to meet the physical or mental needs of a resident when a
resident is exhibiting signs of physical or mental distress, including without
limitation:
(i) End-of-life
situations;
(ii) Adjustment support
after moving to a new facility or environment;
(iii) Emotional support after the loss of a
friend or family member;
(iv)
Physical support after eating or drinking issues, including weight loss or
dehydration; or
(v) Social support
after frequent crying, distress, or depression.
(B) "Compassionate care visitation" includes
without limitation:
(i) Clergy
members;
(ii) Lay persons offering
religious or spiritual support;
(iii) Other persons requested by the resident
for the purpose of a compassionate care visit; and
(iv) A person providing a service requested
by the resident such as a hair dresser or barber;
(2) "Healthcare facility" means a
hospital, an office of a healthcare professional, a long-term care facility, or
a hospice facility;
(3) "Healthcare
professional" means a person who is licensed, certified, or otherwise
authorized by the laws of this state to administer health care in the ordinary
course of the practice of his or her profession;
(4) "Long-term care facility" means:
(A) A nursing home;
(B) A residential care facility;
(C) A post-acute head injury retraining and
residential facility;
(D) An
intermediate care facility for individuals with developmental
disabilities;
(E) An assisted
living facility; or
(F) A facility
that provides long-term medical or personal care;
(5) "Other individuals given access" means
persons other than patients and residents of a healthcare facility;
(6) "Patient with a disability" means a
patient who needs assistance to effectively communicate with hospital staff,
make healthcare decisions, or engage in activities of daily living due to a
disability such as:
(A) A physical,
intellectual, behavioral, or cognitive disability;
(B) Deafness, being hard of hearing, or other
communication barriers;
(C)
Blindness;
(D) Autism spectrum
disorder; or
(E) Dementia;
and
(7) "Support person"
means an individual other than a spouse or legal guardian who is designated by
the patient to advocate or provide support for the patient.
20-6-404.
Visitation and
support for patient with disability.
(a) Upon the request of a patient with a
disability, a hospital, office of a healthcare professional, or hospice
facility licensed in this state shall allow a patient with a disability to
designate at least three (3) support persons and shall allow at least one (1)
support person to be present with the patient with a disability at all times in
the emergency department and during the stay of a patient with a disability in
the hospital, office of a healthcare professional, or hospice facility if
necessary to facilitate the care of the patient with a disability, including
without limitation when the patient with a disability:
(1) Has a cognitive or mental health
disability that affects the ability of a patient with a disability to make
medical decisions or understand medical advice;
(2) Needs assistance with activities of daily
living and the staff are unable to provide or are less effective at providing
the assistance;
(3) Is deaf, hard
of hearing, or has other communication barriers and requires the assistance of
a support person to ensure effective communication with staff;
(4) Has behavioral health needs that the
support person can address more effectively than the staff; or
(5) Is making a decision to consent to
treatment or refuse treatment.
(b) A healthcare professional or healthcare
facility shall not discriminate against a patient with a disability by
requiring the patient with a disability to:
(1) Execute an advance directive or a
physician order for life-sustaining treatment as a condition of receiving
treatment or visitation; or
(2)
Agree to a do-not-resuscitate or similar order as a condition of receiving
treatment or visitation.
(c) This section does not affect any
obligation of a healthcare professional or healthcare facility to:
(1) Provide patients with effective
communication supports or other reasonable accommodations in accordance with
federal and state laws; or
(2) Make
exceptions to the visitor policy of a healthcare facility as a reasonable
accommodation under the Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990,
42 U.S.C. §
12101 et seq., as existing on January 1,
2021.
20-6-405.
Hospital or office of
healthcare professional visitation.
(a)
(1) A
child has the right to have a parent, legal guardian, or person standing in
loco parentis physically present with the child while the child receives care
in a hospital or an office of a healthcare professional.
(2) An adult patient has the right to have a
spouse, support person, or legal guardian physically present with the adult
patient while the adult receives care in a hospital or an office of a
healthcare professional.
(3) A
person with a right to be physically present under subdivisions (a)(1) and (2)
of this section may leave and return to the hospital or office of a healthcare
professional that is caring for the patient.
(b) A hospital or an office of a healthcare
professional shall not:
(1) Require a patient
to waive the rights specified in subdivisions (a)(1) and (2) of this
section;
(2) Prevent a parent,
legal guardian, or person standing in loco parentis of a child receiving care
in a hospital or an office of a healthcare professional from having daily
physical access to the child at reasonable times; or
(3) Separate the parent, legal guardian, or
person standing in loco parentis of a child receiving care in a hospital or an
office of a healthcare professional from the child except in cases of suspected
abuse or threats of violence or to prevent disruption to the care of the
child.
(c) A hospital or
an office of a healthcare professional may restrict access of any person to a
patient:
(1) At the request of the patient or
a law enforcement agency;
(2) Due
to a court order;
(3) To prevent
disruption to the care of the patient;
(4)
(A) If
the person has signs and symptoms of a transmissible infection.
(B) However, the hospital or office of a
healthcare professional shall allow access through telephone, telecommunication
means, or other means that ensure the protection of the patient.
(C) The person shall follow respiratory
hygiene and cough etiquette as well as other infection prevention and control
practices such as appropriate hand hygiene;
(5) If the person is determined to be a
danger to the patient or to be contrary to the welfare of the patient;
or
(6) According to visitation
policies established under §
20-6-411.
20-6-408.
Clergy member or lay person
offering religious or spiritual support visitation.
A clergy member or lay person offering religious or spiritual
support may be physically present with a patient to pray with or offer
spiritual support for the patient while the patient receives care in a
healthcare facility.
20-6-409.
Informational
materials.(a)
(1) Within thirty (30) days of March 10,
2021, the Department of Health and the Department of Human Services shall
develop informational materials regarding this subchapter.
(2) The Department of Health and the
Department of Human Services shall present informational materials regarding
this subchapter to the:
(A) Senate Committee
on Public Health, Welfare, and Labor;
(B) House Committee on Public Health,
Welfare, and Labor; and
(C) House
Committee on Aging, Children and Youth, Legislative and Military
Affairs.
(b) A
healthcare facility shall make the informational materials regarding this
subchapter accessible:
(1) Upon admission or
registration; and
(2) On the
website of the healthcare facility.
(c) Every sixty (60) days or upon the release
of relevant federal guidelines, the Department of Health, with input from the
long-term care industry and the hospital industry, shall reevaluate and update
the directives where needed to allow for the maximum visitation possible under
federal guidelines.
(d) Information
and directives produced by this state that provide guidance about visitation
shall take into consideration and include the highest amount possible of
privacy and dignity for interaction between patients and visitors.
20-6-410.
Complaints.
(a) An individual may file a complaint
against a healthcare professional or healthcare facility for failing to comply
with this subchapter with the appropriate state agency or licensing board,
including the Department of Health and the Department of Human
Services.
(b) The appropriate state
agency or licensing board shall investigate the complaint.
20-6-411.
Visitation limits or
restrictions.
A healthcare facility may establish visitation policies that
limit or restrict visitation when:
(1)
The presence of visitors would be medically or therapeutically
contraindicated;
(2) The presence
of visitors would interfere with the care of or rights of any
patient;
(3) Visitors are engaging
in disruptive, threatening, or violent behavior toward any staff member,
patient, or other visitor; or
(4)
Visitors are noncompliant with healthcare facility policy.
20-6-412.
Liability of healthcare
facilities.(a) Unless expressly
required by federal law or regulation, a state survey agency or other state
agency shall not take any action against a healthcare facility for:
(1) Giving a visitor or other individual
access to a healthcare facility, clinic, or other similar location under this
subchapter;
(2) Failing to protect
or otherwise ensure the safety or comfort of a visitor or other individual
given access to a healthcare facility, clinic, or other similar location under
this subchapter;
(3) Failing to
follow the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention or other national
guidelines that require or recommend restricting visitor access; or
(4) The acts or omissions of any visitor or
other individual who is given access to a healthcare facility, clinic, or
similar location.
(b)
This section does not apply to courts or the judicial branch.
20-6-413.
Construction.(a) This subchapter
does not apply to:
(1) The Arkansas State
Hospital;
(2) A minor who is:
(A) In the custody of the Division of
Children and Family Services; or
(B) A suspected victim in a pending
maltreatment investigation;
(3) An individual who is in the custody of
the Department of Corrections; or
(4) An individual who is attending a
preventive healthcare office visit during which evidence-based guidelines for
preventive care recommend a confidential visit component for youth, as mutually
agreed to by the patient and his or her physician.
(b) This subchapter does not:
(1) Affect the rights of a legal guardian or
holder of a power of attorney; or
(2) Waive or change the long-term care
facility residents' rights under §
20-10-1204.
(c) The requirements under this subchapter
shall be established as a minimum for visitation in a healthcare facility but
do not limit visitation at a healthcare facility to only visitation outlined in
this subchapter.
(d) The rights
specified in this subchapter shall not be terminated, suspended, or waived by:
(1) A healthcare facility;
(2) The Department of Health;
(3) The State Board of Health;
(4) The Department of Human Services;
or
(5) The Governor upon declaring
a disaster emergency under the Arkansas Emergency Services Act of 1973, §
12-75-101 et seq., or ordering the
board to take action under §
20-7-110, or both.
*Abridged to remove Code Sections unrelated to Hospitals
and Related Institutions.
TABLE 1
Filter Efficiencies for Central Ventilation and
Air Conditioning Systems in Health Care Facilities |
Area Designation |
No. Filter Beds |
Filter Bed No.1 (%) |
Filter Bed 1 No.2 (%) |
All areas for patient care, treatment, and diagnosis,
and those areas providing direct service or clean supplies such as sterile and
clean processing. |
2 |
30 |
90 |
Protective Environment Room |
2 |
30 |
99.97 |
Laboratories |
1 |
80 |
- |
Administrative, Bulk Storage, Soiled Holding Areas,
Food Preparation Areas, and Laundries |
1 |
30 |
- |
1 These requirements do not apply to
small outpatient clinics or outpatient clinics that do not perform invasive
applications or procedures.
Notes: The filtration efficiency ratings are based on average
dust spot efficiency per ASHRAE 52.1 1992.
Additional roughing or prefilters should be considered to
reduce maintenance required for filters with efficiencies higher than 75
percent.
TABLE 2
Sound Transmission Limitations in Health Care
Facilities |
Airborne Sound Transmission Class
(STC)1 |
Partitions Floors |
NEW
CONSTRUCTION2 |
Patients = Room to Patients = Room |
45 |
40 |
Public Space to Patients = Room
3
|
55 |
40 |
Service Areas to Patients = Room
4
|
65 |
45 |
Patient room access corridor
5
|
45 |
45 |
Exam room to exam room |
45 |
____ |
Exam room to public space |
45 |
____ |
Toilet room to public space |
45 |
____ |
Consultation rooms/ conference rooms to public
space |
45 |
____ |
Consultation rooms/
Conference rooms to patient rooms |
45 |
____ |
Staff lounges to patient rooms |
45 |
____ |
Existing Construction
2 |
Patient room to patient room |
35 |
40 |
Public space to patient
room3 |
40 |
40 |
Service areas to patient
room4 |
45 |
45 |
1. Sound
transmission class (STC) shall be determined per ASTM Standard E90 and E413.
Where partitions do not extend to the structure above, sound transmission
through ceilings and composite STC performance shall be considered.
2. Treatment rooms shall be treated the same
as patient rooms
3. Public space
includes lobbies, dining rooms, recreation rooms, treatment rooms, and similar
spaces.
4. Service areas include
kitchens, elevators, elevator machine rooms, laundries, garages, maintenance
rooms, boiler and mechanical equipment rooms, and similar spaces of high noise.
Mechanical equipment located on the same floor or above patient rooms, offices,
nurses stations, and similar occupied space shall be effectively isolated from
the floor.
5. Patient room access
corridors contain composite walls with doors/windows and have direct access to
patient rooms.
TABLE 3
Temperature and Relative Humidity
Requirements
Area Designation |
Dry Bulb Temperatures
°F1 |
Relative Humidity (%) Minimum-Maximum
2 |
Operating Rooms, Delivery Rooms, Endoscopy, and
Bronchoscopy |
68-73 |
20-60 |
Newborn Intensive Care and Newborn Nursery
Suite |
72-78 |
30-60 |
Recovery, Intensive Care, Trauma Rooms, Procedure
Rooms, and Radiological X-ray (Surgical/Critical Care and
Catheterization) |
70-75 |
30-60 |
Clean Work Room and ETO Sterilizer Room |
75 |
30-60 |
Sterile Storage |
75 |
70 (max) |
1 Where temperature ranges are
indicated, the systems shall be capable of maintaining the rooms at any point
within the range. A single figure indicates a heating or cooling capacity of at
least the indicated temperature. Nothing in these guidelines shall be construed
as precluding the use of temperatures different than those noted when the
patient's comfort and medical conditions make different temperatures desirable.
Unoccupied areas such as storage rooms shall have temperatures appropriate for
the function intended.
2 Humidification systems serving
anesthetizing locations shall be designed in accordance with NFPA 99 paragraph
5-4.1.1.
SECTION 79
: TABLE 4
Ventilation, Medical Gas, and Air Flow Requirements in
Health Care Facilities1
Area Designation |
Air Movement Relationship To Adjacent
Area |
Minimum Air Changes Outside Air Per
Hour3 |
Minimum Total Air Changes Per
Hour4,5 |
Air Recirculated By Means of Room
Unit7 |
All Air Exhausted Directly
Outdoor6 |
SURGERY AND CRITICAL CARE
AREAS |
Operating/Surgical Cystoscopic Rooms
8,9 |
Out |
3 |
15 |
No |
Optional |
Delivery Room
8 |
Out |
3 |
15 |
No |
Optional |
Recovery
Room8 |
- |
2 |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Critical Care and Intensive Care |
- |
2 |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Newborn intensive care |
- |
2 |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Treatment
Room10 |
- |
- |
6 |
Optional |
Optional |
Trauma
Room10 |
Out |
3 |
15 |
No |
Optional |
Anesthesia gas storage |
In |
- |
8 |
Optional |
Yes |
Endoscopy |
In |
2 |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Bronchoscopy
9 |
In |
2 |
12 |
No |
Yes |
ER Waiting Room |
In |
2 |
12 |
No |
Yes
11,12 |
Triage |
In |
- |
12 |
No |
Yes11 |
Radiology waiting rooms |
In |
2 |
12 |
Optional |
Yes11,12 |
Procedure room |
Out |
3 |
15 |
No |
Optional |
NURSING AREAS |
Patient Room |
- |
2 |
6
13 |
Optional |
Optional |
Toilet Room |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Newborn Nursery Suite |
- |
2 |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Protective environment room
9,14 |
Out |
2 |
12 |
No |
Optional |
Airborne Infectious Isolation, Bronchoscopy
Room9, 15
|
In |
2 |
12 |
No |
Yes |
Isolation alcove or anteroom
14,15 |
In/Out |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Labor/Delivery/Recovery (LDR) |
- |
2 |
613 |
Optional |
Optional |
Labor/Delivery/ Recovery/ Post Partum (LDRP)
- |
- |
2 |
613 |
Optional |
Optional |
Patient Corridor |
- |
- |
2 |
Optional |
Optional |
ANCILLARY AREAS |
Radiology X-ray (Surgical/Critical Care & 16
Catheterization) |
Out |
3 |
15 |
No |
Optional |
Radiology X-ray (Diagnostic &
Treatment)16 |
- |
- |
6 |
Optional |
Optional |
Radiology Darkroom |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Lab General
16 |
- |
- |
6 |
Optional |
Optional |
Lab Biochemistry
16 |
Out |
- |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Lab Cytology |
In |
- |
6 |
No |
Yes |
Lab Glass Washing |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Lab Histology |
In |
- |
6 |
No |
Yes |
Lab Microbiology
16 |
In |
- |
6 |
No |
Yes |
Lab Nuclear Med |
In |
- |
6 |
No |
Yes |
Lab Pathology |
In |
- |
6 |
No |
Yes |
Lab Serology |
Out |
- |
6 |
No |
Optional |
Lab Sterilizing |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Autopsy9 |
In |
- |
1712 |
No |
Yes |
Nonrefrigerated body holding room |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Pharmacy |
Out |
- |
4 |
Optional |
Optional |
TABLE 4-1
Area Designation |
Air Movement Relationship To Adjacent
Area |
Minimum Air Changes Outside Air Per
Hour3 |
Minimum Total Air Changes Per
Hour4,5 |
Air Recirculated By Means of Room
Unit7 |
All Air Exhausted Directly
Outdoor6 |
DIAGNOSTIC AND TREATMENT AREAS |
Examination Room |
- |
- |
6 |
Optional |
Optional |
Medication Room |
Out |
- |
4 |
Optional |
Optional |
Treatment Room |
- |
- |
6 |
Optional |
Optional |
Physical Therapy and Hydrotherapy |
In |
- |
6 |
Optional |
Optional |
Soiled Workroom or Soiled Holding |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Clean Workroom or Clean Holding |
Out |
- |
4 |
Optional |
Optional |
STERILIZING AND SUPPLY AREAS |
ETO Sterilizer Room |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Sterilizer Equipment Room |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Central Supply Soiled or Decontamination
Room |
In |
- |
6 |
No |
Yes |
Central Supply Clean
Workroom17 |
Out |
- |
4 |
No |
Optional |
Sterile Storage |
Out |
- |
4 |
Optional |
Optional |
SERVICE AREAS |
Food Preparation
Centers17 |
- |
- |
10 |
No |
Optional |
Warewashing |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Dietary Day Storage |
In |
- |
2 |
Optional |
Optional |
Laundry, General |
- |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Soiled Linen Sorting and Storage |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Clean Linen Storage |
Out |
- |
2 |
Optional |
Optional |
Soiled Linen and Trash Chute Room |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Bedpan Room |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Yes |
Bathroom |
In |
- |
10 |
Optional |
Optional |
Janitor's Closet |
In |
- |
10 |
No |
Yes |
Notes for Table 4
1.
The ventilation rates in this table cover ventilation for comfort, as well as
for asepsis and odor control in areas of acute care hospitals that directly
affect patient care and are determined based on healthcare facilities being
predominantly "No Smoking" facilities per Ark. Code Ann. §
20-27-704 et seq.. Where smoking
may be allowed, ventilation rates will need adjustment. Areas where specific
ventilation rates are not given in the table shall be ventilated in accordance
with ASHRAE Standard 62, Ventilation for Acceptable Indoor Air Quality; and
ASHRAE Handbook-HVAC Applications. Specialized patient care areas, including
organ transplant units, burn units, specialty procedure rooms, etc., shall have
additional ventilation provisions for air quality control as may be
appropriate. OSHA standards and/or NI0SH criteria require special ventilation
requirements for employee health and safety within healthcare
facilities.
2. Design of the
ventilation system shall provide air movement which is generally from clean to
less clean areas. If any form of variable air volume or load shedding system is
used for energy conservation, it shall not compromise the corridor-to-room
pressure balancing relationships or the minimum air changes required by the
table. Where the air movement relationship is "In (negative) or Out
(positive)", the air movement relationship shall not be reversible. Rooms with
reversible airflow provision for the purpose of switching between "In" and
"Out" are not acceptable.
3. To
satisfy exhaust needs, replacement air from the outside is necessary. Table 4
does not attempt to describe specific amounts of outside air to be supplied to
individual spaces except for certain areas such as those listed. Distribution
of the outside air, added to the system to balance required exhaust, shall be
as required by good engineering practice. Minimum outside air quantities shall
remain constant while the system is in operation.
4. Number of air changes may be reduced when
the room is unoccupied if provisions are made to ensure that the number of air
changes indicated is reestablished any time the space is being utilized.
Adjustments shall include provisions so that the direction of air movement
shall remain the same when the number of air changes is reduced. Areas not
indicated as having continuous directional control may have ventilation systems
shut down when space Is unoccupied and ventilation is not otherwise needed, if
the maximum infiltration or exfiltration permitted in Note 2 is not exceeded
and if adjacent pressure balancing relationships arc not compromised. Air
quantity calculations shall account for filter loading such that the indicated
air change rates are provided up until the time of filter change-out.
5. Air change requirements indicated are
minimum values. Higher values should be used when required to maintain
indicated room conditions (temperature and humidity), based on the cooling load
of the space (lights, equipment, people, exterior walls and windows,
etc.).
6. Air from areas with
contamination and/or odor problems shall be exhausted to the outside and not
recirculated to other areas. Note that individual circumstances may require
special consideration for air exhaust to the outside, e.g., in intensive care
units in which patients with pulmonary infection are treated, and rooms for
burn patients.
7. Recirculating
room HVAC units refers to those local units that are used primarily for heating
and cooling of air, and not disinfection of air. Because of cleaning difficulty
and potential for buildup of contamination, recirculating room units shall not
be used in areas marked "No." However, for airborne infection prevention and
control, air may be recirculated within Individual isolation rooms if HEPA
filters are used. Isolation and intensive care unit rooms may be ventilated by
reheat induction units in which only the primary air supplied from a central
system passes through the reheat unit. Gravity-type heating or cooling units
such as radiators or convectors shall not be used m operating rooms and other
special care areas.
8. National
Institute for Occupational Safety and Health (NIOSH) Criteria Documents
regarding Occupational Exposure to Waste Anesthetic Gases and Vapors, and
Control of Occupational Exposure to Nitrous Oxide indicate a need for both
local exhaust (scavenging) systems and general ventilation of the areas in
which the respective gases are utilized.
9. Differential pressure shall be a minimum
of 0.01" water gauge (2.5 Pa). If alarms are installed, allowances shall be
made to prevent nuisance alarms of monitoring devices.
10. The term trauma room as used here is the
operating room space in the emergency department or other trauma reception area
that is used for emergency surgery. The first aid room and/or "emergency room"
used for initial treatment of accident victims may be ventilated as noted for
the "treatment room." Treatment rooms used for Bronchoscopy shall be treated as
Bronchoscopy rooms. Treatment rooms used for cryosurgery procedures with
nitrous oxide shall contain provisions for exhausting waste gases.
11. In a ventilation system that recirculates
air, HEPA filters can be used in lieu of exhausting the air from these spaces
to the outside. In this application, the return air shall be passed through the
HEPA filters before it is introduced into any other spaces.
12. If it is not practical to exhaust the air
from the airborne infection isolation room to the outside, the air may be
returned through HEPA filters to the air-handling system exclusively serving
the isolation room.
13. Total air
changes per room for patient rooms, labor/delivery/recovery rooms, and
labor/delivery/recovery/postpartum rooms may be reduced to 4 when supplemental
heating and/or cooling systems (radiant heating and cooling, baseboard heating,
etc.) are used.
14. The protective
environment airflow design specifications protect the patient from common
environmental airborne infectious microbes (i.e., Aspergillus spores). These
special ventilation areas shall be designed to provide directed airflow from
the cleanest patient care area to less clean areas. These rooms shall be
protected with HEPA filters at 99.97 percent efficiency for a 0.3 micron sized
particle in the supply airstream. These Interrupting filters protect patient
rooms from maintenance-derived release of environmental microbes from the
ventilation system components. Recirculation 11EPA filters can be used to
increase the equivalent room air exchanges. Constant volume airflow is required
for consistent ventilation for the protected environment. It the facility
determines that airborne infection isolation is necessary for protective
environment patients, an anteroom shall be provided. Rooms with reversible
airflow provisions for the purpose of switching between protective environment
and airborne infection isolation functions are not acceptable.
15. The infectious disease isolation room
described in these guidelines is to be used for isolating the airborne spread
of infectious diseases, such as measles, varicella, or tuberculosis. The design
of airborne infection isolation (All) rooms should include the provision for
normal patient care during periods not requiring Isolation precautions.
Supplemental recirculating devices may be used in the patient room, to increase
the equivalent room airexchanges; however, such recirculating devices do not
provide the outside air requirements. Air may be recirculated within individual
isolation rooms if HEPA filters are used. Rooms with reversible airflow
provisions for the purpose of switching between protective environment and All
functions are not acceptable.
16.
When required, appropriate hoods and exhaust devices for the removal of noxious
gases or chemical vapors shall be provided per NFPA 99.
17. Food preparation centers shall have
ventilation systems whose air supply mechanisms arc interfaced appropriately
with exhaust hood controls or relief vents so that exfiltration or infiltration
to or from exit corridors does not compromise the exit corridor restrictions of
NFPA 90A, the pressure requirements of NFPA 96, or the maximum defined in the
table. The number of air changes may be reduced or varied to any extent
required for odor control when the space is not in use.
TABLE 5
Final Occupancy Inspection Check List
Inspector: ______________ Date:_______________
Facility: ________________ Job:___________________
Item |
Yes |
No |
Comments |
1. Architect/Engineer=s Certification of Substantial
Completion? |
2. Interior finishes development and fire spread rating
information? |
3. Fire Protection Systems - Portable fire
extinguishers are inspected and tagged, and shop drawing for
standpipe/sprinkler systems are available? |
4. Certificate of City Building Inspector? |
5. Certification - fire alarm system,
smoke detection system, sprinkler system, and any other fire suppression system
has been installed, tested and meets all applicable standards? |
6. Certification - medical gas
system? |
7. Certification - electrical system has
been installed, tested and meets all applicable standards of the NEC,
NFPA? |
8. Certification - emergency generator has
been installed, tested and meets all applicable standards of the NFPA,
NEC? |
9. Certification - mechanical system has
been installed, tested, balanced, and approved by the engineer of
record? |
10. Certification - communication
system(s) has been installed, tested and meets all applicable standards of the
NEC, NFPA? |
11. Are there manufacturer=s operation and maintenance
manuals with equipment warranties on site for all newly installed equipment or
a letter from the general contractor stating that the above items will be
turned over to the owner? |
12. Have all applicable pieces of equipment installed
during the construction been incorporated into the existing preventive
maintenance system? Or, have new maintenance policies and procedures been
written to insure that said items are maintained per the manufacturers
recommendations? |
13. Are there as-built drawings on site or a letter
from the general contractor stating that the as-built drawings will be turned
over to the owner? |
14. Are there copies of the Architect=s and Engineer=s
final punch lists with verification that all items have been repaired or
remedied? |
15. Has the Architect/designer accepted testing and
certification of items 5 through 10 above? |
1In accordance with the applicable
electrical system requirements of NFPA 99, grounding system effectiveness shall
be determined for new and renovated equipment by voltage and impedance
measurements. Receptacles shall be checked for continuity of the grounding
circuit and polarity of the hot and neutral connections.
TABLE 6
Dog Behavioral Screening Exam
|
Initial Observation: A room
with minimal distraction is an appropriate test area. Allow the dog to
investigate this area for several minutes without the tester present. The
tester should enter the room, not speak, stand still at a discreet distance and
observe the dog for about 15 seconds. Record the initial response. |
ACCEPTABLE |
QUESTIONABLE |
OTHER |
Holds Ground |
Crouches |
No response |
Approaches Tester |
Hackles Up |
Hackles Normal |
Lips Puffed |
Lips Normal |
Moves Stiff-Legged |
Sniffs Tester |
Growls |
Retreats |
Barks |
Avoids Eye Contact |
Stares At You |
Whines |
TEST 2
|
Approaching the Dog: After
initial brief observation, approach the dog with hand extended at the dog's
nose level, palm and fingers pointed downward. Do not rush in, but do not
approach dog in a cautious or apprehensive manner. Walk up to the dog in a
normal stride until your hand is within six to 12 inches of the dogs nose. Say
nothing and wait for the dog to make the next move.
|
ACCEPTABLE |
QUESTIONABLE |
OTHER |
Extends Head or Steps Forward to Sniff
Hand |
Turns Head Away or Tries to Ignore Hand |
Stares At You |
Seeks Attention by Nudging or Leaning into
Tester |
Pulls Back or Retreats |
No Response |
Acts Playful by Barks or Actions |
Raises Hackles |
Licks Hand 9 |
with Playful Barking |
Lips Puffed |
Overly Exuberant |
Bares Teeth (Don't Confuse with grin) |
TEST 3
|
Handling the Dog: If the dog has not been
eliminated by
|
Pulls Back or Retreats |
Meets You, But With Head Lowered and Eyes
Averted |
Growls |
Attempts to Lick Your Face |
Becomes Playful |
Lips Puffed |
Enjoys Brushing |
Raises Hackles |
Quivers or Cowers |
Barks |
Rolls Over on Back |
Submissively Urinates |
Snaps, Bites |
Shows Whites of Eyes |
Overly Exuberant (Jumps Up) |
Overly Sensitive to Grooming of Certain
Areas |
Aloof |
TEST 4 |
Interacting with the Dog: See
if he/she will retrieve a ball. Walk away briskly, sit on floor and call dog.
Lay the dog down, then roll him/her over, rub his/her belly. Will he/she allow
this subordination? Have a assistant place a novel stimulus such as a large
stuffed animal or mirror close behind the dog when he/she is distracted. Does
he/she have the self-confidence to investigate? How does the dog react to
sudden arm movement? |
TEST 5
|
Sound Sensitivity: While
casually interacting with the dog, have an assistant make a loud noise without
warning (e.g., hitting a metal pan with a spoon).
|
ACCEPTABLE |
QUESTIONABLE |
OTHER |
Notices, But Continues
Previous Activity |
Flees |
Notices, Investigates |
Cowers |
Startles, But Recovers
Quickly |
Freezes |
Trembles |
Urinates |
Moves As If To Attack |
TEST 6
|
Pain Threshold: While playing
with dog, briefly pinch the webbing between his/her toes or pull hair from his
side to determine pain tolerance.
|
|
Tries to Pull Away, But Shows
Forgiveness |
Growls |
Yelps, But is Not Aggressive |
Snaps |
Trusts You, Allows Further Petting |
Acts Fearful |
Acts Distrustful |
TEST 7 |
Reacting to Unexpected Events (Choose
One): Owner is to be present at all times. (Assess response using
response categories from Test 5.) |
A. Have your assistant hide around a corner, out of
sight, with a noisy utility shopping cart. Walk with dog toward the
intersection as the assistant rolls the cart in front of the dog as close as
possible. Record the dog's reaction. |
B. While the dog is playing with you and is distracted,
have the assistant hide in the closet and behind the door. Lead the dog to
within six feet of the hiding place and have the assistant suddenly jump out at
the dog and open an umbrella. Note reactions. |
TEST 8 |
Manners: Test the dog for
basic obedience commands such as heel and sit-stay. |
TABLE 7
Click
here to view image
Click
here to view image
TABLE 8
RECORD RETENTION TIME FRAMES
DEPARTMENT |
DOCUMENT |
RETENTION TIME |
Administrative |
Governing Body |
Permanent |
Medical Staff |
Permanent |
Executive Committee |
Permanent |
Other Hospital Committees |
2 years |
Medical Records |
Original/Microfilm
Adult/Inpatient/Outpatient
Electrocardiogram Strips/
Interpretations
Electroencephalogram/
Interpretations |
10 years after last discharge plus 2 years past
majority.
Facility shall maintain information in the master
patient index |
Minor/Inpatient/Outpatient
Electrocardiogram Strips/
Electroencephalogram/
Original/Microfilm
Fetal Monitor Strips
Interpretations |
Radiology |
Films |
Films |
Nuclear Medicine |
Films |
Facility shall maintain information in the master
patient index. |
Laboratory |
Blood Gas Reports |
2 years |
Patient Specimens |
2 years |
Control Documentation |
2 years |
Immunohematology |
5 years |
Immumohematology Quality Control
Records |
5 years |
Cytology: Histopathology Quality Control
Records |
10 years |
Cytology: Slide Preparation |
5 years |
Transfusions |
5 years |
Blood Donor Samples |
7 days post transfusion |
Quality Assurance |
2 years |
Pathology Lab |
Pathology Reports |
10 years |
Reference Pathology |
2 years |
Preliminary/Corrected |
Exact duplicate |
Histopathology |
Stained Slides |
10 years |
Specimen Blocks |
2 years |
Pharmacy |
All drug records to include:
official records
purchase invoices
Prescription records
Inventory records, etc. |
2 years |
TABLE 9
REQUIRED
TEMPERATURES |
MEDICATIONS |
Refrigerators |
36-4 F |
Medication Storage Room |
59-86 F |
DIETARY1 |
Temperature of Food at Bedside |
Hot Foods = 140 F |
Cold Foods = 40 F |
Temperature of Heated Food Prior to Hot
Holding |
160 F |
Temperature of Heated Leftovers Prior to Hot
Holding |
165 F |
Temperature for
Thawing Potentially
Hazardous Food |
Tempering Units = 45 F or less |
Refrigerator = 40 F or less |
Refrigerators |
40 F |
Freezers |
0 F |
Single Tank Stationary Rack Dual Temperature
Machine |
Wash Temperature = 150 F |
Final Rinse Temperature = 180 F |
Single Tank Conveyor Machine |
Wash Temperature = 160 F |
Final Rinse Temperature = 180 F |
Multi-tank Conveyor Machine |
Wash Temperature = 150 F |
Final Rinse Temperature = 180 F |
Pumped Rinse Temperature = 160 F |
Single Tank Pot, Pan & Utensil
Washer |
Wash Temperature = 140EF |
Final Rinse Temperature = 180EF |
Manual Ware washing |
Wash Temperature = 110EF |
Rinse Temperature = 120°G - 140°F |
Chemical Sanitation (Manual or
Mechanical) |
Sanitation Temperature = > 171°F or Immersion in
75EF water and 50 ppm of hypochlorite for at least 1 minute or other method
approved by Arkansas Department of Health |
All Cutting Board
Surfaces |
Immersion in clean, hot water of > 180°F for at
least 30 seconds or any other method approved. |
LAUNDRY |
Water |
Nothing under 120 F |
Water with Chlorine Bleach |
150 parts per million ppm (parts per
million) |
CLINICAL |
Gallons per hour per bed |
105°F - 120°F |
Notes:
1. Provisions
shall be made to provide 180°F rinse water at ware washer. (may be by a
separate booster.)
2. Provisions
shall be made to provide 160°F hot water at the laundry equipment w
hen needed. (This may be a steam jet or separate booster
heater.) However, this does not imply that all water used would be at this
temperature. Water temperatures required for acceptable laundry results will
vary.
Lower temperatures may be adequate for most procedures in many
facilities but the higher 160°F should be available when needed for special
conditions.
TABLE 10
Central Station Outlets for Oxygen, Vacuum (Suction), and
Medical Air Systems in Hospitals and Related Institutions
Location |
Oxygen |
Vacuum |
Medical Air |
Patient Rooms (medical & surgical) |
1/bed |
1/bed |
- |
Examination/Treatment
(medical, surgical, endoscopy & postpartum
care) |
1/room |
1/room |
- |
Isolation - Infectious and protective (medical &
surgical) |
1/bed |
1/bed |
- |
Security Room (medical, surgical, &
postpartum) |
1/bed |
1/bed |
- |
Critical Care (general) |
3/bed |
3/bed |
1/bed |
Isolation (critical) |
3/bed |
3/bed |
1/bed |
Coronary Critical Care |
3/bed |
2/bed |
1/bed |
Pediatric Critical Care |
3/bed |
3/bed |
1/bed |
Newborn Intensive Care |
3/bassinet |
3/bassinet |
3/bassinet |
Newborn Nursery (full-term) |
1 / 4 bassinets
2 |
1 / 4 bassinets
2 |
1 / 4 bassinets
2 |
Pediatric and Adolescent |
1/bed |
1/bed |
1/bed |
Pediatric Nursery |
1/bassinet |
1/bassinet |
1/bassinet |
Psychiatric Patient Rooms |
- |
- |
- |
Seclusion Treatment Room |
- |
- |
- |
General Operating Room |
2/room |
3/room |
- |
Cardio, Ortho, Neurological |
2/room |
3/room |
- |
Orthopedic Surgery |
2/room |
3/room |
- |
Surgical Cysto & Endo |
1/room |
3/room |
- |
Post-anesthesia Care Unit |
1/bed |
3/bed |
1/bed |
Anesthesia Workroom |
1 per workstation |
- |
1 per workstation |
Phase II Recovery
3 |
1/bed |
3/bed |
- |
Postpartum Bedroom |
1/bed |
1/bed |
1/bed |
Cesarean/Delivery Room |
2/room |
3/room |
1/room |
Infant Resuscitation
Station4 |
1/bassinet |
1/bassinet |
1/bassinet |
Labor Room |
1/room |
1/room |
1/room |
OB Recovery Room |
1/bed |
3/bed |
1/room |
Labor/Delivery/Recovery (LDR)
5 |
2/bed |
2/bed |
- |
Labor/Delivery/Recovery
(LDRP)5 |
2/bed |
2/bed |
- |
Initial Emergency Management |
1/bed |
1/bed |
- |
Triage Area (definitive emergency care) |
1/station |
1/station |
- |
Definitive Emergency Care Exam/Treatment
Rooms |
1/bed |
1/bed |
1/bed |
Definitive Emergency Care Holding Area |
1/bed |
1/bed |
- |
Trauma/Cardiac Room(s) |
2/bed |
3/bed |
1/bed |
Orthopedic & Cast Room |
1/room |
1/room |
- |
Cardiac Catheterization Lab |
2/bed |
2/bed |
2/bed |
Autopsy Room |
- |
1 per workstation |
1 per workstation |
Notes for Table 10:
1. For any area or room not described above,
the facility clinical staff shall determine outlet requirements after
consultation with the authority having jurisdiction.
2. Four bassinets may share one outlet that
is accessible to each bassinet.
3.
If Phase II recovery area is a separate area from the PACU, only one vacuum per
bed or station shall be required
4.
When infant resuscitation takes place in a room such as cesarean
section/delivery or LDRP, then the infant resuscitation services shall be
provided in that room in addition to the minimum service required for the
mother.
5. Two outlets for mother
and two for one bassinet.
6.
Facilities with medical gas requirements in more than one area shall be
equipped with central systems.
TABLE 11 VERBAL ORDERS |
Basic Premise: |
Verbal orders may be used when there is no reasonable
alternative to obtaining a written order. |
State Health Rules: |
Permit licensed nurses and pharmacist (for drugs only)
to take verbal orders and no one else. Section 12, Medications and Section 14,
Health
Information Services. |
Practical Application: |
Health professionals other than nurses may take verbal
orders pertaining directly to their profession under specified
circumstances |
Situation to Address: |
1. Doctor in the department away from nurses'
station.
2. Doctor calls the department |
Policy Statement Parts: |
1. Who are the authorized receivers?
2. Repeat order back for accuracy.
3. Identify ordering doctor.
4. Identify receiver by name and title.
5. The receiver of the order must enter the order on
the medical record, and then sign first initial, last name and
title |
Hospital Administration |
1. Policy must be in writing, and approved by the
Medical |
Responsibility: |
Staff and Governing Body (including identification of
receivers).
2. Policy must be made a part of applicable department
manuals.
3. Inservice training provided for all personnel
involved.
4. Establish an effective monitoring
system. |
Outpatient Department |
1. The therapist or other authorized receivers may take
a verbal or telephone order from the doctor. |
(Emergency Services is Not outpatient): |
2. Must document on outpatient medical record.
3. Doctor must authenticate the order on his next
visit. |
RATIONALE
The Division of Health Facility Services has received numerous
requests for a variance in the regulations relating to who may receive doctors
orders for hospital inpatients and outpatients. This office realizes the
communication problems involved between every expanding service departments of
hospitals and the multiplicity of diagnostic treatment, therapy, and
therapeutic duties necessary for coordinating of patient care. Other
certification and accrediting organizations have also realized the
communication difficulty.
The reason and intent of the regulation was, and still is, to
coordinate all inpatient care through nursing service. The patients' medical
record must be maintained at the nurses' station to coordinate and implement
physician orders for patient care and services.
It is the intent of this policy to have both communication
between departments and also assure all physician orders and services rendered
to patients are promptly documented on the patients chart. In order to maintain
continuity of care on an inpatient basis, it is necessary that all aspects of
the patients' treatment be coordinated through the nursing service of the
facility.
TABLE 12
THIRD PARTY REPROCESSING OF SINGLE USE
ITEMS
The Office of Compliance Center of Devices and Radiological
Health of the Food and Drug Administration (FDA) provides guidelines for third
party reprocessing of devices labeled for single use provided the reprocessing
firm complies fully with all FDA regulatory requirements.
The Arkansas Department of Health will recognize FDA
guidelines.
CERTIFICATION
This is certify that the foregoing revisions to the Rules for
Critical Access Hospitals in Arkansas were adopted by the State Board of health
of Arkansas at a regular session of said Board held in Little Rocks, Arkansas,
on the 28th day of October, 2021.